..CORNELL UNIVERSITY LIBRARY MUSIC BOUGHT WITH THE INCOME OF THE SAGE ENDOWMENT FUND THE GIFT OF HENRY W. SAGE 1891 Cornell University Library MT 55.G59 Counterpoint anglled In the ...".n.Y.'S PXiSVIJi, ,f H « 3 1924 022 381 143 Cornell University Library The original of this book is in the Cornell University Library. There are no known copyright restrictions in the United States on the use of the text. http://www.archive.org/details/cu31924022381143 NINTH EDITION COUNTERPOINT APPLIED In the Invention, Fugue, Canon and other polyphonic forms An Exhaustive Treatise on the Structural and Formal Details of the Polyphonic or Contrapuntal Forms of Music FOR THE USE OF General anto Special g>tubents of ifflussic PERCY GOETSCHIUS, Mus. Doc. (Royal Wiirttemberg Professor) AUTHOR OF "The Material Used in Musical Composition," "The Theory and Practice of Tone-Relations," "The Homophonic Forms of Musical Composition" "Models of the Principal Musical Forms," "Exer- cises in Melody-Writing," etc. Price, net, $3.00 NEW YORK G. SCHIRMER, INC. Copyright, 1902 Bv G. SCHIRMER, INC. Printed in the U. S. A, DEDICATED TO HORATIO W. PARKER IN CORDIAL RECOGNITION OF HIS ACHIEVEMENTS" IN THE SERIOUS FORMS OF MUSICAL WRITING. PREFACE. This book is a sequel to the Homophonic Forms, and the system pursued in its preparation corresponds in every detail to that of the latter. Experience in practical teaching has confirmed the author's belief that no further preparation for the exercise of contrapuntal writing is necessary than the course of harmony given in the Material used in Musical Composition (or any equally exhaustive treatise), together with the course of study prescribed in the Homophonic Forms. But these courses, especially that in harmony, must be exceedingly thorough ; two years of diligent application to Material is by no means too much, pos- sibly not enough, for the acquirement of the only basis upon which practical contrapuntal facility can rest, naturally and securely. .Nevertheless, the first Division of the present book is devoted to the specific details of contrapuntal discipline, partly because of their inseparable bearing upon polyphonic form, and partly as a concession, — for the benefit of students not familiar with the method of harmonic discipline peculiar to the Material. The other Divisions owe their design to the author's conviction that the quickest and surest means of acquiring contrapuntal skill consists in the practical application of the contrapuntal method to the composition of polyphonic forms. Hence the title of the book. Therefore, this volume, like the preceding, " undertakes no more than the systematic enumeration and exhaustive explanation of all the formal designs and methods of structural treatment in the polyphonic domain of music composition, as revealed in classic or standard writings." i Further, " the student must regard the conscientious analysis of all the carefully collected references, as a very significant and distinctly essential part of his study." On the other hand, it will probably not be necessary for every student to do all of each Exercise. The tasks have been made extremely comprehensive, not because they are indispensable, but rather in order to meet the wants of every class of students. vi PREFACE. The following works, to which constant and vital reference is made, should be owned by the student : Of Bach, the Well-tempered Clavichord, Vols. I and II ; the 2- and 3-voice Inventions ; the English Suites ; the Organ Compositions (Peters compl. ed.), Vols. II, III, IV, V, and VI. Of Mendelssohn, Pfte. Works, op. 35 and op. 7 ; Organ Composi- tions, op. 37 and op. 65. Besides these, frequent reference is made to — Bach, The Art of Fugue, French Suites, Partitas, and other clavichord works ; Handel, Clavichord Suites ; Klengel, 48 Canons and Fugues ; And Oratorios and similar choral works of Handel, Mendelssohn, Bach, Beethoven, Brahms, etc. These and all other cited compositions may be obtained, for inspection at least, at any large music store. Like its predecessor, this book is designed not only for the practical composer, but also for the general music-student. The latter, while studying and analyzing with the same thoroughness as the special student, will simply omit the prescribed Exercises. PERCY GOETSCHIUS. Boston, Mass., September, 1902. TABLE OF CONTENTS. (The figures m parentheses refer to paragraphs.) ' DIVISION ONE. FUNDAMENTAL PRINCIPLES OF 2-VOICE POLYPHONY. PAGE Chapter I. The Conduct of the Single Melodic Part 1 Conjunct movement (1, 2). Disjunct movement (3, 4, 5). Natural and acquired tendencies (6). Repetitions (8). Ties (9). Rests (10). Harmonic influence (11). Minor (12). Summary (13). Exercise 1. Chapter II. Association of Two Melodic Parts 19 Essential tones (14,15). Exercise 2. Unessential tones (16, 17). Diatonic harmony (18). Chromatic harmony (i8,f). Exercises 3 and 4. Modulation (19). Notation of minor (20). Summary (21). Ex- ercise j. Chapter III. Rhythmic Relation of the Melodic Parts 55 Exercise 6. Chapter IV. Various Modes of Imitation 61 Strict imitation (26). Free imitation (27). Unessential melodic changes (28). Essential melodic changes (29). Unessential rhythmic changes (30). Essential rhythmic changes (31). Complex forms (32). Miscellaneous (33). The contrapuntal associate (34). The stretto (36). Exercises 7, 8, 9, and 10. DIVISION TWO. THE INVENTION -FORMS. Chapter V. The Two-voice Invention 96 Structural factors: Motive, imitations, counterpoint, episodes (38). Sectional form (39). The first section (40). Influence of harmonic bent; episodes; sequence; unusual species of imitation (41). Exercise 11. The second section (42). Exercise 12. The third (as final) sec- tion (43). Additional sections (44). Exercise 13. The Invention in 2-Part Song-form (45). Primary grade (46). Genuine 2-Part form; Part I (47) ; Part II (48). Exercise 14.. The Invention in Three-Part Song-form ; primary grade (49). Genuine 3-Part form (50). Exer- cise ij. The "Gigue" (51). Two or more motives (52). The Lyric Invention (53). Student's attitude toward the prescribed tasks (54). Exercise 16. The natural species of Double-counterpoint (55-58). Exercise 17. Chapter VI. Rules of Three- voice Polyphony 136 Association of 3 parts (59). Details of 3-voice Polyphony (61-63). Leading part (64). Summary (65). Exercise 18. Chapter VII. The Three-voice Invention 146 Sectional form (66). First section (67). Exercise 19. The remain- ing sections (68). Exercise 20. Other structural designs: 2-Part Song-form (69a, i) ; Gigue-form (69^) ; 3-Part Song-form (6<)d, e) ; Vlll CONTENTS. FAGB animated counter-motive in Part II (70); Song-form with Trio (71). Exercise 21. Distinctions of style (72). Exceptional species : Inven- tion in Contrary motion (73a) ; independent lower part (73*). Exer- cise 22. Chapter VIII. The Invention for More than Three Voices . . . .164 Details of 4-voice Polyphony (75). The 4-voice Invention (76). First section (77). Remaining sections (78). Exercise 23. Other structural designs (79). Distinctions of Style (80). The 5-voice In- vention (81). Exercise 24. Chapter IX. Free Polyphonic Forms 174 Distinction between homophonic and polyphonic forms (82). The Prelude (83). The Toccata (84). The Fantasia (85). Mixed forms , (86). Homophonic forms with polyphonic episodes (87). Exercise 25,. DIVISION THREE. CHORALE - FIGURATION. Chapter X. Small Species of Chorale-figuration 185 Cantus firmus (90). Harmonization (91). Thematic accompani- ment (92). Table of chorales, Exercise 2b. Independent Pedal- part (93). Embellished cantus firmus (94). Motive derived from chorale (95). Independent parts (96). Exercise 27. Three-voice elab- oration (97). Five-voice (98). Exercise 28. Chapter XI. Large Species of Chorale-figuration 197 Invention with chorale (99). C. f. in Soprano (100). Exercise 20. C. f. in Bass (102). In Tenor (103). In Alto (104). In alternate voices (105). Exercise 30. Chorale as Invention-group (106). Exer- cise 31. Chorale as Aria (107). Ritomelle with chorale (108). Chorale-fantasia (109). Exercise 32. Chorale-invention (no). Cho- rale-variations (in). Exercise 33. DIVISION FOUR. THE FUGUE. Introductory 212 Fugue-subject (113). Exercise 34. Construction of the " Response " (114). Real Response (115). Tonal Response (1 16-120). Exercise 33. Chapter XII. The Four-voice Fugue ... 224 The Exposition (121). The first " Counterpoint " or counter-theme (122). Exercise 36. Order of voices (123). Irregular expositions (124). Episode (125). Cadence (126). The Fughetta (127). Exercise 37. The sectional form (128-131). Retaining the contrapuntal asso- ciate (132). Exercise 38. Additional rules (133, 134). Exercise 3g. Two-Part Song-form (135). Three-Part Song-form (136). Exercise 40. Special design (137). Exercise 41. Chapter XIII. The Fugue with Less or More than 4 Parts . . .242 The 3-voice Fugue (138-144). The 2-voice Fugue (145). The 5-voice Fugue (146). Fugue with six or more parts (147). Exercise 42. Chapter XIV. Miscellaneous Fugue-forms .... 249 The Concert-fugue (148). Prelude (149). Exercise 43. Fugue for String-quartet, etc. (150). Vocal Fugue (152). Exercise 44. Fugue CONTENTS. j x PAGE with chorale (154). Chorale as Fugue-group (155). Chorale-Fugue (156). Group-Fugue (157). Exercise 45. Fugue in Contrary motion (158). Fugue in Augmentation or Diminution (159). Irregular spe- cies (160). Exercise 46. Chapter XV. The Doubi.e-Fugue 261 Incipient form (162). Fugue with Thematic counterpoint (163). Exercise 47. Genuine Double Fugue (165). First species (167). Ex- ercise 48. Second species (168). Exercise 41). Artificial Double- counterpoint (169). Double-cpt. in 12th (170). In nth (172). In 10th (173). In 13th (174). Duplication in thirds (175). Double-cpt. in 9th and 7th (176). Other varieties of Double-cpt. (177). Exercise jo. Third species of Double-Fugue (178). Irregular (4th) species (179). Exercise Ji. Chapter XVI. The Triple-Fugue 282 Inversions (181). First species (182). Second species (183). Third species (184). Quadruple-cpt., etc! (185). Exercise 32. DIVISION FIVE. THE CANON. Introductory 288 Leader and Follower (187). Chapter XVII. The Round-canon . 289 Definitions and rules (188). Lyric canon (189). Exercise jj. Chapter XVIII. The Progressive Canon 293 2-voice canon, in the 8ve, Unaccompanied (191). In the 2d (193). In the 7th (194). In the 3d and 6th (195). In the 5th and 4th (196). Exercise 34. In Contrary motion (197). In Augmentation (198). In Diminution (199). Exercise 55. Chapter XIX. Two-voice Canon, Accompanied 302 Instrumental (200). Auxiliary part (201). Significance of canon- form (202). Canon as conventional style (203). Exercise 56. Two- voice canon, Vocal, Accompanied (204). Exercise 57. Chapter XX. Canon for More than Two Parts . 309 Three-voice canon (205). In Contrary motion (206). Four-voice canon (207). Exercise 58. Chapter XXI. Double-Canon, etc 313 Definitions (208). Triple-canon (209). Exercise jg. Chapter XXII. Canon as Chorale-elaboration 315 Chorale as canon (210). Accompanied (211). Canon with chorale (212). Exercise 60. " Canonic " compositions (213). APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. INTRODUCTION. The most concise definition that may be given of good and correct Polyphony is, that it consists in the harmonious association of INDIVIDUALLY PERFECT and COORDINATE, BUT INDEPENDENT, MELODIES. Correct polyphonic writing is, therefore, subject to the following three conditions : — Condition i : Perfect Melody ; Condition 2 : Harmonious Union ; Condition 3 : Independence of Parts ; each of which will be successively treated in the chapters of Divi- sion One. DIVISION ONE. THE FUNDAMENTAL PRINCIPLES OF THE SIMPLE (TWO-VOICE) POLYPHONIC STYLE. CHAPTER I. CONDITION 1 : " PERFECT MELODY." THE CONDUCT OF THE SINGLE PART OR VOICE* Conjunct Movement. 1. The first and most comprehensive rule of polyphonic melody is, to lead each single part as smoothly and evenly as possible. Conjunct movement (that is, stepwise ascending or descending progression along the line of the prevailing scale) is therefore preferable to disjunct movement (that is, by leap or skip), as a general rule. Disjunct move- ment is, however, by no means undesirable, but should be used in moderate proportion to the stepwise movement. * An exhaustive exposition of the fundamental laws of melodic progression may be found in the author's " Exercises in Melody-Writing." Thorough understanding of Chapters I-V of that book will facilitate (possibly supersede) the study of the above chapter. I APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 2. Bach. mmm & mm Ex. 1. -•— *- -XT See par. 6. 2. Diatonic conjunct movement is preferable to chromatic. a. Chromatic successions are least objectionable in slow movement (with tones whose time-values represent whole beats, or at least half- beats) ; and are generally better in ascending than in descending direction, especially when moderately rapid. Disj. Conj Disj. . Conj. Ex. i 1. (Ex. 83-10.) w 2-E^=a 3e* % Chrom. t3=t -■¥ 1 etc. Chrom. 2. Lento, & ^f---MM ^ -M--Fi) Bach. i^BBE Chrom. See also Ex. 82-1 ; 26-5. b. A chromatic succession should, if possible, be approached in the corresponding direction ; and requires, almost certainly, to continue in the same direction. For illustration : /*/*/< \\,\ \ /* /* \ Possible.- ^MEgs& jj^jE ^^i a Ex. 3. ?fe SjBp^P Upward. Downward. ?? ??? (See par. 5.) c. It is generally unmelodious to separate a chromatic succession by inserting an intermediate neighboring-tone, in quick movement : Better. ■ H— I ' -^ — 1 r^: >- Ex. Disjunct Movement. 3. Disjunct progressions are qualified as narrow leaps (major or minor 3rds), and wide leaps (all skips beyond the intervals of the 3rd). Permissible Skips. a. Narrow leaps are generally permissible. Wide leaps, or leaps in general, are always permissible when both tones are common to the momentary chord, i.e., if they occur during chord- repetition. For instance ; Par. 3. PERMISSIBLE SKIPS. Ex. 5. Bach. ¥=X\ etc. G I- •V - • I = VI 7 - See also Ex. 52-2. b. A skip of any reasonable extent (rarely beyond an octave) may be made downward to any tone whose natural tendency is upward ; or upward to any tone whose tendency is to descend ; — that is, the skip may be made in the direction opposite to that of the natural tendency. (These tendencies are defined in par. 6, which see.) Thus : 1. Ex. 6a. mm £ -F- iin C major or minor. 3+ 4+ an ggpig =«* 5 ii 2. Further : . --*-•- 3. The natural tendency of these active scale-steps may be counter- acted by approaching them stepwise in the corresponding direction (i.e., that in opposition to their tendency) ; in which case they may continue in the (false) direction, along the scale. Ex. 26. i e 7 Bach. 3fc^ m •--0=+- ± m*^^mm ^»-..» N.B. N.B. Bach. B maj. 4. Bach. O 8 7 6 _____ Ff maj. etc. Bach. d min. N.B. N.B. — This is merely an obvious corroboration of par. i, in its broadest application. c. An active scale-step, when approached thus in the " opposite '' direction, has the option either of passing onward (as in Ex. 26), or of turning and fulfilling its natural obligation. But, if approached in the Par. 6. ACTIVE TONES. II direction corresponding to its tendency, it is very difficult indeed for the active tone to turn and progress incorrectly. The most natural ex- ception (possibly the only defensible one) is when mere melodic embel- lishment, or deferred resolution, is involved, — i.e., when one of the tones is a neighboring-note, or obviously an interposed tone. For example : 7 6 7 : j^.jj ii ^gj^aii^.i pg=a Exceptional. *i ) Bach. As a rule, very doubtful.- *2) Bach. N.B. N.B. * 3 ) Bach. N.B. ~~ " ~ ' I i 9 N.B. * 4 ) Bach. 6 5 Sequence. N.B. Bach. • -t*^ ^BEEEfcS -$**$ 4- _^rlZ:r* F maj. » 5 ) EI* S^z C IV- jg>T J=^J=|] etc. Sequence. *i) The 4th scale-step is here evidently an auxiliary (embellishing) tone; and fj is taken, in preference to fj, because of the prevailing C-major key. — *2) Same as note *i). — *3) An embellishment of the Leading-tone a, as in Ex. ga, neatly conducted into a sequence of the preceding figure. — *4) A deferred resolution of both the 6th and 4th steps. — *5) Like note *i) ; Bo is taken, instead of bit, to pre- vent the impression of C major. 7. Care must be taken to avoid any- awkward conditions at the transition from one beat- into the next. In approaching an accented fraction of the (following) beat, with a fairly rapid figure, the latter must be so calculated as to reach the desired point at precisely the right moment, — not too soon (so that awkward anticipation results), nor too late (so that an equally awkward leap is necessary). Supposing c to be the tone to be reached, in a rhythm of four tones to the (pre- ceding) beat; 12 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 7. 1. Ex. 28. I IE (Par. 10.) tsS g^g^l Good. I ££ I SE S Good. In measure 1 the run is faulty because it reaches the c too soon ; in measure 2 it is calculated to reach c too late ; measure 3 is correct. As a rule, after moving stepwise toward the desired tone (at the be- ginning of the next beat), it is necessary to continue and enter the new beat stepwise, — not with a leap. If a leap be necessary, it should be made earlier in the figure, according to the prevailing harmonic condi- tions : «3^ L_l -•- -•- -•- Good. Good. Good. C I ii ^p^s pp^gf N.B. In the last measure, the awkward leap into o is avoided by inserting an accented passing-note ; this is a very common and excellent device. While it is usually better to continue thus, and enter the next beat diatonically in the same direction, there is no objection to turning at the transitional point: 3. (Ex. 9*.) i^s P=i^P= ip =t All poor. Good. •^^^ =P=F3 Good. All good. 8. The reiteration of a tone should be avoided in rapid rhythmic succession. It is, however, entirely permissible in slow movement ; i.e., after a tone of full-beat value or more, — more rarely after one of half- beat value ; always good after a tie. Ex. 29. *=t 2 - Moderato. Bach - He ?? Too rapid. Good. i feas Moderate Bach. ± Good. m Pai. 8. 4. REPEATED TONES. N.B. 13 Bach. — — L 1 1 J I ± • T- T-^T T N.B. N.B. a. Rapid reiterations are justified when occurring several times in succession, especially in sequences : Bach. 2. Allegro. Ex. 3 S;g g8|i^^ i [giEl=gii^i fE^SEg I P^=P— !«-•- ISSHI 3. The most natural remedy, in case of objectionable reiterations, is to leap up or down an octave, — always an effective and permissible progression : ? ? . instead : Ex. 31. m zMzzjz *m ^ ^p^ 9. The tie is one of the most effective devices for obtaining the desirable rhythmic independence of the several parts ; it serves to pro- cure time-values of an extent — and at locations — not provided for by the ordinary characters of notation. The tie extends the duration of a tone from one beat into the next, or, with still more striking effect, from the last beat or beats of one metric group into the first beat of the fol- lowing group (i.e., at, or over into, the accented pulses). a. A long tie — from a long or heavy note, of at least a whole (or possibly half) beat value — is everywhere possible. b. On the contrary, a short tie — as a rule, from any value less than a half-beat of the prevailing meter, in moderate tempo, — should be avoided. Bot h of these rules coincide, in rhythmic principle, with par. 8. 14 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. g. c. As a general rule, the second tone (the one into which the tie extends) should not be of longer duration than that of the first (preced- ing) tone. d. A brief tie, from a tone of less than half-beat duration (see b), is best justified when it gives rise to a Suspension : Ex. 32. I ^3^^ Bach. Tsr.B.i- r or when several such (brief) ties occur in succession, as syncopated form of an entire passage : 1. Sj_; S. _ S. Bach. Ex. 33. m FP=ggg -* — • — h* * — • i l / I Bach. ttM ™r*' i-— ■ ^2 ^tr3T^^ 1 «j r— '1 -1 — r^.—. ^ 1 Mife: etc. X e. After a tie of fairly long duration, the part may progress either quickly or deliberately ; if the tie is brief, however, the, part should pro- gress with corresponding promptness, as indicated at c. f. A tie may be followed : (1) by the same tone (reiteration, par. 8) ; (2) by the next higher or next lower tone (which progression provides for any " resolution " that may be necessary, — for example, in case of a Suspension) ; (3) by the tone a 3rd above or below, either as harmonic skip, involving no further obligation, or as opposite neigh- boring-note of the resolving-tone, in case such be neces- sary. See par. 4a (1) ; (4) or by any still more remote tone, belonging to the mo- mentary chord, — again either as harmonic skip, or as interposed tone before resolution. See par. 4a (2). Par. g. TIES. IS The choice of these possible, and equally good, progressions depends principally (often solely) upon the location of the essential tone required or desired at the beginning of the next beat, and is governed in any case by the rules of par. 7, which see. Given the tied note c, followed in the next beat by c: 1. Given : Solution ( 4 notes to a beat ) : Ex. z 34. h I H =f-F+— h=R— F=F-r— R= h-F-F^=F II: Susp. ( 3 notes to a beat ) : =p=s= I •- f — ^ — m -m-W-'- ThrH^P -*-*-* |=l:|=J=tr± =t=t C I C IV 2. Given: Solution (4 notes): ilN^lfe FP=! zw=*=?=W=i — s, (Crooked.) (Possible.) (3 notes) : l^P^i tt (?) (2 notes) : S 1- i gi 1*=*=0- izt :t»: §^ For itai (s.) exactly the reverse of 2. 4. Given : Solution : ^t?^ (s.f) f ??? I f- ^f 3 **- ^^3Tfep = g ^g^jz^grpz^j (?) ^ jJgagigjE^^g^^ Efrti ci ci 16 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. 5. For X I Par. io. the reverse of 4. CIV 6. Given : Solution : Given : Solution : p- p-,. p^»^^ GV (s.?) 10. Brief rests (3) may be inserted at the beginning (generally only at the beginning) of almost any beat, but especially any accented beat. The rest should not occur, as a rule, after any inharmonic tone (on account of the resolution) ; nor after any very short tone, — occupying the last unaccented fraction of the preceding beat; nor in the course of a beat, in such a manner as to impair the rhythm : Ex. 35. r ^#fj .p^ ?? Longer rests (-1 , X, etc.) are good almost anywhere, but under pre- cisely the same limitations : Ex. 36. i ± weje& r . -1 Bach. BE &E= i *H^= £ -* — I- I Bach. I te * 1 S3 -p«- ^ I i ir » -*- S^ ga^=^> J £. V 1 ^* =•=*= 3=t See also Ex. 37, No. 2. Par. ii. HARMONIC INFLUENCE. 17 11. The influence of harmonic laws upon the conduct of each single part (even when isolated, — temporarily unattended by other parts), is obvious from many passages in the foregoing rules ; especially par. 30, 4, 5a, 6a, gf. The next chapter will demonstrate in detail the manifest necessity of basing the polyphonic complex upon a harmonic fundament, and of regarding the polyphonic style simply as an advanced stage in the manipulation of the self-same original factors of Harmony, — charac- terized by that superior freedom and independence which advanced growth brings. But, aside from the controlling influence exerted by harmonic law upon the co-operation of two or more simultaneous parts, the same influence is present even in the conception and movements of the single, unaccompanied part ; for example, the direct derivation of a melody from a harmonic source, or its dictation by a harmonic purpose, is plainly shown in such motives as the following (all from Bach) : 3^:Pl|p^^ B I IV V- etc. a. I plfe^] W ffiR ^g -*-=*- m s=^=* -+±* I— eV — I — IK a I IV V 7 Ab I IV— V I 4. e # I y — I II VI V 7 I See also Exs. 5, 7, 14, 15, 22, Ex. 30-1, etc. Such evidences of harmonic design are most palpable in melodies in disjunct movement (i.e., with many skips) ; but are more vague in melodies in preponderantly conjunct movement. Hence it is that, according to the rule of par. 1, conjunct or stepwise progression is a characteristic distinction of the polyphonic style of compo- sition, in which the parts are more emancipated from the governing power of har- monic bodies ; the homophonic style, in which this power constantly prevails, being distinguished, on the contrary, by greater frequency of skips, and disjunct move- ment generally. 12a. The above rules apply, with no essential modifications, to the minor as well as the major mode. The only noteworthy addition 1 8 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 12. is, that in the ascending scale-progression in minor the 6th step (as de- fined by the signature) is generally raised ; and in the descending scale- progression, the yth step is generally lowered. See par. 20. b. Further, all of the given rules are most binding in prominent parts, namely, the uppermost and lowermost of the polyphonic complex ; but are subject to a certain degree of license in the inner part or parts. c. All reasonable violations of the rules are palliated (and even completely justified) by "thematic authority," — that is, when called forth by deference to, or confirmation of, any perfectly apparent and rec- ognizable thematic design, involved by the Imitation of a motive or fig- ure (par. 24), by the Sequence (par. 3c), or any other sufficiently obvi- ous and plausible melodic purpose. Summary. 13a. Conjunct movement is almost invariably good. Principal exception, Ex. 27, measures 1-3. b. Skips are good between chord-tones, and justifiable by correct harmonic conditions. Principal exceptions, Ex. 66, par. 4a, \c. c. Any essential (harmonic) tone may be preceded by its two (upper and lower) neighbors. Par. 4a, (1). d. After a wide skip, the part turns, either immediately Or at the second next tone. Principal exception, par. §a. e. Any progressions are possible which represent the successive (or alternate) distribution, in one part, of tones which would constitute two (or possibly more) strictly regular adjacent parts. Ex. 15, Ex. 19. f. The tendency of active tones should be respected, and all " reso- lutions " properly effected. Principal exceptions, par. 6a and 6. g. The direction of comparatively rapid figures must be governed by the essential tone (or first tone) of the . following beat. Par. 7. h. The movements of a melodic part must corroborate some ra- tional harmonic purpose ; especially applicable to disjunct movement. Par. n. *'. Cause for almost any irregularity is afforded by the Sequence, or any other entirely obvious and defensible thematic purpose. Par. $c, Ex. 14. Ex. 30; Par. i2£. Par. 14. HARMONIOUS UNION. 19 EXERCISE I. A. Analyze, thoroughly and minutely, the progressions of the solo part at the beginning of every Fugue in the Well-tempered Clavichord of J. S. Bach, for about S or 6 measures (even after another part may have joined the first). Every move- ment, from tone to tone, and the collective relations from measure to measure, are to be tested and demonstrated with reference to the above rules. B. Write a large number of original melodic sentences (40 or 50), of from one to three or four measures in length, illustrating each rule and exception given in Chapter I., successively. Terminate each sentence upon the first unit of the final measure ; employ every variety of measure (from f to J/), and all the keys, major and minor alternately. Imitate the rhythm and style of the Bach models. CHAPTER II. CONDITION 2: "HARMONIOUS UNION." THE ASSOCIATION OF TWO PARTS (VOICES). 14. The simultaneous conduct of two parts must, naturally, yield a harmonious result; not necessarily wholly, but preponderantly so. The consonant intervals must, therefore, dominate all Essential tones, while the equally desirable and necessary dissonant intermixtures must be limited to the Unessential tones. The fundamental distinction between Essential and Unessential tones is partly a question of harmony, but more largely (at least in the present connection) one of rhythm, or, rhythmic prominence. Hence, the Essential tones are those which represent and obviously govern an entire metric unit of moderate duration, that is, the full beats in somewhat rapid tempo, and the half-beats in ordinary or deliberate tempo, — possibly the quarter-beats in decidedly slow tempo. The essential tones, in order thus to govern their beats or half-beats, will usually appear at the beginning, or upon an accented fraction, of the same ; but not necessarily, as the harmonic quality of the tones (their relation to the momentary chord) is decisive in all doubtful cases. The Unessential tones are those whose relation to the chord, or the beat, render them manifestly secondary to the essential tones. Rules for Exclusively Essential Tones. 15. The consonant, or at least harmonious, intervals which are to govern the association of Essential tones, are of three grades : Primary consonances, secondary consonances, and mild dissonances. 20 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 15. a. The primary consonances are : The 3rds, major and minor ; and the 6ths, major and minor. The quality (major or minor) depends upon the momentary key ; and the choice between 3rd and 6th is dictated by the harmonic demands or preference. They are not affected by the enlargement (through an octave of double-octave separation) to 10th, 13th, etc. These intervals are invariably permissible, at any point, during notes of any reasonable time-value, in practically any order and connection. An unbroken succession of 3rds (or of 6ths), while inevitably har- monious, and therefore desirable in moderation, nevertheless militates against the necessary independence of the two parts, and should, for that reason, not be protracted beyond 3 or 4 (5) at a time, as a rule. For illustration (adapted from Bach, with omission of the unessential tones contained in the original) : 2. C a — d etc. TWZU 3 3 3 8 6 SEE &UeSJ- m ii^^^ :fct ^ 1 etc. r^r r r F- Bfr The complete form of these illustrations is given in Ex. 44, Nos. 1, 2, 3. b. The secondary consonances are : The perfect 8ve, or unison ; and those perfect 5ths which represent strong triads (those of the Tonic and Dominant). The octave is useful, and quite common ; it may represent the du- plication of any scale-step excepting the Leading-tone (step 7), but is best as Tonic, Dominant, or Subdominant ; if it occurs at the weaker steps (2nd, 3rd or 6th) its effect must be carefully tested. The perfect 5th is rare, and always requires to be tested. Neither of these intervals can occur in succession (8-8, or 5-5), nor should they be interchanged (8-5, or 5-8), as a rule, when the tones are Essential. Par. 15. ESSENTIAL TONES. 21 Neither of them should be approached in parallel direction, when the upper part makes a wide leap, — always excepting during chord- repetition. A wide leap in either direction, in connection with the per- fect 5th, is objectionable, especially in the upper part. For illustration : i ±±±a Leading-tone. r r ^r as j 1 j fe± Ex. 39. C major. (10) (10) Fair, Good. if - ? Wrong. v 1 ' in L L « 6 i j^J^J: ??? f^ 5>: J Good. j „ ^ zn, t j_8 6J (_6_ V- See also Ex. 40, B; Ex. 44, Nos. 4, 5. 'JJinV 7 — c. The mildly dissonant intervals, permitted to dominate occasional Essential tones, are : The diminished 5th; the augmented 4th ; the diminished 7 th ; \ b ya Incomplete (Dim< ?th chord) _ the augmented 2nd ; ) and those minor 7ths and major 2nds which represent good chords of the seventh. The diminished and augmented intervals are by no means infrequent; but the major 7ths are very rare. None of these intervals can be used in succession, nor, as a rule, interchanged ; i. e., they should occur only in connection with the primary consonances (3 or 6), or, more cautiously, with secondary ones (par. 15^). They must not be introduced abruptly ; the wide leap, in either part, toward any of them should be avoided, — excepting during chord-repe- tition. If a chord-7th or 9th is involved, it must be properly resolved. 22 HffLJEV COUNTMRrOJNT. Par. 15. For illustration : Ex. 40. ^V ,•- 1 1 7 j n r ^ t f 1 1 I I ! i i Never. mm^ i B. I II 7 N.B. 9 Bach. 1 ps p^E 3 s v m See also Ex. 44, No. z, and Nos. 6-9. d. Additional general rules : It is mainly important that each part, alone by itself, should con- stitute a perfect, well-designed melody ; therefore the rules of melodic conduct, given in Chap. I., must be strictly regarded. And the use of the Sequence, or any other factor which imparts design and purpose to the melody, is of great importance. See par. ijc; and par. 216. Further, a good harmonic result must also be achieved, and for that reason the fundamental principles of chord-succession (detailed in par. 18, to which reference should be made) must be respected. Wide leaps, particularly, are to be tested chiefly with reference to these principles. Exercise 2. ESSENTIAL TONES. 21 It is very difficult to justify a wide leap in both parts at the same time, excepting during chord-repetitions. The two parts should be led, generally, in opposite directions, though by no means necessarily. One part may, at almost any time, remain upon the same tone (reiteration, par. 8) while the other part progresses. See par. i-jf. EXERCISE 2. To each of the following given melodies a second part is to be added, according to the rules of par. 15. The two parts are to be essentially similar in rhythm, i.e., a tone in the added part for each tone of the given part ; with an occasional exception, as indicated. Every tone, throughout, is to be regarded as essential. No modulations are to be made. Each melody is to be manipulated twice ; first as upper part, where it is written, and then, transferred to a lower octave, as lower part. The respective added parts must differ from each other. One staff, or two staves, may be used ; if two, the customary G-clef and F-clef. (Should the student chance to be familiar with any of the C-clefs, he may use them also ; if not, their use should be deferred. It is unwise to add to the already suffi- ciently formidable difficulties of the polyphonic style, the difficulty of learning these unfamiliar clefs. After the former have been fully mastered, the student can quickly learn as much about the C-clefs as their comparatively limited uses in modern composition — Instrumentation — call for.) i E: ±F± * 2 ) * 3 ) -o— i I 71 *i) r ~ s- * * » -s- XT tk. I *2) -f? l*-f^ ¥g BJgSigil m S:3 I 4. tdE^S^Ed I IE* -f -•=±4. i i^M -r~- -w dt=£i E^ £3 ib±= i 24 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 16 ^kmiff^^m^^s^m 8. I IK **t *2> ^ -l^» #^ -r— »-w m r — r ■ K-^SfF il pi ES *i) The two parts need not begin together; if the given melody begins on the accent, the added part may rest one beat ; and vice versa, as indicated in most of the melodies. *2) Longer tones in the given part may be accompanied by two tones (even beats) in the added part ; and, occasionally, two tones of the given part by one in the added part. *3) Close upon the Tonic-octave, or unison. *4) Do not neglect par. 1 5^- . Unessential Tones. 16. The unessential tones may constitute any interval, harmonious or dissonant. But every exceptional interval (not enumerated in the preceding paragraph) must appear as obvious modification of an unobjec- tionable one, — as transient (passing) note, neighboring-note, or sus- pension ; and must be employed in such a manner as to confirm the distinction between unessential and essential tones. That is, the objec- tionable interval must be followed immediately, or very soon, by one or another of the perfectly good intervals ; thus, 4-3-, or 4-6, or 4-5-6 ; possibly 4-2-6, or 4-2-3 ; but not 4-2-5-7, or any similar succession. For example : etc. ••*/ 7 8 Pav. 16. UNESSENTIAL TONES. 25 Concisely stated: some good interval (par. 15) must "govern" the ordinary beat, or half-beat, of moderate duration (par. 14, last clauses). If, for any reason, an exceptional interval governs the beat, the effect will be poor. No reasonable interval-association is impossible, but all exceptional intervals must be palpably unessential, and less prominent than the good ones. The operation of this principle may be tested in the examples which follow, — or in any models of good counterpoint in standard literature. Further, of the two tones which form an objectionable interval, that one which is obviously non-harmonic (foreign to the chord) should gen- erally enter without leap, though this is not strictly necessary (Exs. 12, 32) ; but it must progress conjunctly (stepwise) ; excepting the two leaps of a 3rd shown in Ex. 90 (" double-appoggiatura ") and Ex. 90 (unre- solved upper neighboring-note ); and the " ornamental resolutions '' of •the suspension, Exs. 10, 11. Wrong. - 1. Passing-notes. (+) I =Jz g^ a ^H- rJ— i ^y 1 Ex. 42 -EME Pf . = T^M r ^f = ^=P=? r u 2. Neighboring-notes. (O) Wrong. 3. Suspensions. 4. Per missib le. I"! °r-2 WW *=£- etc. Ill r +? a - 1 2. Bach. *i) These 4ths, though occupying the accented fractions, are all distinctly unessential. *2) Here the perfect 4th appears, each time, to govern the beat ; but relief (apparently sufficient) is afforded by the consonant interval which accompanies it, 28 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 17. *3) The perfect 4th is best justified by constituting a brief tonic-6-4 chord (I2). This is obviously the case here, and at the first 4th in No. 2. b. Each part must progress in a strictly correct melodious manner (see par. i$d). In perfectly good 2-part polyphony it must be entirely feasible to dissociate the parts and obtain a perfectly good and intelligible melodic result in each alone. So important is this principle, that it sometimes overpowers the otherwise rigorous rules of part-association (detailed in par. 15, 16, etc.). That is to say, if each one of two asso- ciated parts pursues a definite and obviously justifiable melodic purpose, they may be conducted with a certain degree of indifference to their con- trapuntal details. In the conscious fulfilment of a broader melodic aim, the mind of the hearer may waive the demands of euphony to a certain (limited') extent. (Compare par. 13*.) For example : Allegro. Bach. Ex. 46. ' etc. ign^^i^i N.B. 9 bV r The lower of these two parts has the original Motive (par. 38a) ; the upper one has, simultaneously, the same Motive in "contrary motion" (par. 29a); — each, therefore, moves according to manifest " thematic authority." c. For this very reason, it is eminently desirable that each part (but especially the more rapid part, in protracted uniform rhythm) should exhibit well-defined and regular formation, i.e., should be compounded of more or less lengthy and regularly recurring symmetrical figures, that impart recognizable design to the tone-succession, and prevent it from being a shapeless, rambling, unintelligible, and apparently aimless^ melodic line. Par. 17. UNESSENTIAL TONES. 29 This emphasizes the importance of the Sequence, without which truly good and intelligible polyphony can scarcely be imagined. But it refers also to all other means by which the evidence of clear form and broader melodic design may be established, and which are quite as necessary as the sequence, — especially at those places where the sequence itself threatens to become tiresome from overuse. The beginner should never employ, at a time, more than three (four ?) sequences of a figure (unless the figure be a very brief one). For example : i Effi i=i Ex. 47. 9Wff= EJ f. ...^«. g _ f ■ *. . f f- - ; -~S:. :trP= *— H N.B. N.B. i^^i^Si^ Bach. ;S3^i ^=P: i ^5 e^ N.B> feH" N.B. The succession of figures in the lower part forms a thoroughly intelligible and coherent melodic line ; but the groups differ from exact Sequence just sufficiently to avoid monotony. See also Exs. 88, 92. d. As stated in par. \$b and c, it is a part of the limitation of the secondary intervals, that they can only appear singly, — not in succes- sion. Thus, perfect octaves cannot appear in immediate succession under any circumstances ; and even when separated by one tone, they are quite as objectionable as immediate octaves, if the intermediate tone is distinctly unessential: Wrong._ 30 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 17. But an " oblique " succession of perfect octaves is generally per- missible, if one of the tones of the octave itself is obviously unessential ; or better, if it is evident that the two parts maintain their respective melodic independence : Ex. 49. Bach. f min. I « 1 I I I -J- '- -i- Ji I. ^p Bach. Bach. A succession of perfect 5ths is not permitted between essential tones, unless one semi-essential tone, or at least two unessential tones, inter- vene. When each 5th embraces an unessential tone, or when one of the tones of the second 5th alone is plainly unessential, the succession is not objectionable. Thus : J* SOa.P^ Bach. j-tz-j^Tj I &=r- f 1 &=5 m Bach. ■7 <* *} 5 I gH I, IV Ic f VI CI 3 V 7 I x el A wide leap to or from a tone that is obviously the Fifth of the momentary chord, must be made with caution. It is generally bad when the chord-fifth forms the interval of a perfect 5th with the lower part (and is taken by wide leap, — especially parallel with the other part). But is harmless : Par. 17. UNESSENTIAL TONES. 31 (1) During chord-repetition ; and (2) When the chord is so inverted that the interval of a perfect 5th disappears : 1. (Good.) Bach. Ex. 50. i^= A- X SB3^^ I 3t±3t -+*■ ah F I- =— -I ??? Good. 5 I I I P I I C V 7 C V 7 I1 *. The direct succession of any other secondary intervals (i.e., parallel 7ths, 2nds, 4ths, etc.) is permissible only when at least one of the tones involved is distinctly unessential, and very brief. Thus : N.B, 7 (7) g Bach. Ex. 51. 2. 6 ( 7 71 6 Bach. tirrrf u£*a'f f^fr ° N.B. ! Bach. §3fH * 1 b I ■ f# VI V I- -ell •V * Par. 4a, (1). f. Partly because of the risk of such disagreeable successions as those involved by parallel movement of the two parts ; and partly because such parallel conduct deprives both parts of a certain degree of their respective melodic individuality ; it appears desirable to lead the parts in contrary directions, as a very general, though by no" means 32 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 18. binding, rule. Illustrations of wholly or largely opposite motion (at the points where both parts move) are found in Ex. 42-1 ; Ex. 44-2 ; 44-4 ; 44-6 ; Ex. 46 ; — of almost totally parallel motion, in Ex. 44-3 ; — of largely parallel motion, in Ex. 38-2 ; 44-7. For illustrations of unusually protracted parallel motion, see Bach, 2-voice Inven- tion, No. 8, meas. 5, 6 ; 2-voice Invention, No. 14, meas. 14-16. See, also, 2-voice Invention, No. 9, meas. 1, 2, 4 (contrary), meas. 3 (parallel). Harmonic Influence. 18. Strict observance of the above detailed rules must lead to a thoroughly acceptable musical result ; but inasmuch as these details themselves are very largely dictated by the principles of harmony and correct chord-progression (without which no style of music can be fault- lessly constructed), it follows that constant regard of fundamental har- monic laws must facilitate the application of the detailed contrapuntal rules. As already stated (par. n), the influence of the original har- monic principles is chiefly exhibited wherever disjunct movement is employed ; but it is never absent, and is the remote power which directs even conjunct movements. The laws of harmonic (chord) succession may be summarized as follows : I. Diatonic (within one key). a. Tonic chords (I or VI) can progress into any other chord of the same key, or of a different key (usually related by adjacent signa- ture). b. Dominant chords (V-V 7 -V 9 - V 7 - V 9 , the indicating incomplete forms *) pass, legitimately, into Tonic chords. Other progressions are, however, possible, through the agency of Inversion (i.e., into inverted forms of the otherwise inaccessible chords). c. Second-dominant, or sub-dominant chords (the II-IV-II 7 - IV **) pass, naturally, into Dominant chords. But their progression into Tonic chords is entirely permissible ; best, however, into inverted forms of the latter. d. Subordinate Triads (II, VI, III,) cannot progress into their respective prin- cipal Triads (IV-I-V) except by inverting the latter. c. The III passes legitimately into the IV or VI ; into other chords rarely, and only upon inversion, as above. * Triad and 7th-chord on the Leading-tone. See the Author's " Mat. of Mus. Corop.," par. 187 par. 198. ** Idem, par. 206, 407. Par. 18. HARMONIC INFLUENCE. 33 f. Any chord may be repeated within the same rhythmic group, but, as a rule, not into a unit which is more accented than that upon which the chord began. This rule, however, is also moderated some- what by inversion, i.e., change of bass tone at the accent. II. Chromatic. g. If the chromatic inflection is employed, any reasonable chord- succession is feasible, subject to par. 2a, and b. The most vital of these rules are a, b, and c, — particularly b. For illustration : *k» m l» • (i- ^SS Ex. 52. 5 (8) (3) 3 (4 2) 3 (8) J±eE|=^^gEi *5 *3) (7) 6 (4) 6 6 (8) F-lbi — ! — i — ! — r— CI- ,V 7 - I V- -IV X V- 1 * -!* •- =e=rf p— • Bach. 3 (6) 6 (5-) 3 (5) 3 (S) if (a) 6 (5) H 1 . i .i i . 3 (a) 3 (5-) 3 1 (II) *4) VI- *V- fLp. Bach. 6 (6) a (8X4) 3 3 34 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 18. 3 - u * 6 ) a (5-) 4+6 3 3 7, 5 (6) 4+ 6 BACH. J; i 53fc 1 ff ;•— "Hlfr I I l «JM a#V 7 I- -C#II 7 (I) V 7 Bach. 3 3 _ _ 3 " j- *i) See par. 4a, (1). — *2.) . See par. 10. — •3) The effect of this semi-essential perfect 4th is moderated by the embellish- ing tone e (par. 170). *4) The ear places the simplest and best construction upon every harmonic effect ; therefore this is more likely to sound like (and to be) a Dominant chord, than the subordinate II. *5) Comp. note *4). In this whole example the harmonic formations are very clear. See also par, 30. *6) The majority of these 8th-notes are essential. *7) *8) There are here two striking illustrations of the rule given in par. 17*. The progression of the upper part, at note *7), is not interrupted, though it collides quite harshly with the lower part at the accent. Compare par. 7. The still harsher collision at note *8) is justified by the sequential formation of the lower part. Comp. par. 13*. Par. 18. HARMomC WFLUENCR. 35 *9) The skip of an augmented 2nd" is justified by chord-repetition and straight- forward part-progression (par. 4 etc. 5. I =»t=i ^ TL-0-M-*- -•- f ^^S^^SSH^ 1 etc. =lf"F I W W^W** 53 ^ 5 ^ 1 etc. 6. Faulty (Ex. 48, 49). 8 8 Harsh. mmm M m •- 1 -4 * f=? 3 1 W -•- -•- s- -m- r (4) It is generally very undesirable to reverse the rule of clauses 1 and 2 above ; namely, to tie a poor interval over into a good one : I «j -■- I. 1 1 etc. I f? T Note. — In some of the solutions in J measure the tie may be omitted at the second and third beats, and used at the bar only ; in ± measure, it may be omitted at the unaccented (2nd and 4th) beats, or, occasionally, be used at the bar only. Such omissions should, however, be made uniformly throughout. The tie must be omitted, further, at longer, tones in the given melody, — for instance, in melodies Nos. 6 and 8, at the second beat of each half-note. Each melody may be manipulated in the six different ways specified in Exercise 3. 40 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 19. Modulation. 19. The rules of harmonic progression, given above, also govern the movements of the parts in modulation, i.e., in passing from one key into another. a. It is always safe, generally necessary, to close each key upon some form of its Tonic harmony (I or VI) ; to pass from this into some Dominant or Second-dominant chord of the desired key, and from this into its Tonic harmony. Comp. par. 180, and \%b and c. This modu- latory formula is the most common and reliable, whether effected exclu- sively by diatonic successions, or involving a chromatic inflection (see par. 19^). It is. least binding for modulation into the Relative key (i.e., the key with the same signature) ; and, of course, it is subject to numer- ous modifications, especially upon the grounds of par. ijl>, — uncon- strained melodious conduct of the individual parts. For example : Ex. 53. I W Following Ex. 52 — 1 : §HE ~-T=t -Mod.- *i) Bach. i etc. ^1 II 2. I Hj-f=f^£ -*-•- ?=*: SEFfE££ Bach. HP =t=p :S Following r- Mod Ex. 52-2 :^ , 2) p^l PS SE dl ■FII- •V- *i) From a Tonic chord of the first key into a Dominant chord of the desired (next-related) one. *2) From a Tonic chord of old key, into a Second-dominant, and then Domi- nant chord of new key. Par. 19b. 3. MODULATION. 41 Bach. MWm m ^gilpis^ . Mod. . P^^ J^^^^^^P^ -I 1- DI GV- -Vlbll V 1 VI V r-3 W Bach. I ft3=j t#- Mod. Mod._ •4) *5) ggiEE EEfcEE^BNJ c I f V I c IV V- *3) From the VI (subordinate Tonic chord), into Second-dominant and Domi- nant chord. *4) Chromatic inflection in Bass. *5) The/f is a raised fourth scale-step only, — not the index of a Modulation; it is evident that no other key than c-minor is present. b. The principal exception to this fundamental rule of modulation is occasioned by the chromatic inflection ; this melodic device, as stated in par. \Zg, if properly applied (par. 2a, b), renders every rational har- monious succession possible and acceptable. For illustration : Ex. 54. 1. Bach. isiiiSiprpie^iH Mod.. _Mod._ *i) *' L ' *2) - gi-v F(I) V- 42 APrLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 19c. pe Bach. I sa # Ex. 41-4. . Mod. . c I IV CI- c I V 1 3. Bach. eftfr f . — • — •- -k'r^ — g- -1— — i^= — ^ ^f=Nii -f-t -i — *- — • ^ Mod. — *)- £ - — 1 — 1 — 11 + 1 H A I (E V 7 VI I) V *i ) In both of these cases the first key is abandoned at one of its Dominant chords, but chromatically. — *2) This illustrates the establishment of the new key through its accented Tonic - J - chord, which stands for a Dominant harmony. — *3) Change of mode, from one Tonic harmony into the other. — *4) Compare note *i). The bracketed analysis is extremely doubtful. See, further, Ex. 44, No. 6. c. Another somewhat exceptional, though highly effective, modula- tory device consists in introducing an unexpected accidental in the course of a part-progression, whereby the essential tone involved receives an unpremeditated chromatic inflection (not affecting the letter) ; or, in other words, a foreign tone is substituted for the expected one, so as to divert the melody and lead abruptly, but perfectly smoothly, into a new (usually closely related) key. Such a " Substitution " may take place at almost any point ; but, of course, only where either tone (with or without the accidental) constitutes an equally correct and natural melodic progression from the preceding ones. It is usually safest at accented beats, or accented fractions of beats, and after a Tonic impres- sion of the former key has been imparted — no matter how brief. The parts must be conducted, after the substitution, in a manner calculated naturally to confirm the new key. For illustration : 1. *i) N.B. N.B. M zS^S -I- Ex. 55. §5: -fe ± f PN^a CI V (C I) d V" r!5 (dV) CI Par. igc. 2. MODULATION. 43 i ^ *2) N.B. N.B. 32 P3 I *=* -•-£—*-•- §=Pf C II- -d VI- V- (dl) -G V 7 rj + Tr- Bach. 4. £=F=f= si Bach. * • 1 *£ =P=gi=p= m± l==r s I 9^§=^ £-- -4= S S c i- (CI) -goV 9 - Bach. =*=¥ iil rf=P= %££^£g=£=2=t k= F fc=f=P A -■- fcJ: ■£*- a^mi £8PE3EjeS gv- -ii- (gf) -c II 7 - -V7- 44 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. igc. Bach. (AVI) A I V ell-I *i) By inserting the sharp, the expected c (as part of the expected I of C major) becomes in the Soprano. — *3) The dp in Bass illustrates the force of the rule in par. \"]b. It is even doubtful that this d> is an essential tone, though it indicates the Tonic chord {expected at this accent) quite forcibly, and thus imparts the appear- ance of suspension-harmony to the upper tones. At all events, whether essential or not, the do is " picked up " again at the next accented unit (4th beat) and disposed of in conjunct movement ; and, further, the whole i6th-note passage is sequential. Par. 2od. MODULATION. 49 d. Inversely, the " descending " form (with lowered 7th scale-step) may be used in ascending also, when the harmony is Sub- (or Second-} Dominant; or when it is Tonic, immediately followed by Subdomi- nant. This, however, is far rarer than the foregoing. For illustration : 1. N.B. Bach. bfi3 M TJ-F ESzzli iN^Stf *i) l^isSSE^^Ki^ m c V 9 - -VI- f- ■IV- i V 7 2. ri=jc :tti a I -V 7 - N.B. Bach. ■IV- *i) In both of these cases the notation is influenced by the coming Subdomi- nant harmony. See par. 20^. e. These exceptional regulations will be seen to corroborate the general rule that the notation of all passing-notes usually conforms to the scale represented by the chord upon the momentary beat, — or by the chord upon the next-following beat (if near enough to be affected by the latter rather than by its own beat). Illustrations are very numerous, in classic writings, of this rational principle of defining the notation of all passing-notes which fall within the limits of a certain chord, as if that chord were, for the time being, a " Tonic " chord. Apparently, it is most commonly the coming chord that exercises this dominating power. Exceptions are found, where the influence of the momentary chord is weighty enough to over- power that of the coming one ; and, further, at cadences and other points of separa- tion (alluded to in par. 19^), where abrupt effects are desired. So APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 2oe. General illustrations : l. Ex. 61. M ^£.& Mozart. -3 V R/ Allegro. N.B. ^ £4 - S3 _T"*N.B Pf 1 SI 1 F I- -IV- 3Efc^! N.B. F V ■dV- 3. i 13E d min. ( Asc.) SE53 jffcfr bb min. (Desc.) M* ip= *f^g =t ^¥=5= __^_____ d I- ■F IVt>- =£ Brahms. -£=t?i ^ C maj. fe C maj. (Lowered 6th scale-step.) C maj. ^^m v- -C V 9 l7- *i) There is scarcely sufficient proof that a genuine, decisive modulation from F into & is here being made ; the distinctive tones («b and «lt) are so unessential in effect, that they do not appear to cancel the prevalent /?-major impression. The Par. 2of. MODULATION. Si m, and ei, near the end of each measure, are chosen to blend with the scale-quality of the coming chord. The «b on the second beat of the measure conforms to the momentary chord. *2) This whole measure is, more than likely, the Tonic harmony of F ; the letters * and c are so inflected as to blend with the coming aT-minor chord ; but * and V I IV ell V *i) The chord upon this beat is manifestly a II (of D major), but, represent- ing e minor, the upper neighbor within its radius is written c B. — *2 ) All of these lower neighbors (marked o) confirm the scale (D major). — *3) The lower neighbor is here persistently the kalf-step, despite the key, and the cb above. — *4) This lower neighbor confirms the scale, — as is the case with nearly all the neighboring- notes in the entire composition (W.- 1. CI., Vol. II, Prelude 2 — which see ). — * 5) Lower neighbor the half-step, but evidently influenced by the coming chord (key). *6) The lower neighbor of the Leading-tone (7th step) is almost always a whole-step. Summary. 21a. In two-part Polyphony, the intervals of the 3rd and 6th pre- vail, and govern the majority of simultaneous essential tones. The perfect 8th and 5th, — diminished 5th and 7th, — augmented 4th and 2nd, — govern occasional essential tones, when they represent rational harmonies. All positively objectionable intervals must be the obvious modification of some permissible interval (defined by the harmony). b. Each part must be so conducted as to constitute, by itself, a. perfect, interesting, and well-formulated melody, independent of its fellow-part. In order to verify this, the student must play or sing his added part alone, after each melodic task is completed. Further, the parts are conducted, generally, in opposite directions. c. The concerted operations of the two parts must be in manifest keeping with the laws of harmonic (chord-) progression, and modula- tion. Principal exception : par. 18/-. d. Smooth and effective modulatory inflections (transient or defi- nite) may be made by the substitution of an inflected tone (by an unex- pected accidental) for the expected scale-tone, at the appropriate time and place. Exercise 5. MODULATION. 53 e. The notation of passing-notes, within a certain narrow harmonic range, is denned upon the assumption that the chord which governs that range is temporarily the representative of the corresponding key (usually as Tonic chord), irrespective of its actual name in the prevail- ing tonaHty. f. Sequential (or generally symmetrical) formations justify any not unreasonable dissonance, irregularity of melody, harmonic succession, or modulation. EXERCISE 5. A. Analyze the harmony and the notation of Bach, Well-tempered CI., Vol. I, Prelude 10 (e minor). B. Fill out the Bass part of the following phrase, in scale-runs of 32nd- notes, as on the first (given) beat ; observing the rules of Notation given in par. 20 (particularly 2oe) ; refer to par. 21.?. i^Ek m 1 s fc* ¥ ? E^F W=f=^ m w 1=^ ^ m * --w- ■j&i a ^i^g^ i m -S *»F — •- i 54 APPLIED COUNTEKPOIiXT. Exercise 5. C. Manipulate the following phrase according to the principle of Substitution expounded in par. 19c (particularly Ex. 56). Any signature may be chosen for the beginning ; and the introduction or substitution of modulating accidentals, in the course, is to be freely practised. The Cadence is to be completed, each time, upon the 3rd beat of the last measure, with the Tonic harmony of the appropriate key : l^iM&^i^ rx m^ (May be done at the pfte.) •-* :etc: ^ISWr D. Add a second part to each of the following melodies, with reference to pars. 1 g and 20, and in the manner described in Exercise 3, namely : each melody to be used alternately as upper and lower part, and the added part to be in a uniform rhythm of either 2, 3 or 4 notes to each beat, successively. A few experiments may be made with ties (syncopation), as showji in Exercise 4. Refer to par. 21, 6, <., d,f. Model. (Mel. No. 1.) fef tft* Jt 0... =i=?c £?¥ t=t=t £ =t= V fe LAli i==F=t ^ ±±i tst w% i =^ EE 3 ±=t 3t -g} & L & fo pE ^^mm ^=f illi isti ffisre (SZ •- \t=5=(: I 1. *i) ^fefe^^^^fey *2) Eli SB r etc. Exercise 5. 2. MODULATION. 55 ^g^P-^-^f^^ii^^i E^fefe^ etc. i * l^^^^lii m ■S-fP- 5. 1 trHH ! — •- 3t^ 6. ^2^3*E^^lfel£gEp|^y 7. I i^spp^^iiB ite • — *- 8. ±3 pi^g^gE^ =jia= sggfg^p *i) Scan the melody first as a whole, and determine, at least approximately, where and what changes of key are likely to be necessary. *2) For 3 notes (f ' j* or |" ' J J). * 3 ) For 3 notes (f " J or f -Tl CHAPTER III. CONDITION 3: "INDIVIDUALITY OF PARTS.' The Rhythmic Relation of One Part to Another. 22. The fundamental rule is, diversity and contrast between the rhythms of the separate parts. But the collective effect of the rhythm of two associated contrapuntal parts is generally that of uniform move- ment. 5& APPLIEti COUNTERPOINT. Par. 22a. a. A certain grade of tone-values is adopted as the uniform basis of motion (most commonly the 8th- or 1 6th-note, sometimes as triplet), and this fundamental rate is sustained with predominating regularity. It is rarely pursued in either pari alone, or in both parts at once, for many successive beats ; but alternates more or less regularly between the parts, — the part not conducting the fundamental rhythm relaxing, meanwhile, to tone-values of any reasonable length. Distinction in rhythmic formation must be regarded as the most powerful means of realizing the necessary independence and individuality of the several parts of a polyphonic complex. Hence, the fundamental law of Contrasting Rhythm, and Alternation. Similar rhythm in both parts at once (as in Ex. 46), or persistent uniform rhythm in either part (as in the examples made in Exercise 3, etc.), militates against this vital principle of rhythmic individuality, and must be used sparingly, as an exception to the rule. For example (correct rhythm ) : ^— I- Ex. SE 63.ES5EE5 S ^P - ^ i nES Bach. in etc. r- See, further, Ex. 44-2 (i6th-triplets at first in lower, and then in upper part). Ex. 52-1, — the rhythm of i6th-notes in alternating parts during two measures; then maintained for a time in upper part alone. — Ex. 52-2, similar. — Ex. 55—3. In Ex. 46 the fundamental rhythm is maintained in both parts at once ; in Ex. 53—2, it is uniform in each part for some time ; both cases are somewhat exceptional, as already stated. In Ex. 54—1, the upper part is uniform, but the lower one- diver- sified. b. Modifications of the fundamental rate of motion, for the sake of variety, in either or both of the parts, conform usually to the laws of regular rhythm ; i.e., comparatively heavy (long) tones should occupy the heavier beats, and lighter (short) tones the light beats. In other words, relaxation to longer tone-values should generally occur at ac- cented pulses, and acceleration to shorter tone-values at unaccented pulses. See Ex. 44, No. 1 (lower part, i6th-notes on beats 2-3, 5-6; the 8th-notes on accented beats 1 and 4). Ex. 44, No. i, the change of rhythm from i6ths to 8ths Par. 22C. RHYTHMIC RELATION OF PARTS. 57 takes place at the accented unit (lower part). Ex. 45, No. 1, heaviest note at begin- ning of measure. Ex. 45-2, fundamental rhythm of 8th-notes, accelerated to i6ths on unaccented fractions of 2nd and 4th beats. Ex. 57-3, fundamental rhythms of l6th-notes, accelerated to 32nds on unaccented fractions. c. Still, as long as either one of the two parts is conducted in uni- form rhythm, it appears easy to justify irregularities of rhythm in the other part. See Ex. 44, No. 6 ; the upper part is practically uniform (8ths), while the lower, near the end, is distinctly irregular. Ex. 47, lower part uniform i6ths, upper part irregular. Ex. 52-3, lower part uniform, upper part irregular. Ex. 52-5 similar. Ex. 54—1, and 3. Ex. 57-5, end of measure 1. Ex. 40, B. d. The importance of the tie must here again be emphasized^ By no other means can an equally effective and legitimate result be obtained, as tending toward the mutual independence of the parts. All forms of syncopation are simply the consequence of ties {actual, or — according to their location in the measure — implied), and there- fore serve the same important end. The treatment of the tie is dejfined in par. 9, which review. An especially felicitous illustration of the tie is given in Ex. 44, No. n. See also Ex. 45-2. Ex. 50-1 (syncopation). In each of these cases the general rhyth- mic effect is regular, and preponderantly uniform, because of the correct ^alternation of the parts, as shown in par. 2 2«. Ex. 64-3 (syncopation). The absence of ties will be observed most frequently in two-part counterpoint of a somewhat lively character and movement, where but little opportunity is afforded for the check which ties naturally occasion (comp. par. 9^). See Ex. 47 ; Ex. 52-1, 2,4. Of barely less importance is the occasional rest, which, in the proper place, and in judicious proportion, is quite as valuable as any tone, often far more so. See par. 10. Its use is exemplified in Ex. 63 ; Ex. 64, No. 2 ; Ex. 91. e. Distinctly irregular rhythmic formations are justified by sequences, or any other form of symmetrical successive recurrence ; comp. par. 2 if. For example : 1. Bach. Ex. 64. U j^.1*"^ ""•» Wl i^ I to*'* ' «" ^^k^^ I ** *l) * 1 etc. g^^ ^mtrt^ 58 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Exercise 6. Bach. Ss-^P^ =r- — ¥-^r-i-\ t-t-H (k )-«—•— J— j — ° *2) 9*8 . CL^ — VT * ■ - 1 — - L -H i « W=s=^=r=lf5 Bach. ^ '.tl a. n^2pt & 1 a afe -• — *- Jt £ -f-F- -t a ^e t=t *i) The rhythmic irregularities here are: the division of the first (accented) beat into i6ths, while the 2nd and 3rd beats remain undivided ; and the division of the entire second group of 8ths, while the (less weighty) third group remains undivided. The self-same irregularities, however, are repeated, and thereby balanced, in the following measure. *2) The irregularities of the first measure are reproduced in the next. *3) The syncopation of the upper part is continued, symmetrically, for three measures. See also Ex. 6A-3, measures 2 and 3, uniformly irregular; Ex. 54-3 (the irregular division of the first beat is sufficiently, if not totally, balanced by similar treatment of the next accent, — 3rd beat). See also Bach, W.-t. CI., Vol. I, Prelude 13, measures 2-4; Vol. II, Prelude 13, measures 1, 2. EXERCISE 6. A. Analyze Bach, Two-voice Invention, No. 7, chiefly with reference to the rhythmic treatment of the two parts. Also, Two-voice Invention, No. 1. Also, Well-tempered Clav., Vol. II, Prelude 8, measures 1-5 ; Prelude 10, measures 23-48. B. Add a second part (above and below, as before) to each of the following melodic motives or sentences. Refer, constantly, to pais. 7 ; 9 (particularly a, b, /, Ex. 34) ; 10; 17* and f ; the summaries, pars. 13, 21 ; and par. 22. N. B. Perhaps the most helpful and important rule is, to look constantly for- ward, mentally defining the tone necessary or desirable at the next accent, and guiding the added part accordingly. 1. Moderalo. inputs S| =pcp -P-S= ±j£l -*2 trt Exercise 6. RHYTHMIC RELATION OF PARTS. 2. Allegro. 59 n j i I i i i r *T1 n 2. Al legro. ^ (tr) 3. Lento. 4. Allegretto ., ft '^^m^m s 5. -4rcdarate. ^^5£ m^ &- *=!£ 6. Lento. i « ^^P^gg|iBigp^ tdrtiii 3P" I 7. Moderate. ^^^K jt±S=ft g p jjllg 8. Jfodemfo. O. Andante. =p|a fParTiy'. | J. S. Bach.*2 ) k»fc « 1 1 I 4-i-hCTi — »^ — i — •- !* 3tt * =i=H«= 2£f PI etc. 10. Allegro. w fgjg^ BfliiS^eg ^— • ^ =t=t=t=t Bach. 11. Allegro. ^g^m^amm^^m 6o APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. *3> *Z*^J=tt }& Exercise 6. Bach. -^-H-3=t=5 1 ifcifc 12. Moderate. f&¥r^ g£ss^gjm&^s^ i< &* T^P» P=S==t :S^ §=5sF±r^ : ^S =S«rt=fr u _ p-^-^ Bach. 13. Moderato. _^iT\ u — ^ ^ Bach. *i) The added part may begin, in each case, exactly with the given one; but it is better that it do so a little after, or before, the latter. Further, the student should make several different versions of each task. *z) After having concluded his own experiments with these last melodic extracts from 2-voice polyphonic passages of Bach, the student may compare them with the respective original versions ; No. g occurs in the 2nd French Suite, " Air," measures 1-4; No. 10, in the Art of Fugue, Fugue 9, measures 8-17; No. 11, in the same, Fugue 13, measures 5-9; No. 12, in the 9th Two-voice Invention, measures 17—29; No. 13, ciavichord-fugue on " Bach" measures 5-8. •3) In earlier methods of notation, this figure P^ represented the modem J j J* whenever employed in connection with triplets (as here). Par. 23. IMITA TION. 6 1 CHAPTER IV. THE DEVELOPMENT OF THEMATIC RESOURCES. THE VARIOUS MODES OF IMITATION. 23. The necessary co-ordination of two associated contrapuntal melodies is due largely, it is true, to contrasting rhythmic formation, whereby mutual independence of melodic effect is achieved. See par. 22a, second clause. But, besides this independence or individuality, another condition, that of thematic (or melodic) equality, is vitally essential to a proper co-ordination of the parts; and this condition of thematic equality is obtained by the device known as Imitation, — a device peculiarly char- acteristic of true polyphonic style. 24. Imitation is the highest of the three progressive species of melodic recurrence. The first grade, (1) simple " Repetition," is the recurrence of a melodic figure in the same voice, and upon the same scale-steps. This has its natural types in the echo, bird-calls, and other preponderantly physical manifestations. The second grade, (2) the " Sequence,'' is the recurrence of a melodic figure in the sa?ne voice, but upon other scale-steps. This, unless purely accidental, implies the exercise of a certain degree of mental power, and therefore enters actively and significantly into the processes of artistic music. The third grade, (3) " Imitation " proper, is the recurrence of a melodic figure in some other voice, either literally or with modifications. This involves the unanimous co-operation of different individuals, and therefore calls forth still more comprehensive faculties, enters more deeply into the artistic methods of composition, and becomes the most vital factor of Polyphony. For illustration : Repetition. 62 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 25. etc. Imitation. 25. The Imitation of a given melodic figure or motive may occur either above or below the latter ; and at any time, — though, as a rule, the temporal relation is regular, i.e., the Imitation appears at the same part of the (next) metric group, so that the arrangement of accented or unaccented units is not disturbed (see Exs. 66, 67, etc.). Further, the Imitation may be effected in a great variety of ways, affecting both the temporal and interval relations. These various modes of Imitation, which constitute an important part of so-called thematic resources, are explained in detail below. The principal general distinction is that made between Strict (or Rigid) Imitation, and Free Imitation. Strict Imitation. 26. An Imitation is strict when it adheres exactly to the successive interval-progressions of the initial figure (or motive). This is certain to be the case when it is made upon the same steps of the same scale, i.e., with the selfsame tones, either in the same register (in which case it is called an Imitation in Unison) or, as is far more common, in the next higher or next lower register (called an Imitation in the Octave) ; possibly in a more distant register, for which, however, no special designation is necessary. a. The 8ve-Imitation, because of its perfect agreement with, and confirmation of, the motive (par. 38a), is the most natural, simple and frequent, especially for the beginning of a polyphonic section. For illustration : Bach. ■ SISZ Ex. 66. P^ 1 *o =t #jpg •1) I— I" P%3> Bach. •2) £ £z3±2 3r m^m s Par. 26. STRICT IMITATION. 63 i 3. -m-P »-*- Bach. -P-0. BACH. \ %=Z #-# 9fcB-=r^; •-P- g^^gig -p-.»- 1*0 i 4. &|£e -Q it *3) Bach it *6) IB *i) The " Motive," or leading figure. *2) The " Imitation " of the motive, in the upper octave (or, in the upper part, in the octave). *3) What takes place here in the leading part during the Imitation, has nothing to do with the latter, and will be considered later (par. 34). *4) Imitation of the motive in the lower octave. *5) Imitation of the motive in the double-octave, above. *6) Imitation in unison (in lower part). b. It is also possible to imitate a motive upon other, higher or lower, steps of the scale, without altering any of the given intervals (i.e., strictly) : Bach. Ex. 67. m i m ii£y-&ffl I -0? '""^ 1— *— r fete. Motive._ Motive., jfclf SOMPjES etc.* 3 ) Bach. itr^- •2) L I 11 *i) Imitation. of the motive in the jtk, above; i.e., each tone of the Imitation is the perfect 5th of the corresponding tone of the motive. It is a " strict " Imitation be- cause the successive progressions coincide exactly, in quantity and quality, with those of the motive. This is quickly verified by observing that the Imitation represents the same scale-steps in B major that the motive does in E major. Consequently, the 6 4 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 26c. melodic and harmonic conditions have remained unchanged (though a change of key is implied), — and this is the result peculiar to all Strict Imitations. *2) Imitation of the motive in the 5th, below, — not in the " 5th reckoned down- ward," but in a " lower part " in the 5th. It must be borne in mind that interval- relations are always determined by counting upward, along the line of the scale, — precisely as the scale-steps are numbered, irrespective of their accidental location above or below a given Tonic. The Imitation in the 5th, of a figure beginning upon d, will always begin upon a, whether placed in a higher or lower part. *3) The Imitation is strict ; but an inflection of the scale, resulting in a modulation from d into a minor, is necessary, to prevent alteration of the original series of inter- val-progressions. c. - But, as seen already in the second of the above illustrations, the Strict Imitation in any other interval than the octave, is quite likely to call for inflections of the original scale, equivalent to more or less pronounced modulations. Thus : Motive.. 1 Bach. 23 1 P — f 3 - fc£ -• f- S §±BE-E *2). i l=E: Motive. *= *3)' etc. Bach. XT. I Par. 27. FREE JAIJTATION. 65 5 E: 1 ^-T-T-Jt=i : $=* ft Motive. _etc. Motive.. l ^aj- E F ,J=a ~tEf = B? Motive.. 7. Motive.. A tf *6 ) ~ 1 «^i M il [ -•-"^-Jkj I J IN If'etc. r l < _ *l) Imitation above, in the perfect 4th (strict, each tone in the perfect 4th — the key changing from G to C). *2) Imitation below, in the 4th (strict, — modulation from C to F). *3) Imitation above, in the minor 7th (strict, — the same scale-steps in f minor as before in^ minor). *4) Imitation above, in the major 2nd (strict, — modulation from C to Z>). *5) Imitation below, in the 2nd (strict, — e minor toy"| minor). *6) Imitation above, in the minor 3rd (strict). *7) Imitation below, in the major 6th (strict, — modulation from C 'to d minor). Free Imitation. 27. The precision of interval-succession observed in all the above examples of Strict Imitation, is, however, too whimsical and irksome to be insisted upon ; and, therefore, such desirable licences, or inten- tional modifications, as come under head of Free Imitation, are not only- sanctioned but required, as conducing to greater freedom of manipu- lation, and to more complete development of the possibilities latent in the adopted thematic material (Motive). These licences may affect either the melodic or rhythmic form of the motive to be imitated ; they may be either essential or unessential in na- ture (according to the extent and quality of the changes) ; or they may even assume complex forms by associating different varieties of modi- fication. The extent to which the licences of Imitation may be carried, 66 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 28. is subject to but one limitation, namely, the ready recognizability of the original motive ; that is, all the essential, or striking, characteristics of the motive should be preserved. Upon this unquestionable recogniz- ability of the leading figure (motive), the argument of par. 23 depends. Unessential Melodic Changes. 28. In Free Imitation with Unessential melodic changes, the modi- fications may affect a. The quality of one or more of the original interval-successions. That is, a*perfect interval may be altered to its augmented or diminished form ; or a major one to its minor form, or vice versa ; etc. Ex. These qualitative changes are illustrated in the following 1. Im. in 5th. N.B. i 69.Eip==8 Bach. ^j-am^tf^f Motive. -Jr- iP t k ' >*~*^ r I I m - ' n unison, Bach. Motive 3. Motive. ive. "^ I i 3=t &g y ^J*»etc. Bach. 1 J— •- * — *- I— T-f— F ^ r—f— 1— P tr m Motive. Im. in 6th. *3) Im. in 7th. *4) 3= Bach. =*=2 ^ 8 -*—•- -r r- r~r r f t + r * Im. in 2nd. A. A. Klengel. *i) In order to be a " strict " Imitation in the perfect 5th, each and every tone of the motive should be answered in that interval, so that the tones of the Imitation Par. 28b. UNESSENTIAL MELODIC CHANGES. 6 7 ■would agree with the Ft major scale, as those of the motive do with B major. But this is not the case here : the first and second tones {b, ct) are answered in the per- fect 5th (by ft, gt) ; but the next tone, d$, is answered by a\ the diminished 5th, hence altered in quality of interval-succession. The same is true of the follow- ing g (answered by dti). *2) This " later " version does not follow the motive as immediate Imitation of the latter. But " Imitation " in the broader sense means not only Reproduction with special reference to the preceding tones of some other part, but the general Recurrence or reappearance of the motive at different times and in different parts, in the design of the whole. *3) In order to be a strict Imitation in the major 6th, these tones should con- form to .the scale of E major (beginning with gt) ; or, if an Imitation in the minor 6th, they should represent the Eb major scale. Instead of either of these, the tones are so chosen as to confirm the original scale ( G major). This illustrates the prime advantage, and even necessity, of occasional qualitative changes ; while infringing somewhat upon the original melodic and harmonic conditions of the motive (comp. Ex. 67, note *i), they tend toward a far more desirable modulatory unity. *4) The motive is simply transferred to the next lower (or 7th higher) step of the same scale (g minor ) ; this involves such changes in the quality of the interval- successions as the concession to the prevailing scale demands. *5) Imitation upon the next higher step of the original scale. b. Further, the unessential melodic changes may affect the quantity of one or more of the original interval-successions. That is, the interval of a 3rd may be enlarged to a 4th or 5th, or contracted to a 2nd, etc. For illustration : 1. Motive ™",.§«£1§3& m? r*^ BUJ-t Im. in 6th. later : *: hh, ^m^ , Bach. m 2. N.B. N.B. N.B. Bach. jlm. in 5th. giissiyj N.B. *i) See Ex. 69, note *2). — Compare this version with the motive, and observe what enlargements of the corresponding original interval-successions occur, at the brackets; — the first tone (bb) is answered in the 6th (g); the next four tones are answered in the 5th ; the next in the 7th ; and the last four again in the 6th. From 68 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 28c. this it is evident that the " interval of Imitation " cannot, in such cases, be exactly specified, because of the changes in quantity. It is customary to define the Imitation according to the interval most frequently used, — generally, though not always, that indicated by the very first tone. •2) Here a contraction from 8ve to 7th occurs. This reveals *another of the favorable features of the change in interval-quantity, namely, that it alters tke harmonic aspect of the motive. In this case the original motive, which represents a "triad " form, is modified to a " chord of the seventh." m *3) =gF3 9 I S EE Motive._ E£ Im. N.B. -t- -#- -*- zetc.z later : m Bach. EH3 m Im. *4> At *3) the triad-form of the motive is changed, both by enlargement and con- traction, to the form of a " chord of the sixth." At *4) it is changed to a chord of the seventh. c. As important as these alterations of the melodic and harmonic form of the original motive may appear to be, in themselves, the par- ticular object of • the unessential melodic changes will be found to consist, chiefly, in facilitating the adjustment of the motive (upon its periodic recurrences) to the prevailing modulatory conditions, or to any immediate or general requirement of the total design. When the motive is imitated in any other interval than the 8ve, — that is, when it is shifted to other steps of the scale than those which it originally occupied, — the melodic conditions are changed, of course, and possibly seriously disturbed. To counteract this, two things may be done : (1) A modulation may be made (into any next-related key), changing the scale in such a way that the new location of the motive shall repre- sent correct step-progressions. Or, (2) The above quantitative melodic changes may be undertaken in the Imitation itself, so that the otherwise faulty successions are removed. Par. 2g. ESSENTIAL MELODIC CHANGES. For example, the following motive, in C major : 69 Ex. 70b. Q_ ——»«■_-, would, if Q_ zE EEEq — |— 1 — |— 1 — I imitated thus —3 ---rJTJ rj — 1 ~ J l~H Bp^E^P^El in the 4 th, y^^ ^ P-ti assume an awkward and defective form, if retained in C major without change of interval-quantity ; but it may be redeemed, either by chan- ging the key : =3=^= 3-: 1= $ mi ¥ (to F major.) (to G major or e minor.) or by altering the size of the first interval : N.B. i -4- m or by resorting to both devices ; if transferred to a minor or d minor, without further change, the result would again be faulty : N.B. n IT TTI, . I I I I I, . but would be 1 1 1 1 j, 1. I m [J, I.. ?? ?? In a minor. In d minor. In a minor. In d minor. Essential Melodic Changes. 29. In free Imitation with Essential melodic changes, the following distinctions of species are made : a. Imitation in contrary motion. Here, the direction of each tone- succession of the Motive is reversed in the Imitation ; i.e., all ascending progressions are changed to descending ones, and vice versa. As these changes, though radical in their nature, affect each and every tone alike, the result is a legitimate uniform modification ; though turned " upside down," it is the same melodic line, and invariably recognizable as such. The term "inverted motive "is permissible; but it is judicious to restrict the word " inversion " rigidly to the local relation of two or more parts to each other, as Involved in so-called double-counterpoint (see par. 55). 7o APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 29a. For illustration : 1. Ex. 71. Bach. Motive. I ^fc Im. in Contrary Motion. IS cetc.r Bach. 1 See Motive.. fas 1— r 3=2 Si Im. in Contrary Motion. The size of the interval-progressions may be in " strict " accordance with those of the Motive, but this is by no means necessary, or even desirable. The "interval of Imitation" cannot be defined as in par. 26, obviously, because the melodic lines are not parallel, but contrary ; but they appear to revolve, in opposite directions, about a certain mutual axis, or corresponding tone, and the choice of this tone is sig- nificant in determining the degree of coincidence, both harmonic and melodic, between the Motive and its Imitation. If, for instance, every Mediant (3rd Scale-step) in the Motive is answered by a Mediant in the Imitation, the several tones of the Tonic chord and also of the Incomplete Dominant 9th chord (the most im- portant fundamental harmonies) will reappear, in reverse order. Thus: Ex. 72. a. Mediant by mediant. ditto. " 9- T he C I becomes, contra- motion : iE *£ and: : becomes 1 I -a- C 8 t~^ i 9 Vn The harmonic similarity is therefore complete. This coincidence may also be defined as tonic note responding to dominant notei for that is the natural consequence of Mediant responding to Mediant. Par. 29a. ESSENTIAL MELODIC CHANGES. 71 The same is true of the corresponding minor (c minor). And it applies to these tones either i/i their simple harmonic form, or embellished, — as basis of an ornate melodic motive. If, further, each Mediant in the Motive be answered by a Tonic note, the result will be: Ex. 73. IE J- g^bfx and ~ £pE|=E become ±=3E^ and =£gnjz= jd=H C I 9 C VI 7 V which constitutes very nearly the same degree of harmonic coincidence as above. Consequently, these two varieties of melodic relation, — Mediant responding to Mediant (= Tonic to Dominant) and Mediant responding to Tonic, — are the best for the Imitation in Contrary motion. These, and other conditions, are illustrated in the following : 1. Motive Im. in Cont. Motion. Bach. Motive._ 35* 5ggT t=T G major. I Im. in Cont. Motion. i-*2) P "l""!""! — I 1 11—1 1 I I 1 f i N.B. i i Bach. ^1 1 • r* 1 >, Bach. Im. in Cont. M. ^^» 3 aS J"1i"[ 1 d£5S I zzTz _Motive.- ■*+■ 4. Motive. Z&p^t- xt. C major. ^1*5 £ #— «- Itp 4= as H«-»- £ffi i=2= /# V APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 29b. Im. in Cont. Motion. Bach. *i) The Mediant (/) in the motive becomes each time again/ in the Imita- tion : i.e., Mediant responds to Mediant ; or Tonic (d) responds to Dominant (a), and vice versa. *2) Mediant responds' to Mediant (or Tonic to Dominant) up to the 2nd beat of the fourth measure, when one of the quantitative changes shown in Ex. 70A takes place. *3) Here, Mediant responds to Tonic. The same is true of Ex. 71, No. 2. *4) Tonic responds to Tonic. See also Ex. 71, No. 1. *S) Might just as well have been d$, but for the desirable modulation. While such melodic coincidences may, and perhaps should, be adopted as a means of obtaining the/irst (and best) version of the Imitation in Contrary motion, it must be understood that when the melodic line or figure of the " Contrary mo- tion" has been once thus fixed, it may be shifted about to any steps in its own, or some other, scale — possibly with such unessential changes as are indicated in par. 28. Comp. Ex. 69, Note *2). b. Retrograde Imitation (cancrizans), in which the motive is repro- duced backward. This alteration so seriously endangers the recogniz- ability of the motive, that it may scarcely be regarded as a legitimate or permissible mode of Imitation ; and, in truth, its adoption in modern Polyphony is extremely rare. See par. 27, last clause. 1. Motive.. Mozart. Motive.„ m Ex. w 75. IE t** Retrograde Im. Retrograde Im. Brahms. tiiz ■***■- : ^mm f[_I u i " y-etc. An extraordinary example of Retrograde Imitation may be found in Beethoven's Pfte. Sonata, op. 106, in Bb major, last movement. The long and unique Subject at the beginning of the Allegro risoluto reappears in reversed order (i.e., backward) at Par. 30. UNESSENTIAL RHYTHMIC CHANGES. 73 very nearly its full length, in the first nine measures of the section with the 2% signa- ture, — in the lower part; the same form follows immediately in the upper part, and then in the lowermost part. It is characteristic of Bach's conception of pure Polyphony, that this device does not appear at all in his " Art of Fugue," a work replete with all the legitimate devices of contrapuntal texture. Unessential Rhythmic Changes. 30. In Free Imitation with Unessential rhythmic changes, the following licences occur : a. The value of the final tone of the motive may be either increased or reduced. This utterly harmless modification is illustrated in Ex. 67, No. 1 ; Ex. 68, No. 2 ; Ex. 69, No. 1 ; Ex. 70A, No. 3 ; and Ex. 74, No. 3, — which see. b. The value of the first tone of the motive, also, may be increased or decreased (by beginning the Imitation correspondingly earlier or later). Neither of these modifications is purely arbitrary, but will, in the majority of cases, be dictated by the necessity of adjusting the thematic figure, at either of its extremities, to the general design, — especially as concerns the harmony and modulation. For illustra- tion : i & Ex 76-EME3: Motive. Im. in 8ve. *r _ etc.. T& T^W '^S^ Bach. later 1*2) 'fw^r^^ feH etc 2. Motive._ I fcaEES ^a^i£&£^ *3 later :F =3 CZ Bach. * -#- *^±^ iii et& »i) The first tone is lengthened, from f g to * g — . *2) The first tone is reduced, from f J to S *3) Both the first and second tones are lengthened, from g to f 74 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT- Par. 30c. *4> Bach. ^Ite m later: A££ #g i *4) The first tone is reduced, and the value of the last tone is also changed. The reasons for these and similar changes are amply apparent in the context of the original. c. More rarely, the value of certain tones in the course of the motive may be modified, — generally in such a manner that what is added to one beat is subtracted from the neighboring beat, so that the rhythm of the remaining tones, and the effect as a whole, is not disturbed. These changes are largely arbitrary, and are made more for the sake of variety and heightened effect, than from necessity of adjustment. For illustration : Ex. 77. 1. M see? 1— 1— ' Li wj* n later : Bach. •3-=-5- sss •1) i 2. M. fet SE s|Ee =3=1= r^- m * — - j- *~ •- *—* Im. later: 3. mmsmm N.B. Bach. ~^—h f-+ a *E 1 Im._ i A$M. *-•-*-=+ t=~ j§§KSf b-ba^t_b M._ N.B. N.B. ~- ,-J— T-J_j__|_4- HHI^^i *2) Bach. later: 2*ft 3= -•— #- N.B. *i) The rhythm of the 2nd beat is altered from f P to p ■_» ; the first and last tones are also modified. *z) The value of the 7th and 9th tones is decreased, and, as no equalization takes place, the second half of the motive appears dwarfed. The first tone is lengthened. Par. 31. ESSENTIAL RHYTHMIC CHANGES. 75 Essential Rhythmic Changes. 31. Free Imitation with Essential rhythmic changes involves the following modifications : a. Imitation in Augmentation. Here the time-value of each tone and rest is multiplied in uniform ratio. Thus, the length of the motive is usually exactly doubled, although three-fold and even four-fold aug- mentation sometimes occurs. This applies naturally to motives in duple rhythm ; whereas in triple time it is often necessary to resort to uneven proportions of augmentation, in order to preserve the original arrange- ment of accented and unaccented tones. This change, though essen- tial, does not jeopardize the recognizability of the motive, for it has usually simply the effect of decreasing the tempo without affecting any of the melodic or rhythmic proportions of the original tones. For illustration : Ex. 78. M ! *l) Bach. later : 4: :-=^ ail Im. in Augmentation. Im. in Augm. 2. M. 1 i 1 Im. in Augm. 5 Bach. 3. *2) ^ Sft=gl- &=*=F E^ ?- r( 2- ~^=fi- m 0-0 Bach. *-fS Im. in Double-augm. -0- .. ■£■• • B % P- -.-. *3) i — -r~ -m- ■ EtEEEEEl3 § =9*&*8 -t- ttS: M. Im. in Augm. Beethoven. ^±f 5. fesi^ji *4) Im. in Augm. *5) :¥ — * M. -1 — -V__ N.B. N.B. i tf~EE£E3 76 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 31b. i i=^ £2 *6) N.B. ^3E Sf^B *i) The principle of Augmentation operates from the accented uni:.;., and there- fore affects, in this case, the initial rest also. — *2) The i-rest contracts te value of the first (augmented) tone from => to p- It is a four-fold enlargement, — sometimes called double Augmentation. — *3) This example of Augmentation also involves a shift of rhythm, — explained in par. 31^. — At *4) the proportions of Augmentation are uneven (three- and four-fold). — *5) Here the proportions of Augmentation aie necessarily uneven ; otherwise, the triple measure would be transformed into "luple. — The version at *6) conforms a little more closely to the prosodic effect of the origi- nal motive. b. Imitation in Diminution. This is exactly the reverse of the above, and has the effect of increasing the tempo without changing the design of the motive. It is hardly feasible in any other than duple measure. For example : 1. Bach. R Ex. 79. §*£ £j^g X Ie=3e£ i M. Im. in Diminution. 2. m& •— M. a Bach. =f3 £=¥ m *s gpggp ussi Im. in Dim. M. m& m Beethoven. later: Im. in Dim.*2) *i) The rhythm of these four notes is equalized by cancelling the dots. — *a) A reduction to one-third of the original values. The prosodic effect of the motive is totally changed. — *3) A fragment, only, of the motive, in still more extreme Dimi nution. c. Imitation in Shifted rhythm ; that is, the reproduction of the motive at a different part of the measure, so that the original arrange- ment of accented and unaccented tones is more or less completely changed. Par. 31c. ESSENTIAL RHY1HMIC CHANGES. 77 In 4-4 measure, a shift of two beats simply produces an exchange of accents, without appreciable change of prosodic effect. This is illus- trated in Ex. 66, No. 1 (the motive begins in the 3rd beat, the Imitation in the 1st); Ex. 68, Nos. 2, 3, 4, and 7 ; Ex. 69, No. 4; Ex. 71, Nos. 1 and 2. In 4-4, or any other variety of duple measure, an entirely new ar- rangement is obtained by shifting the motive one beat, forward or back- ward; or, as is more rarely the case, by shifting it a fraction of one or more beats, so that the original full beats fall between- the pulses, and the Motive assumes a syncopated form. For example : Ex. 80, J^ -•-It w& Bach. „ Largo. later : Im. in Shifted Rhythm. ifeplI"''fei!ilgE^H ii=p: teF Bach. -P- •- • *- later ; li -K>~ Im. *z) 3. AH «_|t H t A Bach. ggglater : Eg ^^ g =EE [ i i5B3aai=^ Ears±t=t *i) The Motive, as Imitation, is shifted forward one beat. Observe the change in the location of the accented tones ; play each version several times, with very marked accentuations. — *2) In slow tempo, this will appear to be the simple ex- change of primary and secondary accents ; but the difference in effect is, neverthe- less, sufficiently noticeable. — *3) Shifted backward one beat. — *4) Shifted forward one-half beat (syncopated Imitation). In 3-4, or any other variety of triple measure, the prosodic trans- formations are still more numerous, because the accented tones may be 78 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 32. shifted to either of the two unaccented units, with totally different re- sults. Besides this, syncopated Imitation is also possible, as above. For illustration : Brahms.*i) Ex. 81. t= X M. i- tf *2) m 3E 9 V V Im. in shifted rhythm. i »,t- i & or : *3> *i) This phrase is borrowed from the pianoforte-quartet in A (3rd movement), merely to illustrate, in a peculiarly effective manner, the two-fold transformation possible in triple measure. At *2) the motive is shifted forward, and at *3) back- ward, one beat. 32. Complex forms of Imitation, such as Contrary motion, and, at the same time, unessential melodic or rhythmic changes ; or simultane- ous Contrary motion and Augmentation, Diminution, or Shifted rhythm, and so on, — are possible and not uncommon. But it must be remembered that the more these licences are multiplied, the more likely they are to endanger', or destroy, that recognizability of the original motive designated in par. 27 as the inexorable limit, beyond which it would be inconsistent to pass. For example : Ex. 82. fe^^ g^^E^ I- is! STZIMiiH etc. '""'■ S^^^SlfSpEi Cont. motion and shifted rhythm Bach. » si- ^3 later: -*-«- t£-«- ill far. 33 MISCELLANEOUS CHANGES. 79 3. zq=^^: z?=«b -•-* I" ;-* ^pe3 i=t H^i later : i ¥ ^BE £=£ Bach. » • -*- eB Cont. Motion and Augm. *l) Imitation in Contrary motion and Diminution; the value of the first tone abbreviated. — A few other cases of slight complication are shown in Ex. 74, No. 2 : Ex. 78, No. 3 ; and Ex. 79, No. 2. 33. Finally, more exceptional forms of modified Imitation are oc- casionally encountered in the polyphony of Bach and others, consisting, (1) in the addition of intermediate embellishing tones ; (2) in the con- trary motion of some single interval ; (3) the transposition of a portion of the motive to a higher or lower octave ; and (4) the partial application of certain essential modifications (i.e., to certain figures, only, of the motive). Such miscellaneous changes are most justifiable when made for the sake of adjusting the Imitation to some legitimate and obvious thematic purpose ; or to facilitate obstinate and awkward, but manifestly necessary, contrapuntal movements. (Comp. par 12c.) And, as usual, they should not infringe upon the recognizability of the original motive. For illustration : Motive. m ex. 5^8=1 I N.B. 1 Bach. 83 1&± 5fE 1 P *i) Im.. u. Motive. SB: later: m P \ an d: E: S(Z (Z fc 2 — ^Fz *=— t N.B. N.B. Bach. P » and: N.B N.B. 80 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. 3. Motive. •— *=! — , — P Par. 33- '^g^m^m^^^^^ later: g^^glJ ^J^&^ l etc. etc. later: Ss ^sfe^te N.B. 0** ZU +4- r ^ - -■ Lfllf^^=fl 6. Motive. ^^M^ ^\ '""-^ ^ N.B. 1 — I Cont. motion. N.B. N.B. and : H # — p- EE N.B. Bach. #-=—•- l|p=S= I IS «i±*=£ =t=r N.B. i & Motive. 2=^=^ -z*- i etc. later: Bach. JS < Z . ± * * -&—& I N.B. N.B. i , 8. Motive. m g< « » »l- "5>- later : i fc^? ^ ¥ v*-fvr^--e^L*- Bach. tp=t U-J — u S^l N.B. I Par. 33. 9. MISCELLANEOUS CHANGES. 8l i *a ISS *=*=* Z* -S *- Motive. later: ^H^i^ii -»-=-#- =E=t P-tP±» Bach. t Im. *=3= tr=t^ =t=B»t =#* Motive. ^j>M~ Im ' modified at each *. * # ^9±§- -Tczzp: ■: *-F - t=t=5t=t Sig^i^m * 1 1 1 , 1 1- ^ggpjfel ., a: ^ j^EsM fsgpg^ Bach. fe^^E^^^S^l ^jlt#*±tz-#lt ^-•-3-q- *5) 11. Motive. i H f±±A—— 4— g=g=g=^: i=q later : Im -■— jt- ~\ Im. *6) Bach. ^ N.B. 12. Motive. XT . # _ * later : *7) Bach. ^a^^ss* *i) Comp. par. 40, 1 (Ex. 9A). *2) These last tones are transferred to the lower octave, evidently to avoid carrying the part too high. *3) A curious example of partial augmentation. 82 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 35a. *4) The motive is shifted one beat forward, and embellished, during three meas- ures. *5) This final fragment is transferred to another part. *6) The motive is shifted backward one beat, and the 6th tone is altered, from the expected g% to d%. Compare No. 5, of this Example. *7) This well-nigh unrecognizable Imitation is complicated by change of regis- ter at single tones. The Contrapuntal Associate. 34. After the leading part has terminated its Motive, and the Imi- tation of the latter is annunciated in the other part, the leading part does not discontinue its movement, or even pause briefly, but carries its melodic line along, apparently independent of the Imitation. This projection of the motive-melody must, however, constitute a harmonious contrapuntal associate of the Imitation, and therefore its conduct must be defined according to the rules of two-part polyphony, detailed in Chapter II. It is usually called the " Counter-motive," or, briefly, the " Counterpoint." 35. To the general details of contrapuntal association given in the second chapter, the following special rules must be added : a. The " Counterpoint " must be a perfectly natural continuation of the Motive-melody which precedes it, — as if the imitatory appearance of the other part were rather accidental than intentional, and did not concern the progressive movement of the leading part. This rule is of the utmost moment in genuine polyphonic texturr For illustration : 1. Imitation. Bach. Ex. 84. M I "• •" ' I ' ' J— etc. *i) N.B. i 4-3- m.^_z5!_ w^s^sms Im. N.B. N.B. Bach. iN I *2) fyfrr-ryr-^j^S^ Par. 35b. THE CONTRAPUNTAL ASSOCIATE. 83 3. M.. stftg -1*3) N.B. *4> N.B. N.B. Bach. # Im. *i) The leading part runs on, apparently regardless of the Imitation (observe the collision at N. B.), in sequential projection of its final member. The importance of the Sequence is here again vindicated ; by no other means can melodic evolution be more easily and naturally effected than by the Sequence. See par. 17c. As to the points marked N. B., see par. lyb and 13*. *2) Here also, the " Counterpoint " is a nearly sequential continuation of the motive itself. *3) The Counterpoint is all derived, somewhat disguised, from the motive. *4) See Ex. 45, No. 2. See also, Bach, Well-tempered Clav., Vol. I, Fugue 5, meas. 1-3 ; Fugue 9, meas. 1-3; 16, meas. 1-4; Vol. II, Fugue 5, meas. 1-4; n, meas. 1-8; 12, meas. 1-8. b. The beginning of the Imitation must be properly adjusted (as regards harmony and modulation) to the termination of the motive. This will influence the choice of the interval of Imitation (par. 26a, b, c) ; may induce the employment of the unessential rhythmic changes noted in par. 30^ / and will possibly necessitate the unessential melodic changes given in par. 280 and b, at the beginning of the Imitation. For example : Im. in 8ve. Ex 85 :[pl* M T=ri • — J — = ' etc. or : *i) w^§* 1 Im. in 5th. r *o wkg& t 8 4 i APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Im. in 4th. Par. 35c. in 6th. ^=£=* ge m , , f f , r- -*->-•■ ■rti r i E®l±3 M. . N.B. *5) "1 ••-^ *=* i S^KT^S CJ I 1 etc. or: N.B. *5) r ? -•■ |etc. t^f *6) 3t=| better: rcr 5= n S3 M._ ^ §£fc ^ W=T Utz. better : U* B Eg 1 etc. *i)*i) The adjustment of the beginning of the Imitation to the termination of the motive is perfect, both as concerns interval and chord, in each of these cases. This is to be expected, when either the Imitation in the 8ve or 5th is chosen ; i.e., these intervals are "safe." — *2) Imitation in the 3rd. It is adjusted well at the very beginning, but leads to a somewhat hasty and undesirable modulation. — *3) Imita- tion in the 7th. This is good, because the chord-connection (harmonic adjustment) is complete. — *4) Imitation in the 2nd. Like the preceding case. -^*5) The size of the first interval is in one case extended, in the other contracted. — *6) The objectionable interval at the outset is softened by shortening the first tone. — *7) Improved by lengthening first tone. See also Ex. 76, No. 1 ; Ex. 77, No. 3. c. It suffices, as a rule, to provide thus for harmonic agreement at and during the first beat or two of the Imitation. The subsequent beats may easily be so manipulated, — either by unessential modification of the Imitation itself (par. 28a, b), or by consistent and careful conduct of the " Counterpoint," — as to achieve good harmonic conditions. Par. 36. THE STRETTO. 85 The Imitation once correctly launched, the succeeding movements of the contrapuntal ■ associate are determined, as already stated, by the principles of two-part polyphony, but with more particular regard of the primary rule given at a above (par. 35). Examine the methods of adjusting the beginning of the Imitation to the ter- mination of the motive, in Ex«. 66, 67, 68, 69, 70.^, 71 j 74, No. 3 ; 83, No. i. The Stretto. 36. The Imitation is said to be in "stretto " when it overlaps a por- tion of the motive ; i.e., when the Imitation sets in before the motive is finished. The section of the motive thus covered by a section of the Imitation is, consequently, at the same time the contrapuntal associate of the latter; and, therefore, the practicability of the Stretto is conditional upon reasonable contrapuntal agreement between these sections. ' This depends (1) upon the choice of Strict or Free Imitation (pars. 26, 27) ; if Strict, — if no concessions are to be made, — then but few Stretti will be found feasible, though the rules of par. i2 meas. 27-31 (Soprano and Tenor), meas. 64-68 (Bass and Tenor). Vol. II, Fugue 2, meas. 14-15 (in Augmentation) ; 3, meas. 1-3 (cont. motion) ; 6, meas. 14-15. EXERCISE 7- A. Each of the following given Motives is to be extended by an Imitation (in the specified interval) and a Contrapuntal associate, as shown in the subjoined model. As a rule, two staves are to be used, and care should be taken to prevent the two parts from diverging too widely from each other, — very rarely more than two octaves apart, usually much less. Each Motive is to occupy first the upper part, followed by its Imitation in the lower ; then the lower part, with Imitation in the upper ; and each time a different Counterpoint must be devised. Review the summaries, par. 13 and par. 21 ; also par. 220/ par. 35 a, b, c. This exercise is to be limited to par. 26a, — Strict Imitation in the Octave. Motive. Counterpoint.. Imit. in the 8ve._ Im. in 8ve.~ and: I Vn ferag ip •-*- . -*--*-"£*-!«- N.B. HeeS^ ^m S^ i M.. Counterpoint.. Exercise 7. IMITA TION. 89 The student is expected to manipulate this (No. 1 ) again, in his own way. Then Exercise (sB (page 58), Nos. 3, 4, 5, 2, 6, 7, 8. Then the following: — 2. Moderate*. i^ 5^ES 3. Adagio. *2) iligllp^ralgl -t? 4. Allegro. £ 41 ssf ^g *i> 5. Allegrett o. 6. Moderato. 3-3 3E S^S s= I g^sa F ai ipgg^^gp^giH *--^=^^ 8. Allegro. 9. Largo. IO. Moderato. m ^gg p^ g p jgja tdt=*=sHj*zt ^ 11. Andante. 12. Andante. ^tf^ g^p^^^^^ifl 13. Allegretto. Bach. 14. Allegro. ffisplgj^lpii ^^Ba Bach. Bach. G Maior. ^i 17. Andante. ns G Major, Bach. 18. I, Allegro, £gfert -IS3 :i^* P i^?±t 90 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Exercise 7. Handel. 19. Largo. Handel. 3^f ^#^ s^ap ^g H] Handel. F Major. Handel. I 22. n Allegro. Padre Martini. -f— #- fcttl Si=^t -T^f=£ "T""! - ^ -' ' ! V 3^: ^i 23 Allegretto Eberlin. 24. n Allegro. Mattheson. 25. Andante. Klengel. 26. ,, Moderato. *3) Klengel. *4) *i) Final tone optional, both as regards choice and duration. — *2) The tempo- indications must not be overlooked ; they may affect the rhythm of the Counter- point. — *3) Duration optional ; and the same in every succeeding case. — *4) The Motive ceases with this tone, whose value, and the continuation of the part, up to the entrance of the Imitation, are optional. — *5) The tie is optional. B. A number of these motives (as specified below) to be manipu- lated according to par. 26^, — Strict Imitation in the 5th. Each motive, as before, imitated both above and below. Especial attention to par. 35* {c) will be necessary. Exercise 8. SMITA TION. 91 M._ Model. Im. in the 5th_ Motives adapted to this exercise : Exercise 6B, Nos. 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8 ; Exercise 7^, Nos. 1, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 11, 13, 14, 15, 18, 20, 21, 23, 25. EXERCISE 8. A. Manipulate the motives specified below, in various other intervals of Imita- tion (in the 3rd, 4th, 6th, possibly 2nd or 7th) ; all in Free Imitation, according to par. 283 and b. The practicable intervals of Imitation will be determined in keeping with par. 35^; and it must be understood that the unessential melodic changes there referred to are not arbitrary, but should be resorted to only as an expedient, when the Strict Imita- tion baffles harmonious adjustment, — or in order to secure better modulation. Review Ex. 69, Note *3), and Ex. 70^, Note *2). And observe particularly par. 28^. Im. in the 2d. m fe E: ^0£ — 1 — 1 1 — % »%» i Model. N.B. i*Eg^g| P— 1— •-! — 1 — I — f-^» SS ^F=r ! H^-»4 t — »H* m^m and: Im. in 3d. t^wmmmim i "3d- r ^P a i± feis^ii For this purpose, employ the following Motives : Exercise 6B, Nos. 1, 5 ; Exercise jA, Nos. 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 16, 18, 20, 21, 25. 92 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Exercise g. B. Manipulate a few motives (Exercise 7 A, Nos. 1, 7, 9, 1 1, 26) with the licences of par. 30*, and, occasionally, c, — Imitation with unessential rhythmic changes. Any interval of Imitation may be used (especially 8ve, 5th or 3rd}. EXERCISE 9. A. Manipulate the following motives according to par. 29a (Contrary motion), in various methods of response (Exs. 72, 73 ; Ex. 74, Note *4) : Exercise 6B, Nos. 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8 ; Exercise 7A, Nos. 3, 6, 10, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 19, 22, 23, 26. B. Manipulate the motives specified below, according to par. 31a (Augmen- tation). Any interval of Imitation may be used, preferably the 8ve, 5th or 3rd. ( if^=£S g^g ^TO P^P -< — -0 Model. *i) ife ^t ^in ist *i) It is necessary, in the contrapuntal associate of an Augmentation (because of its length and persistently heavy rhythm), to check the rhythmic current from time to time, — especially at the outset, and at any heavy accent. For this purpose, employ Exercise 62?, Nos. 2, 3, 6 ; Exercise 7 A, Nos. z, 12, 16, 4, 5, 11, 17. C. Manipulate the following, according to par. 31* (Diminution) : Exercise 6B, Nos. 3, 7 ; <• Exercise 7A, Nos. 4, 19, 26 (10). D. Manipulate the motives specified below according to par. 31^ (Shifted rhythm) : Im , l fe n=^S^^B £*2 I w- •?*±& -v Model. *2) r»-_H»- ££££ **=f*-l T^rrH a~* ": • 1 — — ' — > — h-^-ri " • — *-*-*-. — 1 — \ *l) The Imitation is to be shifted forward in each case, — generally one beat, possibly a little more or less. The vacant space that consequently intervenes be- tween the end of the motive and the beginning of the Imitation, must be very care- fully filled out, with close attention to the rule of par. 35a, i.e., with strictly analo- gous material. The interval of Imitation will be almost entirely optional, depending somewhat upon the current of the "intervening tones." Exercise 10. IMITA TIOAT. 93 *2) In every case, both Darts must be thus carried on, to the next accented beat, — with strictly analogous material. For this purpose employ Exercise 6£, Nos. 4, 5 ; Exercise 7 A, Nos. 3, 7, 10, 12, 18, 22. 24. EXERCISE 10. Manipulate a number of motives in Stretto-imitations, according to par. 36. This work is almost purely experimental ; the possibility of obtaining one or more acceptable stretti is to be tested patiently, in each of the seven different inter- vals of Imitation and at different rhythmical distances. The Imitation will, of course, always be shifted backward, and tested at each succeeding beat of gradually increas- ing proximity to the beginning of the motive. The Stretto-imitations in parallel motion (Ex. 86, No. 1), and in Contrary motion (Ex. 86, No. 6), are both to be tested; occasionally that in Augmentation also (Ex. 86, No. 8). Unessential melodic changes (in quantity of interval) may be admitted, to a reasonable extent. ES: Eg ^^ mm^ ^m^m Model. etc. Ex. 49. #— f*-H-pe m m Good. _Counterp._ £ mm A=T- m *—?- i >— F- m Exercise gD t Note*2). -*-•- K.B. :f— 13* Cont. m. For this purpose use any motives of Exercise 6B, Nos. 2-8, or of Exercise J A- Also a few of the original motives invented in Exercise \B. DIVISION TWO. THE INVENTION-FORMS. Introductory. 37. Polyphonic styles of composition are divided into three classes, distinguished chiefly by the degree of severity with which the principles of polyphony, or contrapuntal writing, are applied ; namely : the Inven- tion, the Fugue, and the Canon. In the Canon the utmost rigor of thematic treatment prevails. In the Fugue, the contrapuntal methods are applied with less insistence, but with reference to certain specific conditions, peculiar to this class. In the Invention, the polyphonic principles (Imitation, etc.) are applied in a general way only, with much freedom of detail ; and with almost, if not quite, equal regard of the broader considerations of form (struc- tural design), and of general external effect. The " Invention " (a term adopted from one of the musical practices of the I7~i8th centuries) is, then, the simplest and least constrained of the three principal classes of Polyphonic Form. 38. The factors which enter into the construction of an Invention are: (i) The Motive; (2) The Imitations or recurrences of the Motive ; (3) The Contrapuntal Associates ; and (4) The Episodic passages (including the Cadences). The Motive. a. The Motive is a brief melodic sentence, calculated to be (and adopted as) the basis and source of the evolution, construction (or " in- vention "), of the polyphonic composition in view. It is the " theme " of the structural task. To this end, it should be simple arid regular in its harmonic design, and faultless in melodic formation ; but, at the same time, sufficiently characteristic and suggestive to invite manipulation, and to sustain interest. For this reason, somewhat striking melodic features may be admitted, and moderate rhythmic irregularities are appropriate, if not lecessary, — hence the frequency of the tie, in effective Motives. Review, very minutely, as a test of these details, the formation of all the Motives given in Exercise 6£ (2-8) and Exercise yA. 94 Par. 38. THE MOTIVE. 95 The length of such a thematic sentence concerns mainly the theoretical distinc- tion made between a Figure (a small group of about 3 to 6 tones), a Motive (at least a measure long, compounded of 2 or 3 " figures," and with a more or less indefinite cadential impression), and a. Subject (in complete Phrase-form, with a definite cadence). Some of the " themes " of Exercises 6 and 7 are, properly speaking, Subjects, though the generic term " Motive " will be applied to all alike, for convenience. Par. 1 1 3 may be briefly referred to. The most important rule for the Motive is, that its first tone, or tones, should impart an unmistakable Tonic impression : — See Exercise 6B, Nos. 2, 3, 6, 8, — beginning with the Tonic note; also Exer- cise jA, Nos. 1, 4, 5, 6, 7, 9, 12, 13, 14, 15, 21, 23, 24. Further, Exercise 7A, Nos. 2, 3, 8, 10, 11, 17,22, 26, — beginning with the Dominant note, followed immediately, or soon, by the Tonic. In Exercise jA, Nos. 19 and 25, the Tonic note follows quite late, but the Tonic impression is clear. Exercise 7A, No. 18, is misleading, as the Tonic note is entirely absent. In Exercise 6B, Nos. 5 and 7 begin upon the Mediant, followed soon by the Tonic, — this is perfectly clear. Exercise J A, No. 1 6, is again misleading, because of the long absence of the Tonic, after the initial Mediant (which imparts the impression of e minor, instead of G major). Exercise 6B, No. 4, begins with the lower neighbor of the Tonic, and is entirely clear. Exercise 7A, No. 20, is misleading, because the upper neighbor of the Mediant, though un- accented, imparts a Br> major impression where F major is intended. The Imitations, or Thematic Components. b. The Imitations, or successive recurrences of the Motive, consti- tute the so-called thematic texture of the polyphonic fabric. Compare par. 38*/, and review Ex. 69, Note *2). The details of this factor are given in Chapter IV. The Counterpoint. c. This term is applied (possibly a little loosely) to all the passages that are invented as contrapuntal associates of the motive, upon each of its successive Imitations or recurrences See par. 34. The Episodic Components. d. To all those portions of the polyphonic fabric where the motive is not present in either part, or is represented by only one of its fractional figures, the term Episodic passage is applied. The necessity for such elements in effective polyphony, as a foil to the thematic portions, is 96 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 39. obvious ; for the monotony of persistent motive-imitation must be re- lieved from time to time. But it is equally manifest that episodic pas- sages should, as a rule, be neither too frequent nor too extended ; and that they must be in close keeping with the character of the thematic portions. ^ For the iatter reason, the episodes are usually derived (1) directly from the motive itself, by using some fraction of the same; or (2) indi- rectly, by utilizing the whole or some portion of any of t he cont rapuntal associates of the motive; or, possibly (3), an entirely new figure maybe adopted, on condition that it be conceived strictly in the spirit of the motive, or of the general context, and tha t it reappe ar at intervals dur- ing the composition. Finally (4), it is also possible that an episodic passage, after beginning in touch with the motive, may, by gradual and consistent stages, develop into a more or less independent character, — though it can scarcely be justified in becoming quite foreign. For illus- trations of the episodic components, see Exs. 89, 90, 91. CHAPTER V. THE TWO-VOICE INVENTION. 39. An Invention may be constructed, like any homophonic compo- sition, according to the design of the so-called Part-forms, or Song- forms. But it is somewhat inconsistent with the polyphonic style to check the current of thematic development with the emphasis necessary for the Cadence of a genuine and well-defined Part ;* and it is, therefore, more common for the structural design of Inventions to consist in a kind of group-form, or chain-form, the several divisions of which may most appropriately be called " Sections." a. The Section of polyphonic designs differs from the Part of homo- phonic forms in being, as a rule, less regular and definite in character ; in terminating with a brief, and less distinct, form of cadence ; and in maintaining less obvious formative relation (with regard to general melodic design) to its fellow-divisions. For these reasons, the number of Sections, also, is entirely optional. b. Generally, each successive Section undertakes a somewhat differ- ent method of manipulation, or the development of some special resource * See the author's " Homophonic Forms 0/ Mus. Cotnp., 1 ' par. 70, par. 72$. Par. 40. THE FIRST SECTION. 97 of the Motive. But, notwithstanding the comparative independence thus effected, it is necessary to preserve a certain measure of logical connection and relation between the Sections, and therefore it is cus- tomary to revert, from time to time, to some structural feature of an earlier Section ; thus the idea, at least, of the Homophonic designs* prevails in the polyphonic designs as well — especially in the Inven- tion, which, in contents and purpose, is more closely akin to the ordi- nary (homophonic) Song-forms than are the more advanced grades of polyphony. The First Section. 40. The 1st Section, or " Exposition," of the Invention, will exhibit, as a rule, all of the structural factors enumerated in par. 38. a. The Motive may be first announced by either the upper or (more rarely) the lower of the two parts ; generally it appears alone, though it is sometimes accompanied by a few unimportant auxiliary tones, the better to establish chord, key and rhythm. Compare Bach, 2-voice Inventions, Nos. 1, 3, 4, 8, with Nos. 7, 13 — the first measures of each. b. The first Imitation, in an Invention, is almost always made in the octave; though occasionally the fifth is chosen, or some other inter- val which adjusts itself readily to the harmonic design, — any interval being permissible. In Bach, 2-voice Inventions, Nos. 1,3, 4, 7, 8, and 13, the first Imitation is in the lower 8ve ; in No. 10 it is in the 5th ; in Bach, English Suite No. 6, 2nd movement of the " Prelude," it is in the 4th ; the same in Bach, Partita II, 3rd movement of the " Sinfonia " (3-4 time). c. The details of the Exposition up to this point have been thor- oughly exemplified in the work of Exercise 7, etc. The next step in the development of the thematic design is, usually, another immediate recurrence of the motive, in the first (i.e., leading) part, as^ re-imitation of the preceding announcement. The interval of this new Imitation is optional, though 8ve or 5 th is the most usual. Meanwhile the other * Idem, par. 73^, par. 81a. 9 8 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 4od. (second) part continues its movement, as contrapuntal associate of the Motive, according to par. 35. See, also, par. 41a. For example : Counterpoint.. M. (Im. in 8.)-- M. (Re-im.) Bach. J Counterpoint. *i) This "Counterpoint" to the second recurrence of the Motive closely resem- bles the first contrapuntal associate (measures 3-4). It is so natural and tempting to adhere thus to the first Counterpoint, thaj the student must be reminded of the monotony it involves, and be warned against making it a rule. The recurrences of the Motive provide amply for the necessary condition of consistency and symmetry ; the equally necessary condition of variety devolves largely upon the contrapuntal associates, which may assume more or less different forms at the successive recur- rences of the Motive. On the other hand, to guard against excess in this respect, it is advisable to adhere to a certain counter-motive during two (or three) consecutive announcements of the Motive, and to return, from time to time, in the following Sec- tions, to such former Counter-motives (i.e., "counterpoints "). See further: Bach, 2 -voice Invention No. 1, first six beats; the second recur- rence of the Motive (meas. 2) is a Re-imitation in the 5th. The same is the case in No. 7, first six beats (Ex. 91). In No. 8, measures 1-3, it is in the 3rd. d. What follows, after this second recurrence (i.e., the third announcement) of the Motive, cannot be determined in detail, but only with reference to the general purpose of the entire first Section, which involves the following contents : — The announcement of the Motive ; The Imitation and successive recurrence, as necessary thematic basis ; Par. 40c THE FIRST SECTION; 99 The exhibition of variety (episodic and otherwise) ; A modulation into the^ey in which the Section is to terminate ; The establishing of this key ; and A palpable Cadence in the same. e. Perhaps the most imperative condition, at the juncture reached in the above example, is that of variety. This may be obtained, (1) by substituting the principle of the Sequence for that of Imitation, — i.e., reproducing the Motive once or twice in the same part instead of the opposite part ; or (2) by dropping the thematic thread, and proceed- ing episodically. The first alternative, the Sequence (see par. 41c), is illustrated in the following : M. (Sequence). M._ -ft—m- g=^E H«— • Bach. 1 mm g gF=P=t j__ L _, *i) -m P= etc. IS *i) The Motive, instead of being again imitated in the other part, reappears as Sequence in the same part, upon the next lower step. The first tone is omitted, in order not to disturb the smooth termination of the preceding announcement. A clue to the impulses which Jed Bach to choose this particular interval of Sequence, will be found in par. 41a. See also par. Apg. *2) This " Counterpoint " differs from the preceding ones. Review Ex. 87, Note *i). It is retained during the following Sequence. See also Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, first 11 measures of Prelude 10; — Motive of 2 measures, accompanied briefly by auxiliary tones ; followed by imitation in the 8ve; then a re-imitation, again in the 8ve; then a Sequence, a third above, — the "Counterpoints" constantly differing, up to this point; then another Sequence, a third above, — the " Counterpoint " as before, but in a lower octave. 100 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 406. The second alternative, the Episode (see par. 38^), is illustrated in the following : Ex. 89. i kE±M* gi|& +d — hd- r*-*-» Jb M. *i) =! (i •- ; F^- *-• B ^g: £& lm._ *££fefcEEE££i* :B= g Episode.*2) , -*- .». Bach. 1 etc. ?=P^ m s^p 5 ^^ M._ *i) In the original (French Suite No. 5, " Courante"), a number of auxiliary tones accompany the first announcement of the Motive ; they are omitted here. *2) The " Episode " is interpolated already after the first Imitation ; it is derived from the Counter-motive in the upper part (2nd measure), which is retained (or imitated) in the lower part in a somewhat modified form, and accompanied by a new contrapuntal figure in the upper part. Examine, also, Bach, 2-voice Invention No. 10, first 6 measures, and endeavor to trace the derivation of the episodical passage; Bach, English Suites, No. 1, " Bourree I," meas. 1-8 ; English Suites, No. 2, " Prelude,'' meas. 1-4 ; English Suites, No. 4, " Prelude," meas. 1-6. Further: Ex. 90. M.. Counter-motive. f^^S^E^ii=^ *F' B M >- p - S?S:EtE Im._ Par. 4oe. THE FIRST SECTION. ,M IOI -f-m- ,-fL JL .p- "^^@if : -U, — "-*-\ — »fe — m-a-F-i — i — I — I — I F a-»- F r F \ f m^ Episode. *2) - 1- ' — I— 3— I— I— M- Bach. S^^gliP *i ) This counterpoint, at the 2nd recurrence of the Motive, corresponds exactly to the Counter-motive of the first Imitation (meas. 2). *2) The derivation of this episodic passage is not as obvious as in some examples, but nevertheless palpably in close keeping with the preceding thematic portions. The figure marked a may be accounted for in two ways, as shown by the two slurs : either as part of the Counter-motive, in contrary motion, or (the lower slur) as imitation of the ending of the Motive ; b bears close general resemblance to the Motive, though the indicated derivation may appear tortuous ; it embraces three beats, and is reproduced in slightly modified Sequence; 4 is derived from ay its modified Sequence, e, is admirably utilized in launching the next recurrence of the Motive. See par. 41b. 102 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 4of . /. On the other hand, these specific modes of obtaining variety are sometimes not resorted to until the alternating Imitations have been extended still farther. For illustration : Ex. 91/ M.. fe^7^^ = ^ fc ^f »f M.. *i) IS -M- ^^ M._ *i) Auxiliary tones (par. 40a). — *2) Up to this point, the development is not only exclusively thematic but consists in the unrelieved alternate Imitation of the Motive. This must be regarded as very exceptional, and illustrates how, even in the polyphonic style, the determination to realize a clear structural design may some- times overrule the more specific thematic conditions of the texture ; it is the preva- lence of " form " over " thematic development." The counterpoint is uniform in the lower part, but is diversified in the upper part at each successive Imitation, except- ing the last one. What follows, as Episode, is easily demonstrated. •3) The conduct of the lower part effectively illustrates the application of the brief rest (par. 10, which review). See par. zzd, last clause ; Ex. 90, meas. 4 and 6. See also, Bach, 2-voice Invention No. 8, meas. 1-5 (four announcements of the Motive before the texture becomes episodic). Par. 4og. THE FIRST SECTION. 103 In No. ' of the 2-voice Inventions, the Motive is announced five times (the 5th time in Contrary motion) before the alternative of the " Sequence" is adopted; and no less than ten consecutive announcements are made before an ". Episode " is. introduced. Further, Bach, 4th French Suite, " Gavotte," meas. 1-3. g. The modulatory design of the First Section of an Invention cor- responds to that of the First Part in homophonic forms, namely : if in major, the Section generally terminates in its Dominant key ; if in minor, usually in its Relative (major) key. Exceptionally, these rela- tions may be exchanged (i.e., the Dominant key from minor, and the Relative key from major). Or some other next-related key may be chosen; especially the Relative of the Dominant, — rarely the Sub- dominant keys. The influence of this modulatory purpose will probably be evinced as soon as the original key is sufficiently established ; generally during the first or second episodic passage; or during a line of sequential announcements of the motive. In Ex. 88, the latter is clearly illustrated ; in measures 7-8 (of the entire Inven- tion) the lines of d minor waver, and in measures 9-10 the transition into F major is complete. In Ex. 91, precisely the same course is pursued: measures 1-3 are in e minor, measures 4—5 in G major. See also Bach, 2-voice Invention No. 1 ; measures 1-3 in C major; during the following sequences of the Motive (in contrary motion) in the upper part, the digression into G major is initiated, and is confirmed in the following (5th) measure. And the remainder of the Section consists, probably, in a compar- atively brief confirmation of the new key, and a cadence in the latter. For example : — 1 *3> Ex. 92. ££ =t ^f^e +E3 *i> (Exs, 87 and 88, cont.) •2) m -+-P- -t*-0- 9* =P=F= wt -t *•- £±t \ — y— \- •-F- l=t t=s=tt ±* M._ jM. (Sequence.). P *i) This example must be studied in connection with Exs. 87 and 88. The " Counterpoint," here, differs from the preceding ones ; it is retained for the next announcement, and then, again, new forms are invented. Review Ex. 87, Note *i). *2) This announcement of the Motive is an Imitation of the last Sequence in the upper part (Ex. 88) ; it is followed by a similar line of Sequences, but not in regular interval-succession, as before. •3) Compare Ex. 91, Note *3). 104 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 40h. i =B^g g g ^=g=S Bach. 9* -i=fC Iti= »= :& etc. 4=t JLzzJz ~=t .-.M.. *4) The " cadence-formula." See par. 40^. *5) See also Ex. 93, No. 2, end. When the Section is extended to an unusual length, the correspond- ing breadth of design will probably induce (or necessitate) transient modulations into various next-related keys ; and the prescribed modu- latory aim of the whole may not assert itself until the Section approaches its cadence. In this case, further, the cadence is apt to be proportionately stronger. See Bach, Well-tempered Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 10, first twenty or thirty measures ; — to be analyzed solely with reference to the changes of key. h. The Cadences of polyphonic Sections are generally, as implied in par. 39a, much less decisive than those of homophonic forms, both in harmonic and rhythmic respect. Still, they assume the aspect of the Perfect cadence (only excepting a few rare instances where the formal purpose demands the effect of a Semi-cadence), and, therefore, the distinctive traits of the former are usually preserved, — especially as con- cerns the lower part (the Bass).* But the rhythmic interruption (or pause) is brief ; so much so as to create the impression of an Elision ;** for the thematic thread is taken up so promptly that the cadence-group of one Section is, almost always, at the same time the initial group of the next. For illustration (from Bach) : 1. *v n.b. Ex. 93. ^ Tt rt 2. ^ SgEJEj -•-#- IS N.B. •4) Conclusion of Ex. 91 B3 ^5 G I- I * " Homophonic Forms," par. 3, par. 6. ** Idem, par. 60. Par. 4oh. THE FIRST SECTION. 10$ Bi^i^ii e G IV 4. V I pBa^s C 117 ^ Hil^P =t= n *i) ^^ESsai =J53: #st^^ c IV II V 7 - 6. -Il 1 ' 1 — 1— r -Ji=Mz I *2) m -p- -»- p— •- -1*— •— "P- ts 5=p= ^=j»- D I V 7 v-' I CIV V I " H ^T" ■V 7 *i) This cadence is much less distinct than the preceding ones, because of the instability of the lower (Bass) part, and its culminating upon an Inversion of the Tonic harmony. But the weight of the upper part, resting for some time upon the Tonic note, is sufficient. — *2) Here, again, the lower part is hasty, though its final tones are strictly cadential. — *3) This cadence, on the contrary, is unusually strong, being the final cadence of the entire Invention. It is permissible thus to add auxili- ary tones, at any cadence. In Nos. 3 and 5 the leaps in the upper part are equivalent to two distinct part-progressions (Exs. 15, 19), and give to the cadence the strength of 3-part texture. — *4) The lower part proceeds immediately with the Motive. The material of the cadence is very likely, in view of its special object, to be episodic, and may even be entirely independent of all ante- rior figures. It is, however, also possible, by ingenious treatment, to interweave thematic figures with the cadence, — especially when more than two parts are used. See Bach, W.-t. Clav., Vol. I, Fugue I, measure 19; — cadence on 3rd beat, during thematic announcements (in Stretto) in Tenor and Alto. See also Ex. 96. Note *i). Ex. 116, last measure. 1 06 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 41a. Additional General Principles. 41a. Influence of harmonic bent. In determining the progressive conduct of polyphonic parts, the harmonic and modulatory inclinations must be respected, and even anticipated. ~~ If the harmonic progression (or, in other words, the choice of the next chord) is self-defining, or perhaps even imperative, — as, for in- stance, at certain urgent Dominant or Second-dominant chords, which demand resolution, — then this, the Harmony, will dictate the movement of the parts ; and, if necessary, the unessential licences of Imitation (par. 28) will be summoned, to fit the thematic intention to this harmonic need. Should the harmonic progression not be self-defining, but optional, — as, for instance, after any Tonic chord, — then the thematic design will supply the impulse and determine the choice of chord and key ; and either the Motive, with or without unessential modification, or the Episode, will be chosen, as appears most convenient. Review par. 11, par. 18, and the last clause in the directions to Exercise 6B. b. The Episodes. It would be very wrong to assume that the above episodic passages (Exs. 89, 90, 91) proceeded from a deliberate inten- tion, on Bach's part, to use just these particular fragments of thematic material, in just this manner. His purpose was a far broader one ; and the episodes, while responding first of all to the demand for variety, are simply incidents in the realization of that purpose. In general, then, the episode is rather an accidental consequence than an aim ; and its details, — chosen, as they may be, from a myriad of equally consistent possibilities, — are influenced by the broad harmonic conditions noted in par. 410, and determined by such comprehensive considerations of Form as those specified in par. \od. It is true, however, that the beginner must work along narrower lines, until his range of experience widens toward the master's stand- ard. And the student will therefore, for a time, plan his episodic pas- sages as more or less mechanical derivations from foregoing thematic premises ; making generous use of the Sequence (par. 41*:) ; not pausing long to choose, but accepting the first reasonable suggestion ; and mean- while analyzing the methods of great polyphonic writers (as found in the given citations) with the most penetrating scrutiny, — thus enrich- ing his experience both by experiment and by observation. As already observed, the number and variety of episodic deductions from ante- rior thematic figures, is practically unlimited, and the difficulty lies, not in finding a Par. 41c. ADDITIONAL GENERAL PRINCIPLES. 107 derivative, but in choosing from among the well-nigh infinite range of possibilities. So that the student who is at first apprehensive of not knowing what to do, will soon experience the still more real embarrassment of deciding what not to do ; and this latter consciousness is, in fact, the most trustworthy sign of progress in thematic musical thought. Fof among so many possible deductions, many grades of excel- lence will, of course, be represented ; some episodic forms will be more appropriate, ingenious, and pregnant than others. But, though the student may for awhile not succeed in finding the best forms, or even fairly good ones, the simple determination to adopt this deductive process, in his labors with the problem of musical composition, is, in itself, meritorious and wise. For such logical processes contribute invariably, at least in some degree, to the unity and stability of the musical structure. And as the student's experience increases and his judgment matures, he will more and more readily and unerringly select the better and best forms. At all events, this dependence is vastly preferable to relying upon chance, or upon that most delusive of resources, personal inspira- tion, for the answer to the vital and constantly recurring question, " What next ? " Eminent and indispensable as the impulse of emotional or intellectual ardor (" in- spiration ") becomes to the advanced scholar and to the master of tone-texture, it is fraught with delusion and distraction to the beginner. c. The Sequence. One of the most essential details of effective polyphony is the Sequence. It is the chief, if not the only efficient, safeguard against the most characteristic danger that besets the poly- phonic style, — that of purposeless rambling, or the uncertain, discur- sive pursuit of a vague thematic scheme. The Sequence imparts at least regularity and symmetry to the operations of thematic development ; and, while particularly important in the more vagrant episodic components, is even freely used in the thematic passages themselves (par. 401?). Hence, the pupil may fall back upon Sequences at almost any time, and drift with them until some higher structural condition asserts itself. The number of Sequences should, however, be limited to two or three (i.e., three or four presentations of the figure at a time, in all). A larger number is permissible only when the figure is small. See also par. 2 if. d. Unusual species of Imitation, with Essential changes (par. 29, 31), are very rarely employed in the first Section, excepting the simplest variety of Shifted rhythm (par. 3 ir, second clause), and Contrary Motion ; S and even the latter should, as a rule, be deferred to the second, or a still later, Section. Both Augmentation and Diminution, excepting when applied to fragments of the Motive, are almost entirely inappropriate in the two-voice Invention. The Stretto is most valuable in the later course of a polyphonic form. 108 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Exercise n. EXERCISE II. A. Analyze the following specimens of the First Section of the 2-voice Inven- tion. The contents of each group or measure must be defined, either as Motive, Counterpoint, or Episode ; and when the latter, every figure must be accounted for : Bach, 2-v. Inv., No. i, meas. 1-7. Bach, 2-v. Inv., No. 8, meas. 1-12. Bach, 2-v. Inv., No. 10, meas. 1-14. Bach, 2-v. Inv., No. 3, meas. 1-12. Bach, Well-t. Clav., Vol. I., Prelude 14, meas. 1-12. Bach, English Suites, No. 4, " Prelude," meas. 1-12. Bach, Partita (for clavichord), No. 2, " Sinfonia," 3rd movement (3-4 time), meas. 1-20 (cadence in Dominant key). Bach, Partita No. 3, " Fantasia," meas. 1-3 1 (largely episodic development of first half of Motive ; cadence indefinite). B. Take Motive No. 6 of Exercise 6B, and elaborate it into a moderately brief First Section, according to the above directions (par. 40, 41). Review par. 22a and d. N. B. Begin this, and each of the following examples, on a separate sheet, leav- ing ample space for the continuation dictated in Exercises 12 and 13. The same with Motive 6 of Exercise 7 A. The same with Motive 5 of Exercise 6B. The same with Motive 4 of Exercise 6B. The same with Motive 3 of Exercise 7A. The same with Motive 4, or n, or 2, of Exercise jA. C. The same with one major and one minor original Motive, — one measure, or a little more, in length, invented strictly according to par. 380. The Second Section. 42. The Second Section of an Invention must be conceived mainly as a continuation of the development of the Motive and its resources, initiated in the First Section. Its structural factors correspond to those of the latter (par. 38), but their arrangement is generally less syste- matic. The general requirements are as follows : a. The new section may begin after the cadence of the foregoing has had its full rhythmic value, or it may follow immediately, after an elision. See par. 40^, second clause. It may begin with an announce- ment of the Motive (either alone, or with a contrapuntal associate) ; or with an episodic member. The former is the most natural and most common. Ex. 93, Note *4). b. A certain degree of independence is desirable, and therefore the Second Section, while adhering to the spirit and general character of Par. 42c. THE SECOND SECTION. 109 the First, may contain some distinctive traits; these may be obtained, either by adopting for the new section some special resource of the Motive (for instance, Imitation in contrary motion), or by inventing more striking and characteristic counterpoints than those of the First Section, or by introducing new episodic members. In this way, too, necessary provision may be made for sustaining interest. See Ex. 94, Note *2). c. At the same time, it is desirable (though not indispensable) to institute some points of manifest resemblance, or even exact confirmation, ~ between the sections, by repro Hur-i ri p; some portion of th e preced ing section, — of course in a different key, and, if possible, with inverted parts (i.e., changing the former upper part to the lower, and vice versa). Review par. 39^. And see pars. 55 and 36. This parallelism of design is strikingly illustrated in the 1st 2-voice Invention of Bach ; — the last five measures of the Second Section (measures 11-15 * tne entire Invention) almost exactly corroborate the last five measures of the First Section (measures 3-7) ; but they are transferred to the next higher step ; the former upper part becomes the lower, and its contrapuntal associate is partly reconstructed, — near the end of the section. d. The modulatory aim of the Second Section is, generally, the'' Relative minor from a major beginning, or the Dominant key from a minor beginning. "InlTworH, the first two cadences are usually made in the keys most closely allied to the original key, that is, the Dominant and the Relative ; in a major Invention the Dominant cadence comes first and the Relative next ; in a minor Invention the Relative comes first, and then the Dominant. Other related keys may, however, be substituted. Review par. \og, and h. Ex. 94. Section II. ' *2) -.- >, - 1* (rV J T~f~ -#-! \-M-l 1-*-! WJ * L 1 *2> (Exs. 87, 88, 92, cont.) 9: ^sZ&fi- <~^ j j 1 1— -^&seflz :=ffl=±Jr±= ^g ^£?jt±i _^ • s ,gj_ -J-3-* * -\ * * . I 2_ j-,J> 1 -Jr w •- l * 1 M._ M.(Sequence.)_ no APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 42d. M. (Cont. Motion.)_ '^^g -P __, M. (Cont. M.)_ «t HJS^^Igi -*-• ^" *6) 2=£ A- *-+- ¥ •s) M. (Orig. Motion.). *-^ *7) ! ! j ! J— | I l l *9) S FJPtt P3p Episode. *8) ^ f M.. M._ ll sail ^ ^n^^^^ 3 ++^^ *i) First review Exs. 87, 88, 92. The Second Section begins, after an elision, with the Motive in the lower part ; it is followed, not by an Imitation, but by a Sequence, thus confirming the general structure of Section I, which was very largely sequential (par. 42c). *2) This contrapuntal associate, upon one tone, is an obvious lapse of contra- puntal energy ; it is a temporary and intentional subjection of " contents " to " form.'' The trill, however, lends vitality to the tone ; and, altogether, it contrasts with the preceding Counterpoints sufficiently to individualize its Section (par. 42*). This is emphasized by its recurrence, in the lower part, a few measures later. Par. 43. THE SECOND SECTION. 1 1 1 •3) Here the Contrary Motion of the Motive appears for the first time. It is reproduced in the prevailing sequential manner. *4) Unessential change in quality of intervals ; comp. par. 28^, c ; Ex. yoA, with Notes. *5) This counterpoint corresponds to one which appeared near the end of the First Section (par. 42*). Review Ex. 92, Note *i). *6) Comp. Ex. 91, Note *3). *7) Here the original motion of the Motive is re-adopted. The counterpoint in the lower part is unusually powerful and characteristic. During this the move- ment into the Dominant key is effected (par. 42^). *8) The derivation of the Episode is apparent. *9) See par. 20c. EXERCISE 12. A. Analyze the following specimens of the Second Section, defining, as before, every element ; particular attention must be given to comparison of each with its foregoing First Section : Bach, 2-v. Inv., No. 1, meas. 7-15. Bach, 2-v. Inv., No. 7, meas. 7-13 (symptoms of an additional cadence in the 9th measure). Bach, 2-v. Inv., No. 3, meas. 12-24 (M. apparently "reconstructed" by addition of 3 introductory tones ; par. 42^.) Bach, Partita No. 3, " Fantasia," meas. 31-66. B. To each of the examples of a First Section, invented in Exercise-n B and C, add a Second Section, according to the above directions. Review par. 41 a. A, t', d. The Third (as final) Section. 43. If the Invention is to embrace but three sections (perhaps the most common number), the Third Section (or final one) tends to regain and re-establish the original key. This will determine its general modu- latory design, which, like all terminal sections of musical form, is very likely to include a more or less positive presentation of the Sub- dominant keys.* a. Whether the Third Section is to constitute the climax of the form, the definite and intentional culmination of the progressive devel- opment within the preceding sections, or not, it is at least more sub- ject than these to the demand for increased interest ; and therefore the most attractive and ingenious methods of manipulation should be enlisted. These may consist in the more striking (possibly hitherto * " Homophonic /'"arms," par. 94^. 112 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 43b. untried) species of Imitation ; or in more characteristic and effective counterpoints, or in more elaborate episodic passages ; or, perhaps best of all, in one or more forms of Stretto-imitation (par. 36) ; or in all of these together. b. Care must be taken, however, not to diverge too widely from the prevailing character of the foregoing sections ; and while it is by no means necessary to return to the beginning and corroborate the main contents of the First Section, as is done in the Third " Part " of the tripartite Song-forms * (see par. 490), it is still desirable to employ some method of confirming one or the other of the preceding sections. Review par. 42 b and c. See Bach, 2-v. Invention No. 1. The parallelism between Sections I and II, already cited, is again exhibited in almost exactly the same manner in the Third Section, which, in measures 19-20, copies measures 3 and 4 (in Section I), and measures 11 and 12 (Section II), — both parts in the Contrary motion of their for- mer contents. c. The final cadence is made in the original key, and, as a rule, with more emphasis than the intermediate cadences, — frequently strengthened by auxiliary (inner) tones. See Ex. 93, No. 6. d. Sometimes, however, this cadence is evaded, by using the chord of the Vlth step instead of the Tonic, in which case a brief Codetta is added. For illustration : M. Section III. ^^^mmm. M._ P~^. 1 * " Homophonic Forms," par. 8i«, 91. Par. 44. THE THIRD SECTION. "3 M..(Cont. M.) jrall. *6) SEES=ljg^lEESE2EfaEEjE3Ef 2^=3 ^ ■-,-,, f^ — 1 — PF—r— 1~ FisFfr VI 1 1 ! 1 ! h ^^» i 1 *l) The Third Section begins, after an elision, with the M., again in the lower part ; see Ex. 94, Note *i). It immediately modulates down into the Sub-dominant key; see par. 43; also Ex. 57, No. 1 (par. 19V). — *2) The counterpoints, in this section, differ almost constantly from those of the foregoing sections ; see Ex. 87, Note *i). But observe Note *5). — *3) This " counterpoint " agrees with the preced- ing one. — *4) Comp. Ex. 91, Note *3). — *5) These two measures exactly confirm measures 5 and 6 of the First Section (Ex. 87), in both parts. — *6) Here the ex- pected perfect cadence is evaded, by substituting the VI for the I (par. 43^) ; what follows is a Codetta, in which, again, the Contrary Motion of the M. happens to be employed, as in Ex. 94, Note *3). — *7) Unessential change in quantity of intervals ; par 2 8 b. Additional Sections. 44. If the Invention is to be extended to four, or perhaps even more, sections, the above details of Section III will need to be modified : (1) With regard to the adoption of the most effective and interest- ing resources of thematic development, which, in this case, are more likely (though not certain) to be deferred to the final section ; and (2) With regard to the cadence, which will be made in some other related key, — preferably in one of the Sub-dominant keys, — thus also influencing the general modulatory design. The conditions of individuality and confirmation (par. 42 b and c) are valid, as before ; while those of par. 43 a, b, c, and d refer, in any event, to the final section. 114 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 45. EXERCISE 13. A. Analyze the following miscellaneous examples, as before : Bach, 2-v. Invention No. 1 , meas. 1 5 to end. Bach, 2-v. Invention No. 7, meas. 13 to end (possibly four Sections in all, as intimated in Exercise 12A; brief Codetta). Bach, Partita No. 3, " Fantasia," meas. 66 to end (four Sections in all, the third one cadencing, very exceptionally, in the original key). Bach, Partita No. 2, " Sinfonia," 3rd movement (3-4 time) ; meas. 20 to end (3 Sections in all ; Section II largely episodic ; Section III very similar to II, but shorter, and in different keys). Bach, English Suites, No. 4, "Prelude," meas. 12-20 (Section II, cadence in original key ; the auxiliary inner tones may be ignored). Bach, English Suites, No. z, "Prelude," meas. 1-55; one long Section, with an occasional very vague intimation of cadential purpose. In meas. 47-51 a Codetta is added, with modified repetition in the following 4 measures. The prevalence of the principal key is owing to the Divisions " that follow. The auxiliary tones may be ignored. The remainder of this example is cited in par. 67, which may be briefly referred to. B. To each of the examples invented in Exercise 11B, and continued in Exer- cise 12B, add a third (as final) section, according to par. 43. Review far. 41 a, 6, c, d. C. To the original examples extended in Exercise 1 22?, add a third and fourth section (par. 44). D. Write two complete Inventions, one in minor and one in major, with original (short) Motives ; the number of sections optional, but neither less than two nor more than five. The Invention in Two-Part Song-form. 45. While the -' sectional " form is most consistent with the char- acter of surh polyphonic compositions as the above, representing the continuous development of an adopted thematic germ, it is nevertheless possible to cast them in the mould of some hotnophonic design, like the Two- or Three-Part Song-forms. When this is done, the treatment of the " Sections " must be modified to conform with the more definite specific conditions of the " Parts." Review par. 39a. This will probably affect the extent, which is usually greater in the " Part " than in the " Section " ; and there is generally a marked distinction in the character of the cadences. As stated in par. 40^, second clause, and illustrated at the beginning of Exs. 94 and 95, the " Section" commonly ends with an elision; i.e., the cadence-chord (or end) of one section is at the same instant the beginning of the next. Par. 46. THE TWO-PART SONG-FORM. US This is more rarely the case in the " Part," which is likely to have a firmer, more decisive (i.e., longer) cadence-interruption. Further, a certain predominance of the structural idea over the de- tails of thematic texture will also be evident, when the Part-forms are adopted, and this will influence the general character ; it may lead to greater freedom of contrapuntal treatment, in favor of the distinctive conditions of the homophonic style ; a more definite melodic character, more regular succession of 4-measure phrase-groups, or even distinct period-formations may prevail. 46. The primary grade of the Two-Part Song-form. This differs, when applied to the Invention, but little from a Two-section design, the main details of which are given in par. 40 and par. 43 ; i.e., the First Section stands for Part I, though possibly extended slightly beyond the limit of the ordinary " Exposition," and ends with a somewhat stronger form of cadence (par. 40^). The Second Part may be a trifle longer ; it should exhibit the traits of confirmation explained in par. \2C ; and must close with the perfect cadence in the original key, possibly followed by a Codetta. This form is illustrated in Bach, 2-v. Invention No. 8. The First Section, or "PK.rt" (already analyzed), embraces the first 12 measures, — a regularity of design suggestive of the group of 3 phrases ; it closes with a distinct perfect cadence in the Dominant key. Measures 12-14 (beginning of Part II) correspond to the beginning of Part I, with inverted voices ; measure 15 is a new episode ; the following 4 meas- ures are a sequence of these, with inverted voices; measures 20-25 are thematic, but new in treatment, involving sequential announcements of the M. in Contrary motion ; measure 26 to the end exactly corroborates the last 9 measures of Part I, but trans- posed one fifth lower, in order to close on the original Tonic. See par. 480, second clause. * See further, Bach, 2-v. Invention No. 10. Part I closes in measure 14 (already analyzed as Section I) ; Part II in measure 30, with an evaded cadence, followed by an extension of 3 measures. The Genuine Two-Part Form. The First Part. 47. In the genuine (broader) Two-Part Song-form,* the First Part may be still more extended ; possibly (though somewhat rarely) embra- cing two sections, the first of which fulfils the conditions of an " Expo- sition," with a comparatively light cadence, while the second one carries out the modulatory design, closing with a strong perfect cadence, — always in the Dominant key (whether major or minor). More com- * Homophonic Farms, par. 71-73, 78. Il6 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 48. monly, however, these details are all contained in one single (long) section, which in some cases (e.g., in old Dance-forms) assumes the character of a Period or Double-period. See par. 45, last clause. The First Part is very frequently repeated; generally with " 1st and 2nd ending,'' the second one with a more complete check of the rhythmic movement. In the following examples the First Part only is to be analyzed, but with great minuteness : Bach, English Suite No. 1 , " Bourree I ; " the First Part bears many evidences of regular Double-period form, parallel construction; it contains 16 meas ures, of which measures 9-12 corroborate measures 1-4 almost exactly. It is repeated. Bach, French Suite No. 3, " Allemande " ; the thematic germ is unusually small, only a figure of 4 tones ; a perfect cadence is made on the Dominant, in the 10th meas- ure, and a Codetta follows ; a very light cadence in the Relative major key, in measure 6, appears to divide the First Part into two sections. The Part is repeated. Bach, French Suite No. 4, " Gavotte " ; the Motive is small (5 tones) ; the form of Part I is clearly a " parallel period " ; it is repeated, with two endings. Bach, French Suite No. 5, "Courante"; Part I is evidently a parallel Double period of 1 6 measures, with sufficiently obvious semi-cadences every 4th measure the Contrary motion of the M. occurs in measure 7 ; the evidence of three-voice writing in measure 8, and the auxiliary tones in measures 1 and 16, may be ascribed to the influence of the structural idea ; they do not affect the actual two-voice style. The cadence is extended by a fragment of the Motive. The Part is repeated. Bach, Partita No. z, " Allemande " ; Part I contains two sections, the first one closing in measure 6 on the original Tonic. The copious auxiliary tones assume sometimes the importance of a third part; but, as intimated above, they do not seem to affect the prevalent two-voice texture ; some of them represent merely a device of notation. Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 10 ; Part I is one long section, suggestive of Phrase-group form; it closes on the Dominant, and is repeated, with two endings. Same work, Vol.11, Prelude 8; Part I, 16 measures long, suggestive of large period-form. The Second Part. 48. The Second Part of a genuine Two-Part Song-form is usually much more distinctly individualized than any " section " of the smaller forms. Its thematic basis may be defined in the following ways : a. Most commonly, the same Motive (that of the First Part) is employed in Part II. It may preserve its original form exactly ; or may possibly be slightly modified or reconstructed (as already wit- nessed in Bach, 2-voice Inventions, No. 3, meas. 12-13; an d No. 7, meas. 13-14). Usually the Motive is announced first alone, or accompanied only by unessential auxiliary tones, as at the beginning. Par. 48a. THE TWO-PART SONG-FORM. l\J In this case (when the same M. is retained) the characterization of the Part devolves largely upon the contrapuntal associates, which may be new and more striking than in Part I. The condition of confirmation still demands fulfilment, as shown in par. 42 etc. ^fcfe EE35 Ttz*; 1 1- -•—„,- t-ir^" PI 1 1 *l) Compare the new M. with the first one (Ex. 90) ; they are strictly kindred, though actual similarity is avoided. Observe, further, that the new M. is introduced during (across) the cadence (par. \ah, final clause). *2) The peculiar notation of a (fl) is owing to Bach's conception of this 2nd beat as Dominant harmony of c minor, with a as ascending passing-note. Comp. par. 20b (and c). 120 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 49. *3) First half of the Motive. The parts cross here, briefly. *4) A few measures later the first M. recurs (see Ex. 98). See also Bach, French Suite No. 3, " Allemande." The M. of Part II, like that of Part I (already analyzed), is very brief; though strongly suggestive of the first M. in Contrary motion, it is really new (as its own Contrary motion, further on, proves). The Part has two sections, separated in the 4th measure ; its perfect cadence is evaded in the 10th measure (by a VI), and a brief Codetta, for which Contrary motion is exclusively utilized, follows. This Part is even more persistently the- matic than Part I, containing scarcely an episodic note. It is repeated. EXERCISE 14. A. Write a complete 2-voice Invention (M. original), in the primary grade of Two-Part Song-form (par. 46). Review par. 41 a, i, t, d. B. A complete Invention (in major) in broad Two-Part Song-form, according to par. 47 and 48a, both clauses. C. A complete Invention (in minor), with Contrary motion of the M. in Part II, according to par. 48^. D. A complete Invention (mode optional), with a new M. in the Second Part, according to par. 48^. A Codetta may be added to each Part. See far. 54. The Invention in Three-Part Song— form. 49. In all Three-Part forms there is, in addition to the above two Parts, a more or less distinctly marked return to the beginning, and con- sequent recurrence of the essential thematic contents of the First Part or Section ; it is the fulfilment of this structural condition which devolves upon the Third Part.* This affects, primarily, the cadence of the Second Part, which should be made upon the Dominant of the original key, and may therefore influence the later modulatory and thematic design of the Part. The Primary Grade. a. The primary grade of the Three-Part Song-form, when applied to the Invention, will resemble the Three-section design, explained in par. 40-43, with the significant exceptions, however, that the Third Section is not to be, as there, merely the continuation of its predecessors, but must represent the Return of the original key, and must reproduce a por- tion of the early contents of Section I (perhaps no more than one or two measures) ; and that, consequently, the Second Section must be so con- * Homopkonic Farms, par. 81. Par. 49a. THE THREE-PART SONG-FORM. 121 ducted, near its end, as to lead to this result. (Compare par. 43^.) For example : Part ( Section ) I. *i) Kx. 97. ^H M. *° i^e Eg •-f« — * — • S=ffl Meas. 4. ££ e: ^«^ w H=fc M. See original. *2) E3S^3^ -tp- •v «-*-•-' 5 6 7 9 10 § l± i^ffi* *-^^'^^ Part ( Section ) II. ^m M. ffi 53 =3K^3 '3 etc. 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 m^m^^^ 122 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 49a Part (Section) III. »6) *5) » Dom. p_. H. -I * F •- BE 5^ 1 SSf? ^g^ :g: m. rit. 55& ^ fci i =p=s= Q= ^^^^^^^ *=^=^a§^£t *-*-•- *i) With reference to the uncertainty of definition, compare par. 39a. The Motive is unusually long, and might be called a "Subject " (par. 38a). *2) Bach, 2-voice Invention No. 2. *3) This cadence is very indefinite ; hence the impression of " sectional " form, and the distinction " primary grade " of the tripartite design. *4) This measure and the following 7 correspond exactly (excepting the transpo- sition) to measures 3-10 of Section I, but with inverted parts ; one sequential meas- ure follows, and then the last measure of the Second Part, leading to a brief but definite Dominant ending. *5) The upper part corresponds to the conduct of the lower at the end of Part I. *6) The purpose of this Third Section to reproduce the initial members of the First Section, though somewhat indistinct, is nevertheless sufficiently obvious to establish the tripartite design. Par. 49a. THE THREE-PART SONG-FORM. 123 Furthermore, Ex. 96 is completed as follows : r, 3=i fte Ex. 98. II EEEi ^s (Ex. 96 cont.) Meas, 19. ^ EE EEE M P=5= =E=f Eg=E *i> M^M B^: *=1 §@ s Episode *2) i_^_ EE f3£3£ eS ^S^ i Part III. fgjzgBil g^llgifp^ I I 3E^ ^i Dom. » Efc e£&5 Motive 1.. (See Ex. 90.) *K lgpgf^lgl'^1 I EE 1* SS^SfEE ± • 3 ) is^tel rail. M. 1.. l ^ EE r»-Ff- ^T ffl? fCi=jC 3=*=* Ss^^^^SS *i) First half of Motive 2. *2) This second member of the Episode (which began in the 17th measure) is less closely related to the M. than the foregoing. •3) Up to this point the Third Part agrees exactly with the initial members of Part I (see Ex. 90). It is a much-abbreviated recurrence of the latter. See also Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. I, Prelude 14. Part I (already ana- lyzed) closes in measure 12 with a strong Dominant cadence ; in the Second Part many 124 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 50. auxiliary tones are used, but the impression of essentially 2-voice polyphony is not dis- turbed; the Dominant semi-cadence in measures 18-19 indicates the termination of Part II ; and the following tones are, under these circumstances, a sufficiently evident return to the beginning, — though no more than one measure is reproduced, and that with inverted voices. This somewhat vague Third Part is very brief, closing in measure 22 ; a Codetta, corresponding to the beginning of Part II, follows. The Genuine Three-Part Form. 50. In the genuine (broader and more clearly defined) Three-Part Song-form, the details of Part I correspond to those given in par. 47, which review ; and the conduct of Part II corresponds to all the details of par. 48 a, b, and c, — excepting such as concern its cadence, which, in the Three-Part design, must be made on the Dominant, or, at all events, upon such harmonies, and in such a manner,, as to prepare for and lead decisively into the recurrence of the first measures (as beginning of Part III). a. As before, the thematic basis of the Second Part may be : (1) The same Motive (usually with new, and more or less char- acteristic, counter-motives), — par. 48a, first and second clauses ; (2) The Contrary motion of the original Motive, as in the " Gigue " form (see par. 51) ; or (3) A new Motive, — par. 48^ b. The object of the Third Part is, as usual, to re-establish the principal key, and to re-announce the original Motive and its Imitation as they appeared at the outset, in a sufficiently accurate manner and through a sufficient number of measures to identify itself as the corroboration of the First Part. In some cases, where the design is broad, the parallelism extends through a large portion of the Third Part (perhaps with inverted voices, and occasional modifications), or even to the end, — excepting, of course, the necessary change of modulation and cadence. But more commonly it is limited to the first two or three measures, and the remainder of the Part is then elaborated independently, and, as climax of the form, as ingeniously and effectively as possible. Review par. 43a, which has peculiarly direct bearing upon " Part III." When the Second Part has used the Contrary motion of the Motive, the original motion is resumed at the beginning of Part III, and is then either retained to the end, or, far more effectively, the two forms of the M- subsequently appear in more or less regular alternation, or even in Par. 50b. THE "GIGUE." 1 25 conjunction (as Stretto). And precisely the same principles apply when Part II is based upon a new motive (as in Exs. 90, 96, 98). See Bach, 2-voice Invention No. 3 ; Part I (already analyzed) closes in measure 12; Part II contains two well-defined sections, closing in measures 24 and 38; be- tween the last cadence and the beginning of Part III (end of measure 42) a brief passage intervenes, which, though largely thematic, serves the purpose of a Re-tran- sition,* or returning passage ; Part III corroborates the first 4 measures of the First Part exactly, transposes and inverts the following four, then resumes the original line (transposed), but cadences on the VI (par. 43^) ; a Codetta follows. Throughout the Second Part the M., as already seen, is reconstructed by the addition of three prelimi- nary tones ; this form recurs once, in the Codetta. Bach, French Suite No. 2, "Air"; the M. (one-half measure) is announced in the upper part in a somewhat imperfect form, and imitated in slightly altered Con- trary motion; Part II begins with Contrary motion, but otherwise maintains the original motion ; it has two well-defined sections, of 4 measures each ; Part III (the last 4 measures) is vague in effect, though the structural purpose is clear ; during the first 2 measures the lower voice agrees almost exactly with the upper voice at the beginning of Part I. Bach, French Suite No. 4, " Air " ; Part I largely episodic ; the Contrary motion of the M. prevails in the Second Part, which contains two sections; Part III corre- sponds very closely to the First, — transposed after one and one-half measure, without other changes. EXERCISE 15. A. Write a 2-voice Invention (M. original) in the primary grade of the Three- Part Song-form (par. 49a). B. An Invention (in minor) in genuine Three-Part Song-form, according to par. 50: in Part II the same M., but with new and characteristic contrapuntal asso- ciates. First review par. 41 a-d ; and see par. 54. C. An Invention (in major or minor), employing the Contrary motion of the M. in the Second Part. D. An Invention, with new M. in Part II. The "Gigue." 51. The adoption of the Contrary motion of the Motive as thematic basis for the Second Part (already touched upon, in par. 48^ and par. 50a), is so common in the " Gigue " as to constitute a partly, though not definitely, distinctive trait of that old Dance-form ; and the term " Gigue-form " is therefore often applied to a polyphonic Invention thus designed, irrespective of its character. On the other hand, many ex- * Homophonic Forms, par. 90c 126 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 51. amples of the old-fashioned Gigue may be found in which the Second Part uses the original Motive, or a new one, as in ordinary forms. The design of the whole is usually the Two-Part (more rarely Three-Part) Song-form, with repeated Parts. The most common meas- ure is f . Review par. 48^. For illustration, see — Bach, French Suite No. 2, " Gigue " ; M. two measures in length, imitated at once in Stretto ; Part I is divided into two sections by a brief but decisive cadence in the 23rd measure (Relative key) ; Part II uses the Contrary motion for 20 meas- ures, when two announcements in original motion lead to a Dominant semi-cadence ; Contrary motion is then resumed, though the next (last) section is largely epi- sodic ; the evaded form of the cadence occurs 10 measures before the end. Two- Part form, each Part repeated. Bach, French Suite No. 6, " Gigue " ; Part I has two sections, terminating re- spectively in measures 8 and 16; an episodic Codetta of 8 measures is appended, based upon a motive suggestive of the Diminution of the original M. (par. 31^) ; Part II uses Contrary motion, chiefly in the lower part, and with extensive epi- sodic interruptions; its first section ends in measure 10, and its second one 5 meas- ures from the end ; the final measures are a partial recurrence of the former Codetta. The preponderant episodic portions, throughout this Gigue, seem to be based upon an additional (auxiliary) Motive, or several Motives, generated out of the 3rd measure. Compare par. 52a. Bach, English Suite No. 1, "Gigue"; M. of 1 measure, imitated in Stretto; Part I contains two sections, and a Codetta of 4 or 5 measures ; Part II begins with a curious version of the M, — the first half only in Contrary motion, the second half as before ; this version alternates with the original form during the First Section (5 measures), and again during the Second Section, which is its almost exact sequence ; a Third Section follows, and the added Codetta corresponds exactly to the former one. Bach, French Suite No. 4, " Gigue " ; in the 4th and 5th measures, and once or twice later, the notation represents three-voice texture, but the effect is distinctly that of auxiliary tones ; Part I has but one section, followed by a Codetta (measure 22) beginning with a quaint modification of the M. (in the lower part), — compare par. 33 ; Part II employs Contrary motion throughout its two sections, up to the Codetta (7 measures from the end) ; the Codetta begins with one announcement of the M. in Contrary motion, not included in the former Codetta, and then reproduces the latter in its full length, with inverted parts. Bach, English Suite No. 5, " Allemande " ; in the Second Part a modified form of the Contrary motion is adopted ; there are occasional brief intimations of 3-voice texture ; the original motion of the M. recurs near the end. Bach, English Suite No. 4, " Gigue " ; here also, as in the preceding examples, there is an intimation of 3-voice texture (in measures 5-8 only) ; the lower part, dur- ing measures 1 and 2, though thematic enough to simulate a genuine Imitation, is nevertheless only auxiliary, — the M. is i\ measure in length, and its first real Imitation begins with the last tone in measure 2 ; the last 5 measures of Part II correspond to the ending of Part I. Each Part is repeated. Par. 52. INVENTION WITH ALTERNATING MOTIVES. 1 27 The Invention with Two (or more) Motives in Alternation. 52. A second (new) Motive may appear not only at the beginning of the Second Part, as specific basis of the latter (par. 48^), but may be introduced and developed in closer connection and alternation with the first, or principal, Motive. a. Such an additional thematic germ may be so unimportant in character and extent as to subserve, chiefly or entirely, the episodic purposes, in which case it is to be called an Auxiliary Motive (or Figure), rather than " 2nd Motive." An example of this kind has already been seen in Bach, French Suite No. 6, " Gigue" ; and others will be cited later. b. When the new M. is more nearly or completely co-ordinate with the principal (first) one, it may appear at the beginning of the second (possibly a later) section, and become its thematic basis. Or it may enter into the polyphonic texture still earlier, — during the First Section, or Part, — and be utilized thereafter throughout the Invention, in more or less constant close alternation (not simultaneous conjunction) with the principal Motive. As already stated (par. 48^), the new M. must, while asserting a certain measure of distinct individuality, still be conceived in intimate consistency of character with the first Motive. For illustration, see Bach, 2-voice Invention No. 13 : Ex. 99. fe ^pii ^ h^ g ^^ i Motive 1. Motive 2. The first (principal) M. is used during 2 measures ; the 2nd M. during the rest of Part I (up to measure 6) ; the same arrangement prevails, very nearly, during the First Section of Part II (measures 6-13) ; in the remainder of Part II (up to measure 18) the 2nd M. appears alone, somewhat modified; in Part III (measure 18 to the end) the two Motives are employed, in closer alternation. Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 23 : Bach. Ex. IOO. ^W»p 3£gg Motive r. M. z. ( Auxil.? ) The 1 st M. appears only at the beginning of Part I, with one Imitation, partly in Contrary motion ; the 2nd M., which, but for its domination, would be regarded 128 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 52b. merely as an auxiliary figure, supplies the basis of development up to measure 8, after which fragments of M. I lead to the cadence (measure 1 2) ; Part II extends to measure 37; its First Section, ending in measure 17, is episodic, but derived from' M. 1 ; an independent episode follows, suggesting a third M. (compare par. 52*-) ; in measure 23 the second M. again asserts itself, and continues some time, though fragmentary j measures 29-32 closely resemble the episode of the foregoing section ; Part III (measure 37 to end) is much like the First Part, but the 2nd M. is absent. There are several evidences of 3-voice texture, but scarcely enough to be conclusive. The whole example belongs, more accurately, to the Prelude-class (Chap. IX). And the same is true of Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 13, in which the following contrasting thematic members are discoverable : Motive 1 (introductory). Motive 2 (principal). Of these, Motive 2 appears to be the more essential and important. The design is 3-Part Song-form ; Part II contains three well-defined sections ; in the first one ihe two Motives are announced in conjunction (simultaneously) ; Part III resembles Part I very closely, but is abbreviated. A coda of 8 measures is appended. Handel, Clavichord Suite No. 7, " Andante," employs the following Motives : (Comp. Ex. 99.) Ex. ,02 -ESI & £ 3= Motive 1. M. 2 (in Sequences). The design is 3-Part Song-form, Part III somewhat vague and abbreviated. Handel, Clavichord Suite No. 16, "Allemande," is a very clear exposition of the following, in almost constant clos« alternation : 103 Motive 1. Motive 2. The design is 2-Part Song-form, each Part containing two sections, and repeated. The thematic development is unusually regular and perspicuous. c. More rarely, three Motives participate in the development of an Invention ; either (1) as the respective thematic basis of three succes- sive sections, or (2) in closer and more constant alternation with the first (principal) M., or with each other, in any order. An illustration of the first of these methods is found in Bach, Well-temp. Clavi- chord, Vol. II, Prelude 4 (3-voice polyphony, and therefore to be reviewed in minuter detail in Chap. VII) ; a different M. is employed in each one of the first three Sec- Par. 53. THE LYRIC INVENTION. 1 29 tions (beginning in measures 1, 17, 27), the first announced in the upper, the second in the inner, and the third in the upper part. The second method is illustrated in Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 17 (belonging properly to the " Prelude "-species, Chap. IX); the following Motives appear, in measures 1 , j., and 7 : Ex. 104, sag j^ gii l Motive 1. .Motive 2. Motive 3. Besides these, there are meagre evidences of additional brief auxiliary Motives. The principal M. (No. 1) is each time accompanied by a body of auxiliary tones, almost equivalent to two extra voices, but their unessential quality is nevertheless entirely obvious ; the remainder of the texture is two-voice. The form is sectional (par. 39) ; each of the four Sections begins with the principal M., and employs both of the others generously, and with considerable regularity of design (M. 2 occasion- ally in Contrary motion). Section 2 begins in measure 17, Section 3 in measure 34, Section 4 in measure 50. The latter has quite a definite semi-cadence in measure 63, suggesting a possible fifth Section from that point to the end. The episode in measures 52-59 is based upon the first contrapuntal associate of M. 3 (measure 7), which is so prevalent that it might be regarded as a 4th Motive. The Lyric Invention, with a Long Theme. 53. The 2-voice Invention may, exceptionally, be based upon a thematic sentence of greater length than the ordinary Motives, seen in the above examples. Such a lengthy theme is very likely to represent the regular 4-measure Phrase, or even 4- to 8-measure Period-form, with a correspondingly definite melodic design, usually distinctly lyric in character, and with a well-marked semi-cadence (upon either a Tonic or Dominant chord). Obviously, so extended a Motive cannot be announced (imitated) effectively very often in the course of an ordinary Invention, at least not at its full length ; and therefore the development, while none the less strictly polyphonic, will necessarily be more largely episodic than usual ; and in general the structural idea and considerations of " form " will prevail almost constantly over the thematic purposes (compare par. 45, last clause). The episodic interludes will probably be derived from 13° APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 54. some figure or figures of the large Motive, though they may be inde- pendent. (Compare par. 38// and par. 41^/ see also par. 42^.) See Bach, 2-voice Invention No. 14 ; the theme is announced in the upper part and extends into the 4th measure ; it consists of a figure two beats in length, which alternates with its Contrary motion, excepting in the 3rd measure ; the lower part is "auxiliary" in character, though it is again employed as "counterpoint " to the Imi- tation of the theme (in measures 6-8) ; measures 4, 5, and 9-16 are episodic, derived directly from the germinal figure of the theme ; one more announcement of the entire theme, in the lower part (in shifted rhythm), leads to the concluding cadence. The entire design appears to embrace but one long section, as Phrase-group. Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 24; theme of 4 measures, an- nounced in upper part and imitated immediately in lower part, with different counter- point ; an Episode follows, based during 4 measures upon a new auxiliary figure, and then for 4 more measures upon a figure from the second contrapuntal associate (measure 7) ; the Second Section begins in measure 17, announces the theme four times in unbroken succession, using two former and two new " counterpoints " ; it then becomes episodic (measure 33), the lower part corresponding to the upper one of the former Episode, during 4 measures, while the following 4 measures are a new Episode ; the Third Section (measure 41) announces one-half of the theme, first in the upper, then in the lower part ; an Episode follows, 8 measures of which correspond very nearly to the first Episode (excepting in key) ; the remaining measures (53—59) are new Episode and cadence. A Coda is added, containing one announcement of the theme, and a few effective thematic fragments. Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 6 ; Two-Part Song-form and 5- measure Codetta; theme extending into the 5th measure; both Parts are largely episodic, — especially Part II, — but constantly in close touch with the contents of the theme. Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 1 5 ; Two-Part Song-form ; theme 3 measures long, appearing in a modified form of Contrary motion in Part II (com- pare par. 51) ; the extensive episodic passages, which contribute to the Prelude-like character of this Invention (see Chap. IX, par. 83), are strictly congruous, if not of thematic derivation. The last six measures of the two Parts correspond. The Student's Attitude Toward the Prescribed Tasks. 54 In working out the required Exercises in these grades of 2- voice Polyphony, the student need harbor no fear that he may imitate the given authoritative examples of Bach too closely, and thus perhaps unconsciously acquire the unwelcome habit of conceiving and writing in the somewhat antiquated manner of these old-fashioned compositions. The propagation of this particular style — the multiplication of pieces for which our modern ears have but little sympathy — • is not the aim of the student's present labors ; it is simply the exercise of contrapuntal discipline within the dominion of these forms, as a means to an end, — Par. 54. THE. LYRIC INVEMTTOtf. 131 an end which may be as modern and original as the student (or the listener) could desire. There is but little likelihood that the pupil will wholly escape the influence of modern musical thought, especially if he be observant (as successful students invariably are), alert to recognize and to appropriate the acquisitions of recent times, whether in the polyphonic or in the homophonic domain of musical creation. Polyphony is merely a product, resulting from the employment of the contrapuntal method; and this method may be applied in dealing with any phase of musLal style, romantic, classic, dramatic, or archaic. The distinction rests mainly, perhaps, upon the choice of harmonic basis, out of which all Polyphony must emerge, just as well as Homophony (par. ii); for this harmonic element it is which has grown "modern," leav- ing former simpler customs of harmonic progression behind. The dis- tinctive contrapuntal " method " adopted for the presentation of the harmony is, however, not thus subject to the changes of time ; Polyph- ony is the embodiment of the same principle in the twentieth century as in the fifteenth ; but its character and complexion will differ, as the harmonic material becomes richer and more pliable. There can be no excuse for writing an unattractive Invention in our day, on the ground that it must be produced by contrapuntal methods. Nothing is devoid of interest in which the operation of a quick imagination is discernible ; and nothing discloses, from the proper point of view, a more powerful and constant stimulus to the imaginative faculty, than the contrapuntal methods of tone-association. Brief reference may be made to par. 72 and par. 82. And the following effective specimens of the modern Invention for two parts should be thoroughly analyzed : Rubinstein, Prelude, op. 24, No. 2 ; 3-Part Song-form ; in Part I the Motive, 4 measures long, appears twice, followed by an episode (measures 9-16) ; Part II (measure 17) announces the M. once, in lower voice; a long and brilliant episode follows (measures 21-52), based wholly upon the last measure of the M. ; in meas- ures 35-36 the figure is somewhat concealed among auxiliary tones ; a second episode (measures 53-60) is based on the first measure of the M. ; *. strong Dominant cadence occurs in measure 60, followed by an extraordinary organ-point, as Re-tran- sition into Part III ; the M. is announced twice in Part III (measures 77-84) ; from this to the end is episodic Coda, based on first member of the Motive. Chopin, fitude, op. 10, No. 4 ; 3-Part Song-form ; the M. lies in the upper part, measures 1-4 ; the texture is largely episodic, though all derived directly from the M. ; there is an auxiliary harmonic accompaniment almost throughout, but the whole is distinctively 2-voice Invention-form (Prelude-species, par. 83). 132 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 55. EXERCISE 16. A. Write two examples of the " Gigue "-form (par. 51), one in major and one in minor. Review par. 41 a, i, c, d, and par. 54. B. An Invention, in optional form, with two Motives in close alternation. Par. 52*. ■ C. An Invention in three Sections, with a separate Motive for each section, — returning to the first M. near the end. Par. 52^. D. An Invention with a longer theme, of lyric character. Par. 53. The Natural Species of Double-Counterpoint. 55. Double-counterpoint is a process ; but the term is generally- applied to the product resulting from it. The counterpoint is said to be " double " when the added voice (i.e., the contrapuntal associate) presents perfect agreement with the given voice or Motive, in two differ- ent relations to the latter. These two relations always imply, in Double- counterpoint, the distinction of register, and refer to the agreement of the added part both above and below the given part ; or, in a word, the counterpoint is " double " when the parts admit of inversion. a. The inversion of the parts is effected by transferring either part toward and beyond the other (shifting it up or down, as the case may be) ; thus, the upper part may be shifted down, past the lower ; or the lower part shifted up ; or each may be shifted so that they exchange registers. See Exs. 105, 106, 107. b. When one of the parts is shifted just an octave (or possibly two octaves), while the other part remains where it was, it is obvious that no essential change in their harmonic relationship takes place, because each retains its original series of letters (or tones), and the association or union of the melodies is actually the same as before ; the only differ- ence being that their respective registers have been exchanged. Each contrapuntal interval is simply inverted, and the octave-inversion of an interval, as has been amply tested, is practically identical with the original interval. For illustration : (a), the Original Counterpoint. Ex. - 105.- e etc. 1 Par. 55b. NA TURAL DOUBLE-CO UNTERPOINT. 133 (3), the Inversion. *i) later : m i: 6 3 2 3 etc 5^ 3tg Bach. =**%- 1 *i) At b the two parts are inverted, the original upper part becoming the lower, and the lower the upper. The original upper part remains where it was, and the lower is shifted upward one octave, beyond the other. That no essential change takes place in the harmonic relations of the parts, is easily verified by comparing the contrapuntal intervals. The result would be precisely the same if the lower part were to remain, and the upper part shifted down an octave : I Ex. 106 $H£ 3= SB -*-£: F7 S - - * j i^ n Inversion of Original Counterpoint. Or if each part were shifted one octave (possibly two octaves) towards and beyond the other: Ex. 107. (a), the Original Counterpoint. ftaiste t*fcM mil Iftlslgllllfcfeii i (5), the Inversion. Bach. itzt fe££BE -J-M-t- & l *,) etc. ms^ m^^^^ *i) Here the original lower part is shifted up one octave, and the upper is shifted down two octaves. c. Further, the same result is obtained (without essential change) when the Inversion of the original counterpoint is transposed. In this 134 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 56. case each voice is shifted toward (and past) the other in such a manner that the sum of the two shifts equals an octave; for instance, if the upper voice is shifted down a 5th, the lower must be moved up a 4th ; or one a 3rd and the other a 6th; or one a 2nd and the other a 7th. For example : (a), the Orig. Counterpoint. / etc. I (£), the Inversion. *i) etc. later : *2) ^u^~i - fm mm gg i l s Bach. m w. FEE* *df. etc. *i) The upper part is shifted down a 7th, the lower up a 2nd (or 9th, which is the same thing) ; the original counterpoint is thus transposed bodily, as Inversion, from C major to d minor. That no other change than simple " inversion " has taken place, is shown by the first contrapuntal interval (a 3rd, becoming a 6th in the Inversion). See Ex. 86, Note *6). *2) The inverted form does not need to be enchained with the original counter- point, as chances to be the case in Ex. 107 ; it may occur and recur at any later moment in the form. 56. Such Inversions as these, in the octave or in intervals equalling an octave (or two or more octaves), are so common, so nearly inevitable in contrapuntal writing, and the product is, as has been shown, so likely to be exactly equivalent to the original, that this — the Inversion in Par. 57- NATURAL DOUBLE-COUNTERPOINT. 1 35 the Octave — is called the Natural species of Double-counterpoint. Its feasibility is almost a foregone conclusion, and therefore all good con- trapuntal association is, in a sense, naturally double-counterpoint. 57. No specific rules can be given for natural Double-counterpoint. The best method is to write the counterpoint as usual, and then simply test the effect of inverting the parts ; any lurking discrepancies can thus easily be detected and removed. The following general points may, however, be borne in mind : (1) The Original counterpoint should be as perfect and free from irregularities as possible. (2) Some caution should be exercised in the use of the chord-5th, for certain irregularities that are permitted with it in the upper part become objectionable in the lower ; this refers particularly to skips to or from the chord-5th, during a change of harmony. Compare par. 17^, last clause; (Ex. 50.Z?, No. 2, the last measure, would be much worse in inverted form). See also par. 62. A curious instance of characteristic disregard of this rule is seen in the follow- ing. Its undeniable peculiarity is palliated by broad considerations, that will become obvious to the more advanced st ucient : (b) Inversion. Ex. 109, , , _ . . % N.B. Bach. (a) Ong. *i) ^,1 ■ I M^Mmmmmmn fj^N-^f- US'ZS-f • N.B. ^-" -"I I I *i) The c% in the lower part is the 5th of the chord (I of f% minor). In the Inversion, the chord-5th_/J, also, is unpleasantly prominent in the upper part. (3) If the two parts are kept within an octave (from each other), the shifting of either part a single octave suffices to effect Inversion. If the parts diverge more than an octave at any point, however, it will be necessary to shift each voice an octave (or either voice two octaves) in order to obtain Inversion throughout ; and so on. 58. Frequent unconscious use has already been made of natural Double-counterpoint in the preceding exercises. Systematic application of it may hereafter be made, in the Invention, in many ways that will suggest themselves to the student. For instance : In the sectional form, any later section may correspond exactly (or nearly) to some foregoing section, but with inverted voices, and, of course, in a different key. 136 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 59- Or, in the 2-Part Song-form, a portion, or the whole, of the Second Part may be an inverted reproduction of the First, in the proper key. This is strikingly illustrated in Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. I, Fugue 10, to which brief reference may be made ; the entire Second Part (measures 20-38) is an Inversion of Part I (measures 1-19) in a different key ; the necessary modulation is made in measure 29, first beat (compare with measure 10). Or, in the 3-Part Song-form, Part III may corroborate Part I in the same manner. See Beethoven, Pianoforte Sonata, Op. 10, No. 2, Finale, measure 87 (ff) to 106. Beethoven, Violin Son., Op. 30, No. i, Finale, Var. V; meas. 1-8, inverted in meas. 9-16; meas. 17-24, inv. in meas. 25-32. EXERCISE 17. Write a number of 2-voice Inventions, applying the principle of natural Double- counterpoint, according to the suggestions in par. 58. CHAPTER VI. The Contrapuntal Association of Three Melodic Parts (Voices). 59. Review the definition of Polyphony given in the Introductory Statement (page 1). The " harmonious " association of three co-ordinate melodies must necessarily be controlled by the conditions of chord-structure to a far greater and more manifest extent than that of only two voices, — for which latter a schedule of euphonious intervals was found to suffice. For this reason 3-voice Polyphony exhibits a much more evident harmonic character than the 2-voice ; and the chief difficulty in its suc- cessful manipulation consists in respecting and enforcing the control of the Chord-forms, without fettering the individual parts and interfering with that independence and melodic smoothness which is, in true Polyphony, as significant a requisite as that of unanimous action. 60. The chord-forms, i.e., any combination of three or four 3rds, with or with- out inversion, afford the necessary consonance or general " harmony " of effect. But an excess of this harmonic (i.e., homophonous) effect must be counteracted, by modification (through inharmonic adjuncts) sufficient to disguise the chords, as such, and create the impression of individual voice-movements within the channels marked Par. 61. THREE-VOICE POLYPHONY. 137 off by the chord-tones. The problem of genuine and effective Polyphony for more than two parts is, concisely stated, that of achieving this impression of independent melodic progressions, and still preserving sufficient evidence of the chords to ensure a harmonious result. Technically considered, this is secured by the employment of Suspensions, Pass- ing-notes (accented and unaccented), and occasional Neighboring tones or Appoggia- turas, as disguising adjuncts of the predefined chords, as evidences of freedom and elasticity in a movement whose general direction is dictated by an underlying stern principle of harmonic necessity. But the manner and the extent of the use of these inharmonic (dissonant) factors must be vigilantly guarded, and tempered by due consideration of the demands of euphony and harmony. Review par. \-]b. Details of Three-Voice Polyphony. 61. a. This imparts a corresponding degree of importance to the harmonic idea, and greatly emphasizes the rules of chord-succession given in pars. 18 and 19, which must be carefully reviewed. b. Of the three parts, two will very likely co-operate temporarily according to the rules of 2-voice polyphony given in Chapter II ; and the remaining (third) part aims to secure some essential tone which, with the essential tones already present, completes some legitimate chord-structure. This rule is merely stated for the convenience of the student, who, as beginner, can scarcely expect to conduct three independent parts successfully, all at once, but will need some such division of the labor as the rule indicates. He must observe that no attempt can be made to intimate which two of the three parts will be chosen thus to form the temporary basis of the contrapuntal fabric, or how far the choice each time extends ; for that depends upon conditions that are either self-evident, or follow as a matter of course out of later details, — especially par. 64. And in any case the rule does not refer to a certain pair of voices throughout, but implies a temporary choice, liable at any moment to be exchanged for another pair. The ulti- mate consideration is, after all, that the three parts together must represent, in their simultaneous essential tones, some legitimate chord-form. Hence, in the preliminary draught of the three-fold melodic asso- ciation, the intervals of the 3rd, 6th (8ve, etc.), will govern the choice of simultaneous essential tones, as shown in pars. 14 and 15. For illustration : mZZQ E <>f *= Bach. r i«pg =t ± a-^ — c d-f-(a). c-e-(g). c-(c)-e. f-(f)-a. (b)-d-f. e-g-(b). a-(a)-c. I 138 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 61C. *i) Assuming (arbitrarily, simply by way of illustration) that Bach defined first the conduct of the two higher parts, it will be seen that they conform exactly to the rules of 2-voice counterpoint, and represent, in their essential tones, fragments of successive chords, whose absent intervals afford the staple out of which the additional (3rd) part is constructed. *2) The notes of the lower part correspond to the letters in parenthesis, and represent, in nearly every case, the tones which complete the chord-structure. Further : Bach. c-c-(e)-g. f-a-c-(e).(c). (b)-d-f.f-f-(a).b-(d)-f-a. f 1 IN ^ Ba ch. M._ ! M.. fff^srr^ Episode. B^ S=£ffiS m fi r » ms w, 1 M 1 TF"T?~ M. Cont. m I *i) Auxiliary part. *2) From this point on, a very distinct intention of omitting the first tone of the original M. is exhibited ; these two versions of the Motive — with and without the initial accented tone — actually participate in the development, throughout the entire composition (Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 19). *3) The lower part does not appear with its Imitation of the M. until the upper and inner parts have announced it four times. The upper part has the M. at the same time, in parallel thirds ; such double announcements are not uncommon (see measure 6). *4) The derivation of this episodic passage is somewhat indirect, but manifestly consistent. *5) Here the M. appears to be divided between the inner and upper parts. Such interaction of the parts is, naturally, very exceptional, though not without occasional justification. See Bach, 3-voice Invention No. 1, second measure from the end; M. in Contrary motion, announced by the upper part, but, after one beat, taken up with- out interruption, and concluded, by the inner part. A. Analyze the Bach, 3-voice Bach, 3-voice Bach, 3-voice Bach, 3-voice Bach, 3-voice Bach, 3-voice Bach, 3-voice EXERCISE 19c following Expositions : Invention No. i.meas. 1-11. Invention No. 4, meas. 1-8. Invention No. 8, meas. 1-7. Invention No. 10, meas. 1-11. Invention No. 12, meas. 1-9. Invention No. 13, meas. 1-21. Invention No. 14, meas. 1-12. ISO APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 67e. B. Elaborate each of the following four Motives into a First Section, or Expo- sition ; imitating the character and extent of those analyzed at A. The pupil may choose any technical style, but he is advised to write for a key- board instrument, — unless he may chance to be entirely familiar with the trio of strings, or some other ensemble. The choice of vocal parts must be deferred for a time. Begin each example on a separate sheet, and leave ample space for its comple- tion in the next lesson. First review pars. 21 ; 28; 41 (thoroughly) ; 60; 61 entire (especially d, e); 62 ; 63 ; 64 ; and 65 (thoroughly) : 1. Poco andante.*i) ^■^ft^^ * 2 ) 2. Allegretto. fcm &fll 3. Moderate *5) K *2) sa ^m *6) 4. Lento, HE5^*g^ i4: *7> * 1 ) Poco andante, — with gentle, but quite palpable, motion. The tempo must always be taken into consideration, as it affects, very directly, the question of euphony, — the number, extent, and quality of dissonant combinations ; see par. 65^. The more rapidly these pass by, the less objectionable they are ; and conversely. See also par. 14. *2) The final tone is optional, both as to pitch and duration. *3) This M. is to begin in the inner part, with auxiliary Bass. It may also be manipulated an 8ve higher, beginning in the upper part. *4) Beginning in the inner part, with or without auxiliary Bass. Also a. j*4 higher (in a minor), as upper part. *5) The prevailing rhythm should be quarter-notes. *6) As lower part, — without auxiliary tones above. *7) As upper part. Also a jth lower (in b minor), as inner part. C. Write two Expositions, one in minor and one in major, upon original Motives ; or upon Motives chosen at option from the list given in Exercise 7 A. Par. 68. THE THREE-VOICE INVENTION. 151 The Remaining Sections. 68. The details of the further development and conclusion of the sectional form correspond exactly to those given in pars. 42, 43, and 44, which review thoroughly. a. Contrary motion of the M. is a peculiarly valuable resource, and should be freely used in these remaining sections, Stretto-znnounce- ments (for two, or for all three, parts) are most desirable in the later Sections. Perhaps an Imitation in Augmentation (or Diminution) may be successfully introduced in the 3-voice Invention, though these unusual forms of Imitation are most likely to be applied to a portion only of the Motive. Compare 41V. b. The student should conceive this present Exercise chiefly as an effort to discover and apply as many of the latent resources of his Motive as possible. Therefore, he should employ the Motive (entire or in part) almost constantly, test- ing every form of presentation which the chapter upon " Imitations " (Chapter IV) designates, or which his own imagination may suggest, and introducing compara- tively few and brief episodic passages. In pursuing this interesting and profitable course of thematic experiment to a satisfactory conclusion, the number of Sections may be increased to any reasonable extent (see par. 68^) ; and each Section, in turn, may be devoted more or less exclusively to testing some certain (untried) resource of thematic presentation (compare par. 39^) ; this will tend to individualize the several Sections, while, on the other hand, the necessary unity and consistency of form may easily be restored by establishing points of similarity and corroboration between the Sections (par. 42c). See — Bach, 3-voice Invention No. 1, meas. n to end. Bach, 3-voice Invention No. 4, meas. 8 to end. Bach, 3-voice Invention No. 8, meas. 7 to end. Bach, 3-voice Invention No. 12, meas. 9 to end. Bach, 3-voice Invention No. 13, meas. 21 to end (new and more characteristic counter-motive than in Section 1). Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. I, Prelude 18; Motive in the upper part witti full auxiliary accompaniment ; imitated in lower, in the 8ve ; Section 1 closes in measure 5; the last Section (measures 18-27) is largely episodic, but derived strictly from the Motive ; the last 3 measures are a Codetta. Bach, Supplement (Peters ed. 1959), page 68, — called " Fuga," but belonging to the lower range of " Invention "forms ; irregular voice-texture. Bach, Organ Comp. (Peters ed.), Vol. VI, No. 29, second division, } time; two Motives, in close alternation, — M. 1 in upper part, measures 1-3 ; M. 2 in upper part, measure 4. — Vol. VIII, No. 7. Handel, Clavichord Suites, No. VII, Presto-movement of the " Ouverture " ; largely episodic. c. Sometimes the design of an Invention is extended to embrace an unusually large number of Sections, or even Parts. The result is 152 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 68c. either a Large Group-form * ; or, less frequently, the middle Sections are approximately equivalent to a " Trio," followed by a broad Da capo of all the anterior ones (quasi Song-form with Trio **). In such long lines of development it is almost indispensable to introduce complete episodic Sections, often of quite distinctly homophonic character, based more upon harmonic figuration (in the prevailing rhythm) than upon thematic recurrences. Compare par. 45, last clause ; and par. 84. For illustration of this rare design see — Bach, English Suite No. V, " Prelude " ; very broad sectional design ; Section 1 extends to measure 40, and is largely thematic ; Section 2 (to measure 52) is entirely episodic, and almost suggestive of a new (auxiliary) motive, — par. 52 ; Section 3, to measure 71, is again thematic, but largely ta»-voice texture; Section 4 is episodic, and closes in measure 81 with a semi-cadence; Section 5 resembles Section 2, but is longer (to measure 105), becoming strictly thematic, and, in its last six measures, corresponding to the end of Section 3 ; Section 6 resembles Section 4, and closes with a Dominant semi-cadence in measure 117 ; Section 7, from there to the end, is a literal recurrence of Section 1 (i.e., a da capo) . Bach, " Ouverture a la maniere francaise " (Peters ed., 208, No. 1), first number, second tempo (f time), is very similar; Sections 1, 3, 5, 7 are thematic; 2, 4, 6 epi- sodic ; Section 7 is a da capo, abbreviated at the beginning. The first tempo ( (j> time) is an Introduction, balanced by a Postlude of corresponding character ; they belong to a different species of polyphonic form, and are not to be analyzed here. Bach, Partita No. IV, " Ouverture," second tempo (\ time) ; 5 sections, the final one of which (last 26 measures) reverts to nearly every characteristic trait of the foregoing sections, and, during its last 1 1 measures, practically reproduces the First Section (transposed). Bach, English Suite No. IV, " Prelude " ; 14 comparatively brief sections, Nos. 13 and 14 a literal da capo of Nos. 1 and 2. The texture is largely ftw-voice, es- pecially during the thematic passages ; but unmistakable evidences of multi-voice counterpoint exist. — See, further, par. 71. EXERCISE 20. A. To each of the Expositions written as Exercise 19Z? add the concluding sections, — preferably not more than two or three in number. Review again pais, ior, 61 6, d, e, 63, 64, and 65. B. Conclude the original work begun in Exercise 19C Other Structural Designs. 69. a. The primary Two-Part Song-form. Review pars. 45 and 46 ; and analyze the following examples very thoroughly : — * Homophonic Forms, par. 115. ** Ibid., par. 117. Par. 69b. THE THREE-VOICE INVENTION. 1 53 Bach, 3-voice Invention No. 14 ; Part (or Section) I, already analyzed, closes in measure 12, with a very distinct Dominant cadence; Part II (to the end) is charac- terized by abundant stretti. — Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. I, Prelude 23 ; Part (or Section) I terminates in measure 6, Part II in measure 15 (somewhat indefi- nitely) ; a Codetta, with evidences of four-voice texture, follows. — Bach, Partita No. 1, " Praeludium" ; M. of one and one-half measures,' — possibly two measures; Part I ends in measure 14. — Bach, 3-voice Invention No. 15; two Motives in close alternation, in different rhythms ; the Counter-motive is retained throughout, in Natural Double-counterpoint (compare par. 58) ; Part I ends in measure 14. b. The genuine Two-Part Song-form. Review pars. 47 and 48 ; and see — Bach, 3-voice Invention No. 6; Part I embraces two Sections, closing respec- tively in measures 11 and 18. — Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 9; several Motives,- — No. 1 in measures 1—8, No. 2 in measures 9— 12, No. 3 in measures 13-15, and No. 4 in the Second Part (measures 8-10, etc.) ; Motive 1 re- curs at the beginning of Part II ; Part I closes with a long Codetta (measures 18- 24), which recurs at the end of Part II (measures 19-27) with its two Phrases in reversed order, and followed by a 4-measure Coda. — Bach, French Suite No. 3, " Courante." Handel, Suite No. VIII, " Allemande " ; largely 2-voice texture. — Handel, Suite No. IV, " Gigue " ; two Motives in close alternation (upper part, measures 1 and 2, respectively) ; Part II begins with the second Motive, — not with Contrary motion of the principal Motive (par. 51.) — Bach, Partita No IV, "Gigue"; Part II is based upon a new Motive, which proves, after 6 measures, to be a Counter-motive to the principal Motive of Part I, in connection with which it appears once (or twice) ; the last 8 measures of the two Parts correspond. — Mozart, "Gigue" in G major (Cotta edition, No. 22) ; Part II begins with a fragment of the original Motive, answered by the same fragment in Contrary motion ; the two Parts are very similar in contents ; a Codetta of 5 measures is added to the whole. — Bach, English Suite No. 2, " Allemande " ; the M. of Part I appears first in the upper part, curiously con- founded (on the 4th beat) with one of the lower auxiliary tones, ■ — compare the simple form as it occurs in the lower part in measures 6, 7 ; Part II has, apparently, a new Motive throughout, but careful scrutiny reveals its origin in the modified Contrary motion of the first Motive. c. The conventional Gigue-form, with Contrary motion of the M. as basis of Part II. Review par. 51, and see — Bach, French Suite No. V, " Gigue." Bach, English Suite No. Ill, "Gigue"; the original motion of the M. recurs once, at the very end. Bach, English Suite No. V, " Gigue." Bach, English Suite No. VI, " Gigue." Bach, Partita No. II, " Capriccio." Bach, Partita No. Ill, " Gigue." The above superb illustrations of the 3-voice Invention-species are to be analyzed with more than ordinary attention and minuteness. 154 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 6gd. Bach, Organ Comp. (Peters compl. ed.), Vol. I, Sonata No. I, 2nd movement ; M. one measure, upper part, followed by another measure of episodic extension (related to par. 72c) ; Part II, after 5 measures' exposition of the Contrary motion, corresponds closely to sections of Part I, but in different order, with inverted voices, and (partly) transposed. To be minutely analyzed. Bach, Suite, Peters ed. 214, No. 3, " Gigue.'" Bach, Suite, Peters ed. 214, No. 5, " Gigue " ; M. 3 or 4 beats, in lower part ; curious insertion of auxiliary tones, before Imitation in each of the other higher parts. Bach, English Suite No. Ill, " Allemande " ; M. one measure, lower part. d' Albert, Pianoforte Suite, op. 1, movement 5 ("Gigue," — excellent example). Handel, Suite No. VIII, " Gigue." Handel, Suite No. VIII, " Courante " ; largely harmonic in general character, and at times definite 4-voice texture ; the original motion of the M. recurs in measures 18 and 19 of Part II. Handel, Suite No. XIII, " Gigue." d. The primary Three-Part Song-form. Review pars. 49 and 49a; and see — Bach, 3-voice Invention No. 10 ; Part (Section) I closes, a little indefinitely, in measure 11, as already seen; Part II embraces two Sections, closing respectively in measures 22 and 25 ; in measure 26 a vague, but probably sufficient, intimation of " the return to the beginning " (the distinctive condition of a " Third Part ") is recognizable. Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 3, second tempo (| time) ; Section I ends in measure 10; Section II, based chiefly upon the Contrary motion of the M., closes in measure 17; the remaining (Third) Section is sufficiently indicative of a recurrence of the early contents of Section I to represent the 3-Part form. e. The genuine Three-Part Song-form. Review par. 50, and see — Bach, French Suite No. 1, "Gigue"; Part II, based on the Contrary motion, terminates 7 measures from the end, upon a strong Dominant semi-cadence ; what follows is a very obvious (though somewhat disguised) Third Part, or recurrence of the beginning ; it opens with several stretto Imitations, in the original motion, and, in the second measure, in Contrary motion (upper voice) ; the last two measures correspond to the ending of Part I. Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude No. 5 ; M. one measure long, with an episodic extension of one well-contrasted lyric measure, which reappears at the beginning of Parts II and III, but does not participate essentially in the thematic development ; Part I has a Codetta of 4 measures ; Part II begins with the Contrary motion, but utilizes the original motion also ; its ending, and the announcement of Part III, are very distinct ; the latter diverges into the Sub-dominant key, in its 3rd measure, and thereafter follows almost exactly the line of Part I, transposed, of course, to the principal key. Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 21 ; based throughout upon three brief Motives (announced in measures 1, 9, and 13, respectively), — see par. 52 ; Part II is 16 measures in length; Part III begins very definitely; a curious series of Par. 6ge. THE THREE-VOICE INVENTION. 1 55 double-announcements of the principal Motive, in simultaneous original and Con- trary motion, appears in measures 1 2 to 7 from the end. Bach, Peters ed., Supplement (No. 1959), page 63. In the following examples of the 3-part Song-form, the Third Part is a more or less accurately transposed recurrence of the main contents of Part I : * Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. I, Prelude 9 ; M. 7 beats long, followed by an episodic (lyric) extension ; the first Imitation is in measure 3 (lower part) j Part I ends in measure 8 ; Part II ends in measure 14; Part III is a nearly exact trans- posed recurrence of the First Part, ending, with an evaded cadence, in measure 22, and followed by a brief Codetta, or plagal extension. Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 4 ; Part I, closing in measure 17, manipulates the principal M. (upper part, measures 1-5 ; lower part, very much modified, measures 5-7) ; Part II begins with a new (2nd) Motive, two measures in length (inner voice), which is carried through the first of its Sections (to measure 27) ; in measure 27 a third Motive appears (ij measures, upper voice), derived from the auxiliary Bass at the beginning; this is retained to the end of Part II (measure 33) ; see par. 52^; Part III (measure ^^) is, for 7 measures, a transposed recurrence of the first 7 measures of Part I, with the M. transferred to the inner voice ; thereupon it returns to the beginning and reproduces these J measures in the original key, with slight changes. The remainder of Part III embraces the following factors: Meas- ures 45-49, an episodic passage, largely sequential; measures 50— 55, a transposed reproduction of the Second Section of Part II; measure 56 to end, a reproduction of the last 7 measures of Part I, the upper and inner voices inverted. See, again, par. 58. Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 19 ; Part I is analyzed in Exam- ple 116; Part II begins with Contrary motion of the M., and uses it freely during its two Sections ; Part III (measures 22-30) is an almost exact reproduction of Part I, but transposed, and with inner and upper voices inverted (par. 58) ; a. Codetta of 2j measures is added. Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 22 ; the M. is 5 measures long, announced first in the inner part, and associated with contrapuntal fragments from its first members; an "Auxiliary figure" appears in measure 7 (inner part), which assumes vital importance in the total development ; see par. 523 ; Part II embraces three Sections, beginning respectively in measures 16, 24, and 42 ; Part III (meas- ures 55-70) is an accurate reproduction of Part I, transposed, and with inverted inner and upper voices (par. 58) ; a Coda is added, the last 6 measures of which correspond to the ending of Section 2 of the Second Part. 70. A very effective variety of the 3-Part Song-form is obtained, on the basis of the idea expressed in par. 48a (second clause), by introdu- cing in Part II a Counter-motive in more animated rhythm. a. This implies that the original Motive should be of a rhyth- mically quiet or stately form, with correspondingly quiet counterpoint during Part I. * ffomophonic Forms, par. iiq. 156 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 70a. The characteristic Counter-motive of Part II may be nothing more than an ordinary contrapuntal associate, in shorter note-values. But it is not unlikely that its figures m3y be generated, by Diminution, out of parts of the Motive itself • and, in either case, it should be treated to a certain extent as an " Auxiliary motive," i.e., recurring, entire or in part, from time to time (freely modified, if necessary), in order to avoid *3ie impression of desultory rambling. For example (Bach, 3-voice Invention No. 7) : Lento Auxiliary part.- i . See the original. *2 ) zjLzi m^E* w m 5 6 7 8 11 12 'im Cadence. Part II. 15: ?TT M._ Par. 70b. THE THREE-VOICE INVENTION. M 157 i ~i~ ~ M J_ ' • . *4) *=q=»=rfEf^ =&* _____ feEa _____ ________ ___ ______ _____ -+- • — I — — I — 1 — 1 — I — ~ — l""T — V- *s) *6) fe 2___*gE__j_ ^ Bach. *i) The irregularity of rhythm at this place (i6th-notes upon the accented 'beat only) is balanced and justified by the recurrence of the same figure two measures later ; compare par. 22e. Further, the i6ths are called forth by the purpose of connect- ing the inevitable dt and d"i as smoothly as possible. — *2) The First Part runs on thus in a fundamental rhythm of 8th-notes, interrupted three times as in measure 3. *3) This figure of four tones is the evident thematic germ of the new, character- istic Counter-motive in animated movement, which begins abruptly at the outset of Part II. The figure was doubtless conceived and adopted by Bach as the Contrary motion of the first member of the principal Motive, in Diminution. — *4) The pecu- liar "cross-relation " between the inner and lower parts here (dt-dtt ) is justified by the structural joint (or light cadence) at the first beat ; compare par. iqd, and Ex. 57, especially Note *y). — *5) This Counter-motive agrees with the preceding one throughout, but skilfully transposed to correspond to the interval of Imitation adopted for the M. in the upper part (the 5th) ; therefore, the contrapuntal calculation is identical, and harmonious union is assured. — *6) From here on the animated contrapuntal figure is transferred impartially from one voice to another. — *y) The animated rhythm is maintained, without a check, to the cadence of Part II, which is made with much emphasis upon a. Dominant chord, in measure 37 (see Ex. 118). The 2nd Section of the Part begins (measure 25) with the Contrary motion of the animated Counter-motive (modified unessentially to conform easily to the altered conditions) ; this reveals more clearly the origin of the figure indicated in Note *3) # The original is to be thoroughly analyzed, up to measure 37. b. If the characteristic Counter-motive in quicker rhythm is to dis- tinguish Part II especially, it will be abandoned at the beginning of 158 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 70b. Part III, and the latter will resume the original fundamental rhythm, — possibly only for a few measures, however ; for the animated rhythm is quite likely to assert itself again, either in the later course of Part III, or in the Coda or Codetta, which, in such definite structural designs as these, is almost indispensable. The first of these alternatives is illus- trated in the continuation of the above example (Bach, 3-voice Inven- tion No. 7), thus : Part III. II M_ ._ ... _.. _^_ i'i. _ !\ Ex. 1 18. l w a= ■&=±L -■=£ 36 'P~ ^£*E^ (Cont. of Ex. 117.) $m 1 .fei 37 m =P=5= -A — 4- u ^=T- ¥=&=P -1 — r e i) -+— • £^e£ - I ' ll b f=r=g4=?= — r— 1 m ±EES£ I I fclt Bach. I w T=W- f=f=f W sfe^SI * 2 ) 4 i 42 43 £ *==*b F S *i) At the beginning of Part III the original rhythm of 8th-not.es is resumed, abruptly; but after two measures the characteristic Counter-motive reappears. As a rule, the original rhythm should have more time than this, to re-assert itself. *2) The rhythm of i6th-notes is carried on without interruption, up to the cadence-beats. There is no Codetta in this instance. See also— briefly, and solely with reference to the rhythmic design of the three Parts and Coda — Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. I, Fugue 19; Part I, measures Par. 71. THE THREE-VOICE INVENTION. 1 5.9 1-20 ; Interlude, measures 20-22 ; Part II, measures 23-42 ; Part III, measures 42-49 ; Coda, to end. The Song-form with Trio. 71. As intimated in par. 68c, an extension of the sectional line of development to an abnormal length is not unlikely to resolve itself into that broad homophonic design of three Divisions, the third of which is a more or less exact " Da capo " (recurrence of the first), thus isolating the second Division somewhat, — like the " Trio " of certain dance- forms. See Bach, English Suite No. VI, "Prelude," allegro-movement. The Introduc- tion of 37 measures is not to be analyzed at present. Section 1 extends to the 1 1 th measure ; Section 2 utilizes the Contrary motion of the Motive ; Section 3 (measures 20-49) i s preponderantly two-voice texture, and contains several effective episodic passages, more in the style of harmonic figuration than polyphonic development ; this closes with a strong Tonic cadence in the principal key, and terminates the First Division. The following five sections constitute the Middle Division or "Trio" (up to measure no) ; Section IV (measures 49-61) is mainly episodic, and suggests the presence of an Auxiliary Motive ; Section V (measures 61—76) reverts emphatically to the principal M., and contains a reminiscence of Section III ; Section VI (to measure 90) begins with a novel treatment of the M., and then (measure 80) corroborates the main contents of Section IV; Section VII (to measure 106) begins with a new form of treatment, but soon runs into the current of Section III, to which, especially during its last 6 or 7 measures, it bears close resemblance ; Section VIII (to measure 1 10) is a brief Re-transition. The remaining three sections (meas- ure no to the end) are a literal recurrence of Sections I, II, and III, i.e., the First Division. Bach, English Suite No. II, " Prelude." This is preponderantly ftw-voice tex- ture, and its First Division has already been analyzed in Exercise 13^. The Middle Division (measures 55-110) begins with an episodic passage, based upon a new (Auxiliary) Motive which distinctly governs the Division, though the principal M. asserts itself from time to time, — somewhat analogous to par. 48^; in measure 87 a 4-measure Section occurs, corresponding exactly (excepting in key) to the Codetta of the First Division ; it is immediately repeated, with transferred register and other unessential changes ; in measure 95 the Auxiliary M. again resumes its sway, and leads to an unusually impressive cadence in measure no, in the Relative key, — fol- lowed immediately by the literal reproduction of the First Division, as " Da capo." It is almost certainly only an accidental coincidence that the three Divisions should each contain the same number of measures (55). EXERCISE 21. A. Write a complete example of the 3-voice Invention in 2-Part Song-form (broad design, par. 69^), employing the same Motive in Part II, chiefly in the original motion (par. 48a). An original M. is to be used, — preferably in major. 160 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 7a. S. An example of the 3-voice Invention in the 2- Part Song-form, as " Gigue " (par. 6gc), — Contrary motion of the M. as basis of Part II. Original M., preferably in minor, and f time. C. Two examples (major and minor, but in different species of measure from each other and from those above) in the 3-Part Song-form, par. 69 d and e. The- matic basis of Part II optional. Motive original D. An example (preferably major) in the 3-Part Song-form, with characteristic counter-motive in animated rhythm during Part II, — par. 700 and b. Either Motive 3 of Exercise ioi? may be used, or an original one of similar stately character. Distinctions of " Style " in the Invention. 72. Distinctions of Style are necessarily less definite in polyphonic than in homophonic composition ; not only because Polyphony is, in itself, so characteristic a " style " as to counteract the assumption of other specific style-distinctions, to a large degree ; but also because the peculiar restrictions of polyphonic writing render it difficult to real- ize all the essential details of certain (especially the conventional) styles. But the broader distinctions of style may, nevertheless, be exhibited definitely enough in an Invention (or any other polyphonic form for at least three voices), as far as these distinctions rest upon the choice of tempo, mode, rhythmic character, and similar general qualities ; or upon the melodic character of the Motive; and it is therefore entirely feasible, as it is desirable, to distinguish at least three broad divisions of poly- phonic style, namely : a. The Light or Spirited style (with its kindred qualifications, sprightly, joyous, vigorous, brilliant, capricious, flowing, etc.). The chief characteristics of these species are a comparatively brief Motive, of lively, flowing, gay, or rhythmically capricious (distinctly individualized) character ; fairly rapid tempo ; probably (though by no means certainly) the major mode ; and general brightness and vivacity of expression. For example: Bach, 3-voice Inventions, Nos. 8, 6, 1, io, 14, 15; Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 5. b. The Serious style (with its kindred qualifications, grave, somber, stately, pathetic, etc.), characterized mainly by a Motive of stately or even heavy character, generally brief ; quiet or moderately slow tempo ; generally the minor, though not infrequently the major, mode; and subdued, dignified expression. Par. 72c. DISTINCTIONS OF "STYLE." 16 1 For example: Bach, 3-voice Inventions, Nos. 4, 9, 13; Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. I, Prelude 18; Vol. II, Preludes 9 and 17. c. The Lyric (melodious) style ; characterized by a M. of distinctly melodious nature, and generally of considerable length, — often in regu- lar (4-measure) Phrase-form ; graceful, flowing tempo ; major or minor mode indifferently ; and unusual definiteness of structural design. For illustration : Bach, 3-voice Inventions, Nos. 7, 12,3, z (the last-named is to be thoroughly analyzed ; it is largely episodic) ; Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 4. d. Another, scarcely less genuine, variety of the Lyric class, is dis- tinguished by a brief Motive, or simple thematic Figure, out of which (1) the broader lyric sentences are sometimes constructed, by sequen- tial combination ; or which (2) enters still more incidentally into the lyric texture, apparently as a mere figural accompaniment (or auxiliary Figure) derived from the successive harmonies that underlie the princi- pal melodic lines. This is clearly illustrated in Bach, 3-voice Invention, No. 11, which is to be care- fully analyzed ; the thematic Figure of four (or five) notes stands at the beginning of the principal melodic part, but its connection with the latter is thereafter, almost constantly, purely incidental ; the lyric sentences are built upon, not derived themati- cally from, this Figure. The character of this Invention is distinctly lyric ; its form is Sectional. See further, briefly : Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. I, Preludes 9 and 1 7 ; Vol. II, Prelude 21. c. These distinctions of Style must be adopted and applied in a very general sense only. It is as impracticable as it is obviously undesirable, to coerce a poly- phonic composition into such definite agreement with the essential conditions of " Style " as is found in some free homophonic structures. Consequently, even the analytic definition will often be found doubtful and difficult, because the related phases overlap so widely that both styles may be distinctly represented in the same composition; a lyric Invention may incline toward either the light or the serious style ; and even these extremes may touch, — a serious Invention may contain viva- cious episodes, and vice versa. Furthermore, the number of parts employed influences the style to a certain extent ; two-voice texture is most appropriate for the Light styles, three-voice for the Lyric, and four- (or more) voice for the Serious. Examples in two-voice texture have been cited in pars. 51 and 53. Three-voice texture is the only kind that may be adapted to all three styles. Finally, in an Invention expressly designed to represent one or another of these styles, the episodic passages are apt to predominate somewhat, both in extent and character ; for the relief from strict thematic treatment which they afford contributes to the realization of the specific purposes involved. And, in general, the structural 1 62 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 73. (formal) details advance proportionately in significance, and are defined more dis- tinctly than in the more neutral varieties of polyphonic development. Compare pars. 45 and S3- Exceptional Species of the Invention. 73. a. The Invention in Contrary motion (" per moto contrario "). In this species the Motive appears throughout in nearly, or quite, regularly alternating original motion and Contrary motion. See Bach, Prelude of the " Preludio con f ughetta " for Clavichord, in e minor (Peters ed. 200, No. 7). The thematic texture is exclusively two-voice, but an auxili- ary third part is frequently introduced. — Bach, Organ Comp. (Peters ed.), Vol. VII, No. 58, measures 1-7, 11-18, 22-28 ; in measures 32-40 a similar association of the original M. with its Diminution and Contrary motion is effected. b. The Invention with an Independent Lower part. The thematic manipulation is restricted, largely or wholly, to the inner and upper parts ; and the Bass accompanies these, chiefly as an auxiliary contrapun- tal associate. The latter may (1) be based upon some more or less characteristic figure, usually reiterated regularly, as in harmonic figura- tion ; or (2) it may be a Running part, in a uniform rhythm of two (cr more) notes to each beat. The first species is most common in Organ music ; the peculiar diffi- culties and limitations of Pedal-technique render it often expedient to assign certain adapted figures to the Pedal-part, either quite indepen- dent of the Motive, or as a modified (simplified) form of the latter. In either case it is absolutely necessary to preserve a certain (if not constant) uniformity of melodic delineation in the independent Bass ; especially when it is a running part, which must be prevented from deteriorating into a "rambling" part by consistency of formation, — i.e., by frequent recurrences, sequential or otherwise, of the leading figures. Review par. iyc. For example : Ex. 1 19 Lento. EEt t.±_ a^#^^ 3^3i Bach. S (73«) §SE M. cont.m. | etc. Pedal. asfe: 1 *o Par. 73b. EXCEPTIONAL INVENTION-SPECIES. 163 2. Allegro. Bach. M. -?— •- t=t LB il^si^ii m -p — • — f- -p. ,- B: M._ » etc. *i) The Pedal-part is based upon this independent M. throughout. *2) Here the Pedal has, constantly, a simplified form of the first member of the principal Motive. For further illustration : See Bach, 3-voice Invention No. 5 ; there are several brief thematic figures, the principal one of which is first announced in the upper part (one measure long) ; the form is Sectional, the style Lyric ; during the last 8^ measures, the inner part corre- sponds exactly to the upper part ol the First Section. The Bass is an independent auxiliary part throughout, in uniform harmonic Figuration. Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. I, Prelude 24 ; the Bass is an auxiliary run- ning part in 8th-notes, with two or three brief interruptions ; the consistency of its formation- is noteworthy ; the M. of the two other voices is one measure long, first announced in the inner part, and imitated mostly in stretto ; in Part II the original M. is abandoned, and in its place the modified Diminution is adopted as thematic basis, resulting in greater rhythmic animation throughout the Part. Bach, 30 Var. for the Clav. in G major; Var. 2. Bach, Organ Compositions (Peters compl. ed.), Vol. I, Sonata No. IV, 1st move- ment; the form embraces 3 Sections, with Coda, and an independent Introduc- tion; the M. is 6 measures long, first announced in the inner part; the Pedal-part (Bass) is entirely independent of the thematic voices; Section 3 (measure 25 from end) is wholly episodic, but corroborative of the foregoing Sections. The same Sonata, 2nd movement ; Pedal entirely independent ; design embraces 9 brief Sections; principal M. of two measures, announced by the upper part, carried through first 2 Sections (measures 1-1 1) ; an auxiliary M., one-half measure in length, is adopted as sole basis of Section 3 and (in Contrary motion) of Section 4 ; Section 5 (measures 22, 23) is episodic; the remainder is practically a reproduction of the foregoing, transposed, — Sections 6, 7, and 8 corresponding closely to 2, 3, and 4, extended by a 9th Section based on the principal Motive (last 5! measures). The same Sonata, 3rd movement ; 4 Sections and repeated Codetta ; M. 8 meas- ures; the Pedal takes the M. twice, — as regular third announcement (measures 2 1-27), and again near the end, — in a simplified form, convenient for pedal-technique ■ otherwise the Bass is independent. 1 64 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 74. Bach, same Volume, Sonata No. I, last movement ; 2-Part Song-form, " Gigue "- species; the Pedal has occasional fragments of the M., but is chiefly independent; Part II, after 15 measures devoted to the exposition of the Contrary motion, cor- responds to the latter portion of Part I, but transposed, and with inverted voices (par. 58). The same Sonata, first movement ; 2-Part Song-form, closely corresponding structure ; M. 1 J measures ; the Pedal is independent, excepting a very few imperfect imitations of the principal figure of the Motive. Mendelssohn, Pianoforte Capriccio, op. 5, middle Division (measures 135—290) ; M. 8 measures, upper voice ; running Bass during Part I ; M. in Contrary motion and running upper voice during Part II ; after 28 measures (3 complete announce- ments) the M. appears in sequential succession, each time contracted more and more at the end (up to the^ where another complete announcement is made) ; in Part III the original motion of the M., and the running Bass, are resumed. Mendelssohn, Prelude (Pfte.), op. 35, No. 4; 3-Part Song-form; Part I, Double- Period with Codetta ; Motive, 2 measures ; Part II is based upon a new M. of 2 measures, in stretto Imitations, but also announces the principal M. ; Part III like I, but abbreviated to Single Period with Codetta, and extended by a Period taken from Part II, and brief Coda; the Bass is a running auxiliary part throughout, and consists in strictly uniform harmonic Figuration. EXERCISE 22. A. Write a complete 3-voice Invention, with consideration of the essential conditions of the Spirited Style (par. 72a), and the Serious Style (par. 72*), as fol- lows : Adopt the design of the 3- Part Song-form; develop the rapid M. during Parts I and III, and the stately M. during Part II ; the second M. may be quite new (par. 48^), or it may be developed out of the first Motive by Augmentation (of a portion of the latter), — see par. 31a. This arrangement of movements reverses the rhythmic order given in par. 70a. B. Write an Invention in the Lyric Style, according to par. 72^,- mode, tempo, and form optional. C. An Invention with a Running Bass (par. 73*). D. An Invention for the Organ, with Independent Pedal-part (par. 73*). CHAPTER VIII. The Invention for More than Three Voices. 74. As the number of polyphonic voices or parts is increased, the texture assumes a proportionately pronounced harmonic character ; and the difficulty of preserving proper balance between the dissonances of Pat. 75. FOl/R-VOiCE POLYPHONY. 1 6$ friction, inevitable in the " independent conduct " of the parts, and the consonances indispensable to their " harmonious union," becomes more and more real and severe. Review par. 59, and par. 60. Details of Four-Voice Polyphony. 75. a. As before, the sum of 4 parts may be successively accumu- lated by adding contrapuntally first a second voice, then a third, and finally the fourth voice, to the leading part, — in such order as appears most convenient, and generally in brief stages of about five or six beats at a time. Review, thoroughly, par. 6i£. b. Or, probably better and easier, the three other voices may be led more nearly, or exactly, abreast of the leading part, and of each other ; their movements will then be controlled directly by the successive har- monic structures, or chords (i.e., the vertical clusters of essential tones, which are to represent the successive rhythmic pulses) ; and the vital condition of voice-independence must be satisfied at the same time by judiciously disguising these harmonic clusters. Review, thoroughly, par. (j\c The choice between these two processes wV.l p obab'y be determined by individ- ual disposition ; some students will find the " cumulative " process easier, while others will prefer the " harmonic " one. c. The importance of the Tie, and of parallel movement in jrds or 6ths between two of the parts, is as great, here again, as in three-voice texture, and must not for an instant be lost sight of. Review, thor- oughly, pars. 61 //and e; also par. 6i_/". d. The rules relative to the conduct of the lowermost part, to the rhythmic conditions of the polyphonic texture, and to the adoption of a temporary leading part, apply without modification also to the associa- :i ki vi four contrapuntal parts. Review, thoroughly, pars. 62, 63, and 64; aL>j the summary, par. 65. Especial care should be taken to avoid too great density of texture. To this end, it is wise to sustain the rhythm of at least one of the voices as much as possible, — as shown in Ex. 122 (Note *4) ; and, at all events, to avoid conducting all the parts together in (simultaneous) rapid rhythmic movement, or in any fashion that pro- duces a " jumbled " rhythmic effect. e. The condition which probably increases most in significance, in this fuller species of polyphonic writing, is that of the Rest ; not only i66 APrLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 75ft because the temporary cessation of one (or more) of the voices conduces to greater variety of volume, and to greater clearness of texture ; but also because it facilitates, very materially, the manipulation of the whole. On the other hand, the indispensable discipline of strictly 4- voice Polyphony obliges the student (for a time, at least) to abstain from such frequent use of Rests, — especially protracted omission of one or another of the four parts, — as would reduce the present task to that of the 3-voice texture. Review, particularly, pars. 63$ and 63c. For illustration of the domination of the harmonic principle, and the methods of preserving voice-independence, etc. : m M._ Ex. 120. Effi J^-A -J * 3 U- M._ I I M._ *0 f= f^ 2fe #-h«^ m 5££ J -I 1 ^ j j j M.. *4)" "-t *7) M.. *3)' mm *6) Ebl-II 7 V IV I IV 7 V 7 IAt?V 7 VI 7 Et>V 7 I VI IV c-e-g(b-d). a-c-e. d-f-a. b^-f-a. c-e-g-b. f-a-c. Par, 76. FOUR-VOICE POLYPHONY. J 67 *i) Last tone of M. lengthened (par. 30a). *z) Shifted rhythm (par. 31^). *3) First tone of M. lengthened (par. 30^). *4) Suspension. *5) Parallel 6ths in upper, and 3rds in lower, voices (par. 6\e). *6) This line of Roman numerals indicates the harmonic basis ; compare with par. 18 « to c *7) The Triad upon the Leading-tone (sometimes marked VII) is an abbreviated form of the Dominant 7th-chord. *8) From the Well-temp. Clav., Vol. I, Prelude 7, measures 10-15; the student is to continue the analysis, up to measure 24. *9) From the same Prelude, measures 36-38 ; continue the analysis, with extreme thoroughness and minuteness, to the end. *io) The " chord-forms " are here indicated in letters, without regard to the accidentals (which are always determined by the key), or to the chord-names. *i 1 ) All tones foreign to the prevailing chord-form are marked + ; it will be observed that they invariably obey the law of inharmonic tones, and progress con- junctly. Compare par. 4a. *I2) These two beats illustrate admirably the fundamental rule of rhythmic relation of the voices (par. 65/). Observe, also, how effectively the rhythmic movement of the other parts is restrained (by heavy notes) while one part is active. *I3) Indirect resolution of Suspension (Ex. 10). *I4) These beats illustrate a very effective interaction of adjacent parts, whereby one part appears to cooperate with its neighbor in furthering some melodic or the- matic purpose of the latter ; in this instance the descending scale passes, without a check, from the Soprano into the Alto, and from that into the Tenor, describing a long and powerful line, and unifying the parts without impairing their independence. Compare Ex. 116, Note *5). Analyze the following specimens of 4-part Polyphony ; very minutely, but only with reference to the voice-conduct, — not thematically : Bach, Well-temp. Clav., Vol. I, Fugue 1, last 7 measures ; Vol. I, Fugue 12, last 6 measures; Vol. I, Fugue 14, last 9 measures; Vol. I, Fugue 17, last 8 measures; Vol. I, Fugue 18, last 10 measures. Bach, Well-temp. Clav., Vol. II, Fugue 5, measures 1-16; Vol. II, Fugue 9, measures 1-9; Vol. II, Fugue 23, measures 14-27. The Four- Voice Invention. 76. Review par. 37. — When four polyphonic parts are used, they are always named Soprano, Alto, Tenor, and Bass, in analogy with the vocal quartet. Review par. 66a. i68 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 11. The structural designs are somewhat more limited, — in keeping with the other specific limitations of 4-voice Polyphony ; hence, while any of the forms already enumerated may be adopted for the 4-voice Invention, the Sectional form is probably the most appropriate and effective. The First Section, or Exposition. 77. a. The Motive must, as a rule, be brief, comparatively narrow in compass, and of quiet (or at least not too lively) rhythmic character. The following Motives are used by Bach for 4-part development : 2. Moderate. 121. 3. Allegretto. 4. Adagio. 5. Moderato. ^^trTTj fei^ g^^^g p 6. Andante. 7. Andante. ^M 3PS a& :£=$! H: t* ±t£ m PB See also Ex. 120, Nos. 1 and 2; and Ex. 122. b. The first announcement of the M. may occur in any one of the four parts ; and, as usual, one or two, or possibly all, of the other parts may supply auxiliary lines (either contrapuntal, or simply harmonic) until their turn comes to imitate the M. legitimately. Review par. 67 «, b, and c. c. The order of Imitations at the beginning of a 4-voice Invention may be regular ; i.e., each successive Imitation may appear in the part nearest (adjacent) to the preceding imitating voice ; thus, after Soprano, in the Alto ; after Bass, the Tenor ; after Alto, either Soprano or Tenor ; after Tenor, either Bass or Alto. But this regularity of voice-succession is by no means necessary in the Invention, and the utmost freedom is exercised in the choice, both of the interval of Imitation, and of the voice in which the Motive is Par. 77c. THE FOUR- VOICE INVENTION. 169 next to appear, — not only at the beginning, but through the entire Exposition. Compare par. 6"]d; and see also par. 67*. For illustration : Lento. M . Ex. 122. *&- i^iSl -1- s -»-*-! ^r^rr *o *2) 9M* OE ^s^a^^^i^ p fSf*r©^S c ^f= ± p?m^s Episode. 3) M M._ iJLl^^O irt 3^^ »— * * 1 M._ (5 See Original ^^JJ^PjS e^ *■ Bach.*5) M. , M. a*— (Slj *■ ^-p ■*- , etc. f— 11 fe=b ¥=^^^= — -— =ti •1) Motive in Soprano; Alto and Tenor tacent; Bass auxiliary. •2) Unessential modification of the M., corresponding to par. 33 — (1), which e. This form recurs frequently, later on. 170 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 78. *3) Thus far the order of Imitation is regular, as concerns the part-succession, — Soprano, Alto, Tenor. In the following measure the M. appears again in the Alto, and during the next 3 (sketched) measures two other announcements are made, in upper parts, before the Bass announces its legitimate Imitation, in the 9th measure. *4) Observe, here again, how carefully the inner parts are restrained in their rhythmic movement, by long notes, while the outer parts are active. The same disposition to preserve good balance of motion and to avoid " jumbled " rhythmic effects is evinced throughout. See Ex. 120, Note *I2), second clause. *S) From the Prelude of the " Preludio con Fughetta " in d minor, for the clavichord (Peters ed., 200, No. 6). 78. The remaining Sections of the 4-voice Invention are conducted in the usual manner. Review par. 68 ; and analyze the following Inventions, in sectional form, very diligently : The remainder of Example 122. Bach, English Suite No. I, " Prelude " ; introductory cadenza of 2 measures ; M. given in Ex. 121, No. 3 ; Section I ends in measure 9, and is extended by a Codetta of 1 J measures ; Section II closes in measure 16, followed by a similar Codetta ; Sec- tion III extends to 3rd measure from the end, and has the same Codetta, extended. (Compare last two measures with Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 19, end.) The texture is frequently 3-voice (compare par. 75*), and the register of the four parts is somewhat obscure, at times. Bach, Toccata for Clavichord in c minor, measures 12-29; M. given in Ex. 121, No. 4. The rhythm is gradually accelerated. Bach, Toccata for Clavichord in f% minor, second tempo (3-2 time) ; M. chro- matic, first announced in Soprano ; Bass has the M. once only, abbreviated. Bach, Air with 30 Variations (Clavichord); Var. 16, second tempo (3-8 time); chiefly 3-voice texture. Bach, Fantasia con Fuga in u minor (Clavichord), "Fantasia" (Peters ed. 208, No. 2) ; Section I, measures 1-12, is purely introductory, containing only allu- sions to the Motive ; it is 5-voice texture, and harmonic in character, and recurs as Section IV (measures 31-42), transposed; recurs again, as Section VI (measures 69-80), transposed; and once more, as final Section (last 12 measures), as a nearly literal da capo. The M. is first announced in Section II (Soprano, measures 11-13, — given in Ex. 121, No. 2), and imitated, chiefly in stretto, during this and the next Section (to measure 31) ; in Sections V and VII (measures 42 and 80) the rhythm is more or less persistently animated, — somewhat after the manner of par. 700. Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. I, Prelude 12; the M., 2 beats long, is an- nounced by the Soprano, and then followed by a lyric extension (or episode) before an Imitation occurs, — in Tenor ; the Bass is auxiliary, taking no evident part in the thematic announcements ; the same is partly true of the Alto, also ; there are three Sections, the last one containing fin measures 16-18) a fairly convincing indication of a return to the beginning, and thus imparting the impression of 3-Part Song-form (primary grade). Par. 79. THE FOUR-VOICE INVENTION. 171 Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. I, Prelude 4 ; M. one measure^ Soprano part ; the texture is largely 3-voice ; there is a strong Dominant cadence in measure 14, which probably resolves the structure into a 2-Part Song-form (primary grade). The manipulation of this M. is extremely ingenious and instructive; unique rhythmic modifications, and the shifted rhythm, occur frequently ; analyze carefully. Bach, Toccata for Clavichord in d minor, measures 15-32 ; M. 3 beats, in Alto. Bach, Fantasia con Imitazione, Peters ed. No. 216, Section II (| time); M. undergoes several modifications. Bach, Fantasia, Peters ed. 215, bottom of page 7 to page 10. Same volume, page 22, — first 4 measures introductory; M. in Alto, one measure. Bach, Fantasia, Peters ed. 1959, pages 94 to 97, — first 14 measures introductory. Same volume, pages 99-100 (C time). Mendelssohn, Var. se'rieuses, op. 54, Var. 10. Bach, Organ Comp. (Peters compl. ed.), Vol. VIII, No. 8; independent Bass (par. 73«). EXERCISE 23. A. Write a 4-voice Invention, in brief sectional form, in minor ; with an original Motive, patterned after those shown in Ex. 121. Especial reference must be made to par. 64 (Leading part) ; Ex. 122, Note *\) (sustained parts) ; par. d\d (Ties) ; par. 63 b,c (Rests). The Imitation in Augmentation, and also in Diminution (par. 31 a, i), are both available in 4-voice texture, and must not be neglected. B. A 4-voice Invention, sectional form, in major. Other Structural Designs. 79. Besides those in sectional form, occasional examples of the 4- voice Invention are found in the 2-Part or 3-Part Song-form. For example, see — Bach, Air with 30 Variations (Clav.), Var. 4; M. of 3 notes, Soprano part; first Imitations in alternate original and contrary motion (compare par. 73a) ; definite 2- Part Song-form. Same work, Var. 22 ; M. of 2 measures, first announced in Tenor, after i£ intro- ductory measures ; definite 2-Part form. Bach, English Suite No. I, " Allemande " ; the M. of Part I is presented in a mode of notation peculiar to ieyooard-instruments, and, as it represents harmonic bulk rather than individual tone-/>««, scarcely justifiable in any other than these inferior grades of polyphonic writing ; it appears thus, after 3 introductory beats, Ex. 123, and is imitated in this form without exception to the end of the Part: the Second Part has a new M., announced in Bass after two preliminary beats ; the last 4 meas ures of the Parts correspond. 172 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 80. Beethoven, Variations, op. 120, Var. 24 (M. for each Part, somewhat free). 80. The fullness and weight of 4-voice Polyphony leave less oppor- tunity for distinctions of style than were definable in 3-voice texture, and therefore the Serious or Stately style is almost the only consistent variety (par. 72^). a. But it is possible, by such use of protracted rests as will virtually reduce the texture to three voices, for a time at least, to realize the lyric, and even the moderately spirited styles. This is ingeniously illustrated in Bach, Clavichord Sonata (Peters ed. No. 213), No. I. " Gigue." b. Another device, very common in the 4-voice Invention, and es- pecially effective in the lyric style, is the adoption of a brief thematic Figure, which is carried through the several voices more as an inciden- tal than as an essential motive, and merely enlivens what is actually a definite harmonic stratum. Compare par. 72*/. This was seen in Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. I, Prelude 12, cited above. See also Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 16 ; M. of 4 notes, an- nounced at once in Soprano ; its recurrences, often much modified, are recognizable more by the striking rhythm than by the melodic form; the first 3 Sections (4 measures each) are very similar. Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. T., Prelude 22 ; M. of 5 notes, Soprano, often extended by sequence, and at times contracted to 3 tones ; 2-Part Song-form. Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 1 ; the first 4J measures are an Introduction, containing only intimations of the M., which first appears in its legiti- mate form, in Bass, at the end of measure 5, where Part I begins ; the texture is largely episodic ; the design is 3-Part Song-form, with transposed Third Part (meas- ures 20-29 corresponding closely to measures 4^-13^. shifted one-half measure). In organ music the association of three thematic parts with an independent Bass (pedal-part), as explained in par. 73^, is effective and not uncommon, — especially in connection with the elaboration of a chorale melody (to be considered later on). See Bach, Organ Compositions (Peters compl. ed.), Vol. V, Nos. 1, 14, 16, 38, 56, and others. The Five- Voice Invention. 81. An Invention for 5 parts is naturally rare. When so elaborate a polyphonic apparatus is employed, it is mostly in the service of the higher grades of Polyphony. It is, however, easily possible to expand Par. 81. THE FIVE-VOICE INVENTION. 173 the 4-voice to an ostensible 5-voice texture, by the occasional addition of a 5th part, with entire freedom as regards register, though usually in thematic form. The M. should be brief, narrow in compass, and of „;uiet, if not heavy, rhythmic formation; the style will probably be lyric, or stately. See Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 1 1 ; M. of 4 notes, Soprano, reproduced twice in same voice, in Contrary motion, before the regular Imitations begin. The 'design is genuine 3-Part Song-form; Part I ends in measure 16, and is followed by a complete sequential reproduction, before Part II appears (in measure 33). Texture largely 4-voice. Analyze minutely. Bach, Organ Comp. (Peters compl. ed.), Vol. IV, No. 12. — Same Vol., No. 11, second Division (Grave) ; M. 2 measures, Soprano ; observe, also, the frequent ascending scale-passage, in whole measures. EXERCISE 24. A. Write a 4-voice Invention in 2-Part Song-form ; all details optional. Either an original Motive or one of the following may be used : 1. Sosten. I 4 2. Andante con moto. m -U4 P iifM^^^^i Tenor. Soprano. 3. (Exercise 19.) I* • I gfee^ =P=t =r=t Bass. B. A 4-voice Invention, in " Gigue "-form, moderately lively tempo, according to par. 80a. C. A 4-voice Invention in Lyric or Serious style, with Incidental thematic Figure, according to par. 800. D. An Invention for 5 parts ; form optional. Either the following or an origi- nal Motive : Lento. M , i *£ liE EE s- -1 -1 M. T~l r etc. 174 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 82. CHAPTER IX. Free Polyphonic Forms. — - The Invention as PrSlude. — The Fantasia, Toccata, Etc. 82. In a genuine Invention the principle of thematic Imitation pre- vails with little or no interruption ; for though it represents the lower grade of polyphonic writing (par. 37), it is nevertheless Polyphony ; the thematic development is of primary, the structural design of secondary, importance. In Homophony this relation of qualities is reversed, — the material subserves the Form. But it is not always possible, or desirable, to separate these two domains of musical thought absolutely, and many intermediate varieties exist, in which a mixture (or the alternation) of the two ruling purposes is exhibited. Thus, the Invention may very gradually deteriorate from its original polyphonic rank, — as the thematic treatment becomes more and more loose and free, and the episodic passages more extended and independent, in the pursuit of some more and more marked structural purpose, — until it becomes partly (at times totally) homophonic in character and effect. And, on the other hand, a genuine homophonic form may, by the interlineation of more or less assertive and extensive imitatory passages, assume a partially (at times distinctly) polyphonic character. Examples of such intermediate grades have been quite frequently cited in the preceding pages, and in some instances their classification among the " Inventions " has been doubtful, — in exact proportion to the increasing importance attached to all essentially structural (formal) conditions. See, especially, pars. 45, 51, 53, 72, 8o£. It appears, therefore, that this primary division of the polyphonic forms, for which the collective term " Invention " has been adopted, embraces a number of subordinate varieties, inclining more or less posi- tively toward the homophonic domain, and distinguished by certain peculiarities of design or treatment. The Prelude. 83. As its name indicates, the Prelude was not, originally, a sepa- rate and independent composition, but always an adjunct of some Par. 83. THE PRELUDE. 1 75 legitimate form (or of a collective set of pieces), in the inferior capacity of a preliminary or introductory movement. The inferiority of rank thus involved is exhibited in many and vari- ous ways : either in looseness of form, or in freedom of technical detail, or both ; in frequency, extent, and homophonic quality of episodes ; in indifference to the number of parts, — the frequent employment of purely auxiliary tones or melodic fragments, and free interchange 0/2,3, 4 ( or more)-part texture; or in a certain general superficiality and sketchiness of character, suggestive, in extreme cases, of a mere improvisation. Such a form, consisting mainly in a free exposition of the principal harmonies of the key, perhaps with thematic allusions, may very appro- priately precede, and prepare the hearer for, the more definite design and thoughtful contents of the principal movement to follow. The degree of inferiority depends mainly upon the function assigned to the Prelude ; and likewise, while the species of texture (homophonic or polyphonic), and the general style (lyric, dramatic, brilliant, etc.), are almost entirely optional, they may be partly definable according to the character and quality of the principal movement with which the Prelude is connected. a. The treatment of the Prelude is, as a rule, most serious when it precedes the Fugue. In this connection it is likely to be a genuine Invention, entirely (or largely) polyphonic. Generally it bears no other relation to its Fugue than that of key; — time, tempo, Motive, and character may be independent of the latter, though occasionally the M. of the Prelude is derived from the Subject of the Fugue. The latter (thematic) coincidence does not appear in any of the 48 numbers of the Well-temp. Clavichord, excepting, perhaps, in Vol. I, No. 23 (B major), where a faint, probably accidental, resemblance between the first 4 notes of the Prelude and of the Fugue, may be traced. In the 6 numbers of Mendelssohn's op. 35, also, there is no thematic connection between Prelude and Fugue, save a brief coincidence in No. 4 (Ao ). On the other hand, see Rubinstein, op. 53, where thematic connection is obvious between Prelude and Fugue in Nos. 1 and 6 ; and, more incidentally, in Nos. 3 and 4. Generally the Prelude to a Fugue ends with a complete cadence on the Tonic, becoming thus a separate piece, virtually independent of its Fugue. In rare instances, however, especially when the Prelude is brief, and of a looser, more extemporaneous character, it closes with a Dominant semi-cadence, leading, as Introduction, into the Fugue. See Rubinstein, op. 53, Nos. 1, 2, 4, and 6, — Dominant ending. In the Well- temp. Clavichord, and in op. 35 of Mendelssohn, the Preludes are independent. 176 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 83b. The texture is distinctly polyphonic (i.e., Invention-species) in the following Preludes of the Well-temp. Clavichord, already analyzed: Vol. I, Nos. 4, 9, 12,. 14, 18, 23, 24; Vol. II, Nos. 4, 5, 8, 10, 11, 19, 21, and 22; also No. 3, 2nd division. The texture is of a less strict type, including more episodes, or definitely homophonic passages, in Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. I, Nos. 17, 20; Vol. II, Nos. 9, 13, 17, 18. It is ai a more general imitatory character (less definitely thematic) in Vol. I, No. 16; Vol. II, .Nos. 1, 16. Prelude 11 of Vol. I is based upon Sequence rather than Imitation. For all of these the term Prelude, (or Prelude-Invention) is more appropriate than " Invention " would be. See also, Bach, Organ Comp. (Peters compl. ed.), Vol. II, Prael. 1 ; Invention, 3- to 4-voice, indep. Pedal, sectional. Vol. II, Prael. 5 ; 2-Part Song-form. Vol. II, Prael. 7 ; Invention, 4-voice, 2 motives (Pedal an indep., 3rd, motive). Vol. II, Prael. 9; many motives, definite sectional form, ample confirmation, 4- to 5-voice. Vol. II, Prael. 10; very similar to Prael. 9; 4-voice. Vol. Ill, Prael. 1 ; long sectional form (ten Sections), free, but including genuine polyphonic texture (Sees. 5 and 8) ; confirmations, and Da capo. Vol. Ill, Prael. 4 ; 3-Part Song-form. Vol. Ill, Prael. 9 ; three divisions : Introduction, Invention (4-voice, 2 Sections), Transition into Fugue. Vol. IV, Prael. 2 ; two motives, sectional. Vol. IV, Prael. 3; three divisions: Prelude, Thematic section, Coda. Mendelssohn, Organ Comp., op. 37, Prael. 1 ; Invention, elaborate thematic treatment; excellent illustration of fragmentary manipulation; 4-voice, long motive, sectional (quasi 3-Part Song-form). Op. 37, Prael. 2 ; 3-Part Song-form, motive for each Part ; distinctly thematic, but homophonic (lyric) in character. Op. 37, Prael. 3 ; 4-voice, six Sections ; a principal Theme with various counter- motives, in different (accelerated) rhythms. b. The Lyric Invention, with a long, melodious Motive (pars. 53, 72*:), belongs properly to the Prelude variety ; and when the lyric pur- pose so overshadows the polyphonic that evidences of thematic imita- tion are faint, and incidental in effect, it becomes ultimately a Prelude as Aria, with, at most, occasional imitatory traits in the accompanying parts. See Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. II, Prelude 24, 14; Vol. I, Prelude 13, 8. The extreme limit of this design is touched in the following — almost distinctly homophonic — Preludes of the Well-temp. Clavichord: Vol. II, No. 12; Vol. I, No. 10 (with long Coda, as Toccata, — par. 84), No. 1 (simple chord-figuration) ; Vol. II, No. 3, first division (the same). c. The Chorale-Prelude is an organ composition, designed to precede the congregational intonation of the opening chorale in the Lutheran Par. 83d. THE PRELUDE. 177 and other Reformed church-services, chiefly in Germany. Hence its M. is derived recognizably from the first line of the chorale, and the treatment is usually distinctly, sometimes severely, imitatory, as in the Invention ; though evidences of the freedom of design and treatment characteristic of the Prelude-species are seldom wanting, and sometimes so pronounced as to lower the Prelude to the rank of a mere Chorale- Fantasia, — ■ especially in practical expositions, which are quite com- monly actual polyphonic improvisations, i.e., made extempore. Examples of this form will be cited in Chapter XI. d. The Prelude as opening number of a Suite is more independent than any of the foregoing, and may be isolated, as well as any other number of the Suite. In this respect it resembles, and probably was the incentive to, the variety treated at e below. It relates to the succeeding numbers of the Suite solely in point of key ; and its texture may be selected, at option, from the whole range of Polyphony ; very rarely, indeed, however, is it any more severe than the genuine Invention (Bach, English Suite No. I) ; most commonly it is of the looser fabric of the " Prelude "-species (as in Bach, English Suite No. VI, first 37 measures ; Bach, Prelude to Suite, Peters ed. 214, pages 3 2 > 33> — fi rs t *5 measures introductory); sometimes of a general imi- tatory character, without manifest thematic development (as in Handel, Suites Nos. V, VI, VIII ; Bach, Sonata, Peters ed. 213, pages 4, 5 ; same volume, pages 20, 21); possibly still more nearly, or absolutely, homo- phonic (as in Handel, Suites Nos. I, III ; Bach, Prelude to Suite, Peters ed. 214, pages 18, 19). The Prelude as " Fantasia " is touched upon in par. 85. e. The modern Prelude, as isolated piece. ' The propriety of the title Prelude is apparently cancelled by isolation, for its relation as " Prelude '' to a subsequent movement is uncertain, if not utterly chi- merical. But it is nevertheless possible to institute close analogy with the legitimate Prelude-form, by preserving such traits as distinguish the latter, or, at least, imply its origin in that early era of musical history which gave rise to the conventional Prelude. The modern isolated Prelude will therefore usually be found to exhibit some traces of this origin, in remnants of the polyphonic bearing of earlier centuries ; in the presence of certain scholastic details which suggest (if they do not constitute) "imitation," "contrapuntal treatment," or other distinctive traits of the traditional Prelude; particularly in the absence of that 178 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 83e. dominating romantic expression, significant of the modern conception of music. For example : Mendelssohn, 3 Praeludien, op. 104 (No. 1, thematic, contrapuntal, but free, and not imitatory ; No. 2, running parts; No. 3, elaborate figuration, quasi thematic). Rubinstein, 6 Preludes, op. 24 (No. 1, elaborate running inner part ; No. 2, already cited, Invention ; No. 3, imitatory, — at times almost canonic ; No. 4, Toccata ; No. 5, elaborate figuration; No. 6, imitatory). Beethoven, Praeludium in / minor (Peters ed. 142) ; thematic, quasi Invention. Chopin, Prelude, op. 45 ; elaborate figuration. Bach, Praeludium, Peters ed. 1959, page 67 (Invention). Schumann, Praeludium, op. 99, No. 10 ; elaborate figuration Bach, Organ Compositions, Vol. VIII, No. 11. Further, the title " Preludes " has been assigned by several modern writers to a series of 24 pieces in each of the 24 major and minor keys, partly in analogy with the design of Bach's Well-temp. Clavichord ; and also partly because this device supplies the pianist with a piece (pre- sumably brief, and either extemporaneous and sketchy in character, or of the traditional "prelude" consistency) in every key, and therefore actually available, if desired, as preliminary sentence to any number upon a concert-program, — as far as the relation of key is concerned. This is the modulatory disposition of the 24 Preludes of Chopin, op. 28, several of which exhibit, furthermore, certain scholastic traits (Nos. 1, 3, 4, 5, 8, 12, 14, 15 — the persistent reiteration of ab =gt, — 19, 21), while others are brief or extem- poraneous (Nos. 2, 6, 7, 9, 10, 11, 16, 18, 20, 22, 23) ; and others, again, are lyric and definite enough in design to merit a more significant title (Nos. 13, 15, 17, 21, 24). See further : Heller, 24 Praeludien, op. 81 (brief, rhapsodical, and extremely loose in respect of formal design, — -with but few exceptions). Heller, 32 Praeludien, op. 119 (cer- tain keys represented twice, or oftener). Hummel, 24 Preludes, op. 67 (all brief, and distinctly extemporaneous in design and effect). Further: 2 Praeludien by Beethoven, op. 39 (Peters ed. 142) ; each is a modu- latory study, the design being to describe the complete circuit of major keys, twice ; — both are thematic, the first one (cited above) more definitely imitatory than the second. The Toccata. 84. This is one of the earliest forms of instrumental music, and derived its name from the primitive mechanical act of manipulating the keyboard (toccare, to touch). Originating thus, long before instrumen- tal music had assumed any of its present definite structural designs, the early Toccata was a formless succession of figures and runs, some- Par. 84a. THE TOCCATA. 1 79 times purely harmonic, again imitatory and contrapuntal, often in- coherent and indefinable. It was the legitimate forerunner of the Fantasia, but has retained its own title to the present day, and has gradually developed into a somewhat more definite and characteristic style, the basis of which is the manipulation of a small Motive, or mere brief Figure, usually of but two or three notes, — possibly strictly poly- phonic, as in the genuine Invention, — much more commonly, however, only partly polyphonic, or even purely homophonic ; generally in lively, vigorous tempo. a. The Toccata as single movement : The Toccata as Invention is exemplified in Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. I, Prelude 22 (already cited) ; Vol. I, Prelude 15 ; Vol. II, Preludes 2, 6, 15, 23, and 7 (the last more graceful than the ordinary Toccata). Bach, English Suite No. Ill, " Prelude " (Figure of 3 tones, uppermost part ; texture variable, from one to five parts; broad sectional design, — par. 68^, — with da capo). Bach, Toccata con Fuga, Peters ed. 211, page 4, Allegro moderate. Bach, Organ Comp. (Peters ed.), Vol. Ill, No. 2, "Toccata"; No. 3, "Toccata" (approaching the Prelude-species). It assumes the looser Prelude consistency in Bach, Well-temp. Clavichord, Vol. I, Preludes 2, 5, 6, and 21 ; Vol. II, Prelude 3, first 24 measures. Bach, Preludio con Fuga, Peters ed. 211, pages 14-21 (two Motives, in close succession) ; same volume, pages 28-31, Allegro. Bach, Preludio con Fuga, Peters ed. 214, pages 4, 5; same volume, pages 10, n. Bach, Toccata, Peters ed. 215, pages 19-21. Bach, Organ Comp., Vol. II, Prael. 2 ; Prael. 3 ; and Prael. 8. Vol. Ill, Prael. 5, and Prael. 7. Vol. IV, No. 4, "Toccata" (encloses the Fugue, quasi as Prelude and Postlude). See further, Schumann, Toccata for Pianoforte, op. 7 (largely homophonic, but with occasional Imitatory, and even distinctly thematic, passages). Of kindred texture and character is the last movement of Beethoven's Pianoforte Sonata, op. 54; and even the Finale of his Sonata, op. 26, might be called a Toccata. It is left to the student to inspect such other examples of the Toccata, both homophonic and polyphonic, as he may find in published literature for Pianoforte or Organ. b. The Toccata sometimes appears as collective form, of three, four, and even more distinct divisions, or movements. In this broader and more elaborate design it usually comprises as many distinctions of style as there are divisions, and is therefore a composite of Invention, Pre- lude, Toccata, Fantasia, — very frequently including also the higher Fugue-species, — in apparently optional succession. See Bach, Toccata for Clavichord in e minor (Peters ed. 210, No. 1), three brief, totally independent sections, the 2nd (£, Allegro) a. Double Fughetta, to be consid- ered later; a. Fugue follows, to which the Toccata may be considered to be a. " Prelude." Bach, Toccata in f% minor (Peters ed. 210, No. 2), four different, but l8o APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 85. kindred, divisions : I, an introductory " Toccata " ; II, a 4-voice Invention; III, a Fugue, connected with IV, a Double Fugue, by a curious sequential Interlude of 31 measures. Bach, Toccata in c minor (Peters ed. 210, No. 3), very similar: Move- ment I, an introductory " Toccata " ; II, a 4-voice Invention ; III, 0. Fugue, connected by a brief Interlude with IV, a Double Fugue, followed by brief Coda. Bach, Toc- cata in d minor (Peters ed. 210, No. 4), three divisions: I, a brief introductory "Toccata"; II, 4-voice Invention ; III, Double Fugue, followed by a Coda. Bach, Toccata con Fuga in g minor (Peters ed. 211, No. 1), four divisions: I, introductory Cadenza, three measures ; II, Aria, 12 measures ; III, an Invention, 2- to 4-voice; IV, a Postlude, n measures. The "Fuga" which follows is entirely independent of the Toccata, excepting in key. Bach, Toccata in G major (Peters ed. 215, No. 3), three movements : I, Toccata; II, 4-voice Invention; III, Fugue. Bach, Organ Comp., Vol. Ill, No. 8, "Toccata"; four divisions (31 measures introductory Cadenzas). The Fantasia. 85. This is of still less definite and definable form and consistence than the Toccata, though in many respects closely connected with the latter in origin and character. It is, as its name indicates, a fanciful combination of tone-effects. Irregularity of design, freedom of melodic and rhythmic treatment, and generally incoherent character, are there- fore almost essential conditions of the species ; at the same time, the domination of a central tonality, occasional concurrences of style (cor- roboration of former sections), and the evidences of at least a broadly consistent progressive design, cannot be wholly dispensed with. The texture of the Fantasia, as a whole, is more likely to be homo- phonic than polyphonic, though the latter style is frequently adopted for certain sections, — probably in unconscious imitation of the technical conditions under which, centuries ago, the Fantasia came into existence. For illustrations see Bach, Fantasia for Clavichord in c minor (Peters ed. 212, No. 1), already cited, as 2-voice " Invention." Bach, Chromatic Fantasia, d minor (followed by a Fugue). Bach, Fantasia in g minor (Peters ed. 215, No. 5), introduc- tory Cadenza, 2 measures, — the rest a strictly polyphonic "Invention" in double counterpoint, to be analyzed later. Bach, Fantasia e Fuga ("Peters ed. 1959, page 80, 21 measures) ; same volume, pages 84, 85, — quasi " Toccata." Bach, Clavichord Sonata (Peters ed. 213, No. 3), first movement; this bears no other title than the tempo-mark, Adagio, but it is a " lyric Fantasia," quasi " Aria." Handel, Clavichord Suite No. 1, " Prelude," — clearly Fantasia in consistency. Bach, Fantasia con Fuga in a minor (Peters ed. 208, No. 2), already cited, as " Invention." Bach, Organ Comp., Vol. Ill, No. 6, " Fantasia"; 4-voice Invention, or rather, Invention-group, 2 Motives, for successive Sections ; treatment serious and strict ; form very definite. Vol. Ill, Prael. 10; VoL IV, Prael. 1 ; and PraeL 5. Vol. II, No. 4, "Fantasia' (elaborate). Par. 86. THE FANTASIA. l8l The Fantasia as more elaborate collective form, — like the broad Toccata, — is illustrated in the following : Bach, Fantasia con Fuga in D (Peters ed. zn, No. 3) ; five movements, viz,, Introduction, Toccata, Interlude (similar to Introduction), Double Invention, Post- lude (similar to I and III), — followed bya Fugue. Bach, Fantasia in a minor (Peters ed. 215, No. i)j three movements, — Toccata, Invention, Toccata (similar to I). Bach, Fantasia con Imitazione (Peters ed. 216, No. 7) ; two movements, — Introduc- tion and Invention. Bach, Organ Comp., Vol. IV, No. 11 ; three movements (the " Grave " already cited as 5-voice Invention). General reference may also be made to the more modern, and almost wholly homo* phonic, Fantasias : Mozart, Pianoforte Fantasia (followed by a complete Sonata) in c minor (Cotta ed. No. 18); Mozart, Fantasia for Pianoforte in ./minor (Cotta ed. No. 23) ; ditto in c minor (Cotta ed. No. 24) ; ditto in C major (Cotta ed. No. 25), — followed by a Fugue. Mendelssohn, op. 15. Mixed Forms, of a General Imitatory Character. 86. Finally, there is a very numerous class of musical forms which are neither definitely homophonic nor polyphonic, but a mixture of both ; partaking of the characteristics of the Invention, the Prelude, and the Fantasia, though not strictly to be classified as any of these. Such mixed forms rest upon a homophonic basis, and therefore ex- 'hibit distinct harmonic and melodic traits, and, generally, well-defined form. The polyphonic elements are exhibited, side by side with these, and more or less sparingly, in incidental imitations, or a general imitatory bearing, quite different from that continuous thematic development of which Imitation is an essential factor, — the essential condition of the genuine Invention, as has been seen, and, in a higher degree, of the Fugue and Canon, as remains to be seen. Many of the examples cited above, under the head of the Prelude, Toccata, or Fantasia, belong properly to this mixed class, though designated thus definitely by their authors, and, usually, approaching most nearly in general design the character of the form in question. The most characteristic examples are to be found in some of the " Allemandes " and " Courantes " (more rarely in the " Bounces," " Gavottes," " Minuets," and kin- dred dances) of the French and English Suites, and clavichord Partitas, of Bach. In these the " melody " is usually continuous, and sometimes as distinct as in purely homophonic writing; the harmonic successions are everywhere clearly apparent, and the design is almost always regular. But fragments of incidental imitation are frequently introduced ; or, at least, the general impression of contrapuntal texture (partial voice-independence) is sustained, —despite the entire freedom exercised with regard to the number of parts employed, and the use of auxiliary tones. See particularly, Bach, Clavichord Partita III, " Allemande " (decidedly poly- phonic in general effect, though no evidences of systematic imitation exist) ,■ same 182 APrLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 87. Partita, " Courante," " Sarabande," and " Burlesca." Bach, Partita IV, " Alle- mande" (quasi Aria) ; " Courante" (quasi Invention, — M. in contrary motion dur- ing a portion of Part II) ; " Aria" (general voice-independence, but little evidence of even incidental imitation, — the same is true of the following " Sarabande " and " Menuet "). Bach, Partita V, " Allemande " (quasi Invention ; the M. evades strict definition, being rather of a rhythmic than melodic consistency). Bach, Partita I, " Allemande " (quasi Toccata, — occasional incidental imitations) ; " Courante " (quasi Invention, M. of one measure, in upper part, chiefly in sequential succession). Bach, Partita II, "Allemande," is a genuine Invention, already cited; the following " Courante " is quasi Invention, but the imitation is more incidental than essential ; " Sarabande," — incidental imitations, chiefly in 2nd Part. Bach, English Suite No. I, " Courante I " (a few faint traces of thematic imita- tion, and considerable incidental imitation ; the form is unusually regular and defi- nite, the melody of measures 4 and 8 being similar, in both Parts ; the voice-texture is treated with great freedom). Bach, English Suite No. Ill, " Courante," — excel- lent example of incidental imitation, and general voice-independence, without a trace of thematic development. Bach, English Suite VI, " Allemande " ; and the " Double " of the " Sarabande." Bach, French Suite I, " Allemande " and " Courante " ; " Sara- bande" (the first 5 measures of Soprano, in Part I, become the Bass in Part II, and again Soprano, 4 measures later) ; " Menuet I," similar. Bach, French Suite V, " Bourree II " ; French Suite VI, " Courante." Handel, Suite for Clavichord No. I, " Allemande " and " Courante " ; the texture is quite regular (3-voice, occasionally 4), but it is only of a general imitatory charac- ter, not definitely thematic. Handel, Suite III, "Allemande" and "Courante";. Suite IV, "Allemande" and "Courante"; Suite V, "Prelude," "Largo," and "Gigue." And so forth; the majority of Handel's clavichord pieces, excepting the Fugues, are replete with incidental imitations, but not strictly thematic. Scarlatti (Peters ed. No. 277), Suite No. I, "Preludio," "Sarabande"; Suite II, "Courante," " Scherzo " (quasi Invention) ; Suite III, "Courante" (quasi Inven- tion, several Motives, Large 2-Part form). Mendelssohn, op. 7, No. 1, No. 2 (Nos. 4 and 7, — see par. 87), No. 6. Mendelssohn, Var: serieuses, op. 54, Var. 2, Var. 3, Var. 4 (quasi Invention). Also, Variations, op. 83, Var. 4. Schumann, Jugend-Album, op. 68, No. 40 (" Kleine Fuge"), first 22 measures (quasi 3-voice Invention). D' Albert, Pianoforte Suite, op. 1 , •• Allemande," " Sarabande," " Courante." Brahms, op. 76, No. 8. Arthur Foote, op. 45, No. 1, Invention; 2-voice; 3-Part form. Homophonic Forms with Polyphonic Episodes. 87. A mixture of the polyphonic and homophonic styles, of stiL another kind, is obtained by introducing brief thematic imitations, oi complete thematic sections, into a composition of distinctly homophonic character and otherwise unalloyed homophonic texture. Par. 87. MIXED FORMS. 1 83 Such incidental polyphonic episodes may occur in the course of a homophonic design (as, for instance, during the Second Part of the Three-Part Song-form) ; or the form may begin, like an Invention, with genuine thematic imitations, which extend for a few measures and then gradually (or even abruptly) relax and yield to pronounced homophonic treatment ; or, more rarely, the polyphonic texture may be adopted near the end, as a means of promoting interest or creating a climax, — or as basis of the Codetta. For illustration : Beethoven, Pianoforte Sonata, op. 2, No. 1, "Trio" of the Menuetto (thematic throughout, quasi Invention of the "Prelude" consistency). Sonata, op. 2, No. 2, Finale, first 16 measures (a 3-Part form, in which Part II, measures 9-12, is imita- tory). Sonata, op. i, No. 3, Scherzo (thematic throughout, quasi Invention, " Pre- lude "-species). Sonata, op. 10, No. 2, Allegretto, measures 9-30 (Parts II and III, imitatory). Same Sonata, Finale, entire; broad 3-Part form, quasi Invention with homophonic episodes ; thematic imitation almost constantly, but within the definite limits of a homophonic design. Sonata, op. 10, No. 3, Menuetto, Part II. Sonata, op. 22, Adagio, measures 34-45. Sonata, op. 27, No. 1, Finale, measures 106-131 (thematic imitation). Sonata, op. 28, Finale, measures 29-35 > an< ^ measures 79-101 (thematic, M. of 4 measures, upper part). Sonata, op. 54, Finale, first 28 measures. Sonata, op. 109, Finale, Variation IV and Variation V. Beethoven, Variations, op. 35, var. V, 2nd Part; var. V'l, 2nd Part. Variations, op. 120, Vars. IV, V, VI, IX, XI, XIV, XXX (portions of each). Variations in A (Righini-Theme), Var. VII, — 2-Part form, new Motive for Part II ; Var. XXI, 2nd Part. Mendelssohn, op. 7, No. 4 (partly thematic, almost throughout) ; op. 7, No. 7 (general imitatory character); op. 14, Principal Theme of Rondo; Prelude, op. 35, No. 3 (quasi Toccata, practically homophonic, but with numerous imitatory epi- sodes). Organ Sonata, '.p. 65, No. 5, Finale (Sees. I, III, and V are based upon a Motive of two measures ; Sees. II and IV upon a new Theme, longer, and lyric, with more animated accompaniment). — See also, again, op. 37> No. 2. Additional Miscellaneous Examples. Schumann, Papillons, op. 2 : No. 3 ; No. 9, Second Part. Schumann, Intermezzi, op. 4: No. 1, measures 3-7, measures 17-24; No. 5, " Alternativo," imitatory throughout, with harmonic accompaniment (in figural form in Part III). Schumann, Symphonic fetudes, op. 13: No. 1, measures 1-8; No. 8, thematic Imitation throughout (quasi 4-voice); No. 12, measure 37 ("animato ") to 75, the- matic Imitation, partly 2 Motives. Schumann, Waldscenen, op. 82, No. IV ; also No. III. Schumann, Kreisleriana, op. 16, No. 5, measures 5-14. Schumann, Novellette, op. 21, No. 1 (5-flat signature). Schumann, Romanzen, op. 28, No. 3, measures 1-24 ; also " Intermezzo I," thematic Imitation throughout, quasi 4-voice. 1 84 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 88. Schumann, Gigue, op. 32, No. z., 3-voice Invention, sectional. Chopin, Mazurka, No. 32 (op. 50, No. 3), measures 1-9, 33-41. Chopin, Mazurka, No. 41 (op. 63, No. 3), measures 1-10 from end. Chopin, Ballade, No. 4 (op. 52), measures 134 (cadenza) to 145. Chopin, Scherzo, No. 3 (op. 39), measures 59-98 ; Motive in Bass, measures 59-66, and repeated, in octaves ; Imitation in inner voice, measures 75-82, and meas- ures 83-90. Chopin, Etude, op. 25, No. 11 ; the Motive (measures 1-2) pervades the en- tire Etude, with figural accompaniment ; not strictly Invention, but thematic, and generally polyphonic. Schubert, Pianoforte Sonata, op. 143, principal theme of the Finale. EXERCISE 25. A. Write two examples of the Prelude as Invention (minor and major, respec- tively), according to the general explanation given in par. 83, and with reference also to par. 86. B. An example of the Toccata (in one or two movements), according to par. 84. C. An example of the Fantasia (par. 85). D. Two or more examples of the homophonic Three-Part Song-form, with imita- tory episodes as indicated in par. 87. Use a different mode, different measure, and different style (par. 72) for each. DIVISION THREE. CHORALE-FIGURATION. Introductory. 88. The contrapuntal elaboration of the Chorale (the characteristic representa- tive of German ecclesiastic song since the days of the Reformation) has always been regarded by serious German masters of the past three centuries as a most important and truly indispensable part of the academic discipline of the composer; and, while a portion of this conception may be due to religious enthusiasm, it is nevertheless a just and wise pedagogic view. There is, unquestionably, no field of contrapuntal training so reliable and wholesome, so stimulating to the determined student whose aims are serious and genuine, and, best of all, so many-sided and inexhaustible, as "polyphonic Chorale-elaboration,'' — or "Chorale-Figuration," as it is more commonly called. For this reason, although its immediate practical utility may not be apparent (as available "composition"), its very thorough and conscientious exercise is warmly Par. 89. CHORALE-FIGURATION. 1 85 urged upon the student ; particularly upon him who desires to master the Fugue and Canon, — forms which cannot (as a rule) be successfully realized with the compara- tively limited contrapuntal technique that will have been acquired through the exer- cise of the Inventions only. Chorale-figuration affords precisely the quality and degree of supplementary technical discipline required for the proper achievement of these higher polyphonic forms. 89. Chorale-elaborations are divided, according to their magnitude, and certain distinctions of treatment, into two classes known as the Small Species and Large Species. CHAPTER X. The Small Species of Chorale-Figuration. 90. In the small species the adopted chorale melody (called the cantus firmus) is placed in the uppermost part, as regular Soprano, and in its original metric condition, without extensions or interruptions. The exercises are to be written for the Organ, and therefore the lower- most part is for the Pedal keyboard, while the upper three parts are placed on two staves for the Manual keyboard (generally one, possibly two). The student who is unfamiliar with the technique of the Organ must first obtain at least a general insight into the treatment of the Manuals and Pedals, before under- taking the present tasks. The only information, that can be given here is, that the compass of the pedals is, generally, as follows : ~ 3& and that the tones of two adjacent manual-parts should always be well within reach of one hand. Elaborate Harmonization. 91. As the basis of this species of polyphonic texture is again mainly harmonic (see par. 75^), the student had best begin with experi- ments of a specifically harmonic nature, and make a number of chorale harmonizations, as ingeniously as possible and elaborately as desired, in ordinary 4-part writing (with or without Pedal-bass), after the manner of the following : Bach, Organ Comp. (Peters compl. ed.), Vol. V, No. 36 (analyze thoroughly) ; end of No. 53; page 60, I; page 68, I; page 76; page 105. — Further, Vol. V, No. 1 86 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 92. 27. — Vol. VI, No. 26 (5-voice). — Vol. VII, No. 53 (chorale melody extended by rests before and between the lines ; imitatory, but not thematic). Thematic Accompaniment. 92. The number of parts ordinarily employed is four : the cantus firmus, two inner parts, and the Pedal bass. a. The three lower (accompanying) parts — including the Pedal — are to be thematic ; that is, a Motive (or brief Figure of one or two beats) is adopted, and imitated in the usual manner, as contrapuntal harmoniza- tion, or Figuration, of the given chorale. The cantus may be written in J -notes, with a thematic figure (below) in J* -notes ; or in J -notes, with figure in J* or J* -notes. Or, these values dotted (f or J^- time). For illustration (beginning of a chorale) : Ex. 124 I -I ypcd jjQ^^ p i Man. U.*%) M. r^-t etc. s i2. Longer Motive tj-QEr^=t M. ^^B&ESit^ etc. m X =3 M. (cont. m.) M. M. S3 Par. 92b. CHORALE-FIGURATION. 1 87 *i) C. F. — the cantus firmus, or given chorale melody. *2) The Motive, or thematic figure. In this instance it is only one beat long ; in the next version it is a genuine " Motive," two beats in length. *3) Imitation in contrary motion. Every conceivable device of Imitation may be freely used, in this polyphonic task. *4) Or an 8ve lower; the Pedal-bass is generally kept fairly low, though it may cross the Tenor occasionally, without objection. See also Ex. 129. b. The usual harmonic process must be pursued, more or less in- sistently, in defining the chord-basis of each beat or tone of the cantus firmus ; but the effect of the accompanying (Jigural) voices must be thor- oughly polyphonic. Much liberty may be taken with the adopted Motive ; as a rule, it should be present constantly, in some part, in some shape or other, — Ex. 124, Note *3) ; though it may, briefly, be replaced by episodic fragments, either derived from the M., or independent. It is not necessary to have a separate chord for each tone of the c.f. The same chord may be held through two successive tones, or more ; or the harmony may change within one c.f. tone. Modulations, both diatonic and chromatic, must be freely made, and may be as swift as is compatible with perfect smoothness. The Pedal-part should be kept somewhat more quiet (sustained) than the inner parts. See also Ex. 124, Note *4). The end of each " Line " of the chorale is designated bya^s; this, however, merely serves to mark the lines, and is not to be respected, in the Small species, — no check of the rhythmic movement is to occur, anywhere. At the same time, these final tones (/*n) should produce a certain cadential impression, and therefore they should, as a rule, be harmonized with some triad, in fundamental form. At the end, the thematic rhythm runs on, a beat or so (usually in one or both of the inner voices), past the final c.f. tone. Or, better, the final tone may be expanded to a whole measure, or more, while the lower parts effect a plagal ending. The following illustrations are to be analyzed very thoroughly and minutely : Bach, Organ Comp., Vol. V, No. 22 (M. in Alto, one beat) ; No. 48 (M. in Tenor, one beat) ; No. 33 ; No. 32 (M. in Pedal, two beats) ; No. 5 ; No. 2 (M. in Pedal, two beats) ; No. 4, verse II (M. in Tenor, four beats) ; No. 47 (manuals only) ; No. 31 (M. in Pedal, four beats, divided into two definite figures; inner parts largely episodic). 188 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 93. Table of German Chorales, for Use During This Entire Third Division. N. B. It is not obligatory to use the keys here given. The chorales may, sometimes must, be transposed to other, higher or lower, keys. 1. * ps^JF^P^^^Spg^ n\ ^ u=i &E*3£f -&—&- fel s *=i4 ? Pe&^Se^=E -z^- zgH- 'g- fe fet* S g'-hsi— •- *- -zsi--^ - — (=- g o r o— gi- (*-v) g Sg^ gs -s<— z^- ^: -e>— -&■ X s -*- '9— 3— e— gt— » m &— -P=F — f 2 — is- t=F 4. (orrfV) pa^S 5 1 =S I F ■fSZ— <&- 5. ^ ^=3=EgE^. 1=1 ttzzf: ■ gi — — '-si- ^ fei^-J^^gESi^ ggji^^j FT* 1 fl Vi 1 /T\ n\ v , ™ r» j , 11 yf b h 1 t J _i _] 1 1 r=> M fft\" 1) • a "• * J ^ II im — 10 ^ -s 1 «* - * r- eJ -s> II i « se lT=P=-T w--z*- s>- -^ t=±±t * **= f=fe=f-=s=-s=g~jj ■s 1 — s>~ - i «r 1=* 3=^= - si— g^~ Tgl— gH :t=t^f i «= *=}= 1 £ =t=£ -s>— g 1 - ?= «— fc=*— =»- o 8 - 1 1 n\ /T\ /* | | 1 1 2 h / * 1 | | | 1 If ■\" I / ■ zi s 1 w a -■i — s^ ^—,5= s> 10. -*-• 3-H5 1 - ^ I T7 (oT or D I) -g>- E^=i ^J— si- -gi— g- Eg -g— |g— pP— — si- -zi—&- ±B±t •-+- i u. =9 - ^-s 1 - -s> si— — -<» si I g' -j 1 >=j — £•_ - g &J 190 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. gz. SjrjzlJ^B i ESI l=±t -g-hg- -*-•- ^= — (=- :^z ■(=—(=- :fc=tt=t t=t i W^T^F f^ it-. js — g£ -1=2— « S> t=t=& t=5f=tt=t t±t=t iP^ t=t 13. pz&fc $ = g=E^IJ=2 * szzg. pfeg p^ gg Z^±g t=t g-'- g, eJ W-* — ^ i a -g gj - -g a <- 14. is ■&—z i- -zt- f fg -g> t=4 8e a^s- >»— •- ^EESFE^E^ ~2gl- i iS> . if - ^=^ EEEiEEEB 1 &< — H g g; gv i a) (2)1) (or b V) ^EEEJJEjgjg 3=3=:* £ rt-\ n\ / | 1 | / - r> 1 > - 1 | | 1 E 1 ^ 1 r= ci J _fi ^ a * m a /J ■ t^ 1 • gJ -6- cs -*>- i (may end here.) IE - g—^- 3 s 3"-f2-(=- ^E Par. 92. CHORALE-FIGURA TION. 16. I 9 I g^^^gpi^^^i aJJ. 1 /T\ 1 ;T\ | if TM | , | | .{2. fiJ J J c e> , '-p a 1 * -] 1 «5 \j a i 5 IE -2=1- O— <=- ^ g I S? 17. $ l^lii&fe E£ -s>-f=- ■ g-gl- ? -a-g- _lS,_w Z5 r Sssfe 3 TZXZLjBZ^. -tf—& i — (^ lEEEEEf :^=zst -g — sJ- g— ^- -&—&- g 18. Same as 17, but in (^-measure : =t |etc gE* «-(=- EEE^EE^E^B J=tt=t (either) A similar transformation of any (^-measure chorale into 2 measure may occasionally be made. 19. $0$M i % gzgi-c- i=tf =1= -asHg I - 1 20. ^ = fe^ rfzEgp^ - g ^ - ig — \-& — &— \- <9 — &- zJ fefHr -&— -& — &- s 3 192 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 92. 21. [ ^fe^g ^^g^ iaSi S^ a n\ 1 1 IV\ 1 1 /T\ 1 J | [ | 1 | | | 1 I 2 f 3 | | | | • a KU c>-=" a* ci d & e * LW_ — U- --JK ' i I §H6EpHE^3g -z*- ■|S2-- -g- s'- ^ =t±t= i 3= II =fa gj-g- -f2-S>- Sl^iii^S^^ I ■fZ— (2- 1 g^=S=F f 2 - =~ -fepj— Zg~ -—<9 23. "zrrf*' 1 1 "i — ~Hd r» f ~=~\ 75 — j — 1 — 1 4 v*<-Jr-\-+--±-*^- -*-^~ -f-i — <*- —J- -^-p-r-^j- i s>--(= — (a >=3 — 1 ■(=-—&- 31- -■g—g)- -° «g I 24. H HE g flrnr-i— 1 i*~ —X-OL- §5=^=[ &-&- jfS-fi- s>- gj gj ; J=t= g ^:&» r? fg t=t 1 25. I a tea rgrtatizz -<=- -|S_£2_ §ffii ^ ^ ¥=•- -^±^ =p= f=t-- - - ^ — g* I g^-H 26. H&: -1= |S- =1=1= - ■& — s>- Par. 92. CHORALE-FIGURA TSO/v. 193 rf\ /■^ f \ — ' 1 -A b 1 nJ r> c ,f If aJ &J « R" [ Jtz n *_. rt\ IT\ | 1 11 /T h - 1^ f S<: II ©) 1 VO c " hi s) *= II O II 27. =1= 3= i gFS=g=s 5--22--» •— =)— L <»- fe rfaE^^i^EEEF^E&D^ ?g= Tj^- Tg # "25 1 — <9 28. li 1 ^ /!N — y-t^T-TtT 1 1 1 (2— (2- -m—^ef- ^^=til_ :j "^ * _-3*-*-.i£ ^1=^:-^ ^_^:&_^- Fft^r =4= -h ■ (^ -*r /T\ -i- A- — [- /T\ II 4^ 3= • ^ -<9 sJ -B*- ^-(S>- II 29. i ±=t ^ ^BF^J: ^ =p=^g= ^=^= ^^~:p=i=g: i f= ■5 !=- (2 (=— -«>■ I 15: p— g ^— g f -g>- t=t ~ :^= l«-*--& 194 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 93. EXERCISE 26. A. Harmonize a number of the above chorales, according to par. 91. Write the chorale in J -notes, \ or f time ; limit the accompaniment to J*- and occasional fe -notes; ehvploy organ-notation (3 staves, including Pedal-bass). B. Two 4-voice thematic elaborations of No. 1 of the given chorales, with a Figure of one beat and two beats, respectively, according to par. 92 a, b. Use \ time, and imitate closely the Bach examples. C. The 4-voice thematic elaboration of two or more other chorales, in any keys, with a Motive one whole measure in length. The end plagally extended, f, f , or ^ time may be used. Independent Pedal-Part. 93. Partly for the sake of effective variety, and partly on account of the limitations of pedal-technique, it is quite common to conduct the Pedal-bass independent of the inner thematic voices. This is done (1) either by so modifying (simplifying) the Motive as to adapt it better to thf character and technique of the pedals ; or (2) by adopting an inde- pendent (auxiliary) figure for the bass, in more sustained rhythm. See par. 73^; Ex. 119; and the following : Bach, Organ Comp., Vol. V, No. 1 ; No. 13 (inner parts thematic, but largely episodic) ; No. 14; No. 16 (running Pedal-bass) ; No. 28 (entire Pedal-motive 3 meas- ures long) ; No. 38 (very characteristic Pedal); No. 40; No. 46; No. 50 (Augm. of Motive, in Pedal ; observe rhythmic form of c.f.) ; No. 54 ; No. 55 (Pedal-motive, a simplified form of figural motive) ; No. 56 (M. in Pedal related, but longer) ; No. 4, Verse 3. Brahms, " Choral- Vorspiel " (and Fugue) in a minor. Embellished Cantus Firmus. 94. Although it is characteristic of the present task to restrict the c.f. to the exact form of the original chorale, it is, nevertheless, both natural and desirable (especially in actual practice) to modify cer- tain tones of the given melody by means of unessential passing- or neighboring-notes. a. Such embellishment of the c. f. may be limited to strictly unes- sential auxiliary tones, introduced here and there in order to facilitate the thematic development, but not altering or obscuring the original chorale tones. Or it may consist in occasional slight changes of the original even rhythm, by means of dots. For example : Par. 94b. CHORAL.E-FIG URA TION. 195 Original. gjfeEJ p^iiiiE ex. ; 125. • i Slightly modified form. fa J^pE 3^EEE I -3^t jffi^E Bach. i and: i Iff S^^Sfe £ Bach, Organ Comp., Vol. V, No. 22 (already cited) ; No. 25 (Pedal indep.) ; No. 49 (ditto) ; No. 41 (c.f. embellished thematically, i.e., according to figural Motive ; Pedal, simplified form of M.) ; No. 53 (compare with above Table of Chorales, No. 22 ; the modification of the c. f. oversteps, somewhat, the present limit. Compare, also, with reference to the c.f. only, the preceding and following numbers of Vol. V — Nos. 52 and 54). b. Or the modification may extend to a systematic ornamentation of the chorale melody, involving all (or nearly all) of the original tones, and resulting often in a richly embellished form of the c. f, to which the lower parts, though usually the- matic, appear to constitute a subordinate accompaniment. This variety of elabora- tion will be considered in detail further on (par. 107). Motive Derived from Chorale. 95. The motive of the thematic accompaniment may be, and very frequently is, derived from the first line of. the c. f. ; usually by simple Diminution of the first group of (three or four) tones ; or by unessential figuration of them. Thus : First line of c. f . = Motive. i -• — ?- ■P3=fC I Ex. 126. H ^ =53 2. Beg. of Chorale I m^ * =t etc. Motive. Bach. mm « n More elaborate forms are shown in Ex. 128 I 96 APPLIED COUNTERPOufT. Par. 96. See Bach, Vol. V, No. 21 (contrapuntal associate retained throughout) ; No. 12 (ditto). 96. Finally, each of the three accompanying (figural) parts may have its own, separate, motive.- Each should be sufficiently character- istic, especially in its rhythmic form, that of. the Pedal-bass being natu- rally the most sustained ; and they are likely to differ in length. Each part announces its motive independently, and without necessary regard to regular association with the others. In Bach, Vol. V, No. 9, the following 3 Motives are manipulated, more or less independently of each other : Ex. 127. ^^^m ^fi ^tfiiu In Alto. In Tenor In Pedal-bass. Analyze the whole number thoroughly, and see also Bach, Vol. V, No. 1 1 (less thematic than " figural "; Alto and Tenor appear to cooperate in announcing a com- posite motive, or figure, of one or two beats ; the Pedal is independent, and not obviously thematic). — No. 1 7 (somewhat similar ; inner parts cooperate ; Pedal plainly thematic). EXERCISE 27. A. Write a 4-voice example, with Independent Pedal-part, according to par. 93. Select chorale from the table given in Exercise 26. B. An example with slightly embellished c.f., as in par. 94a. C. An example with a Motive one measure long, derived from the c.f. ; par. 95. D. An example with separate M. for each part ; par. 96. Three- Voice Elaboration. 97. When two parts only are added to the c.f., they are most likely to be an inner and lower part for the manual keyboard ; though a Pedal- bass is of course possible. The following specimens are all somewhat peculiar, especially those in which the c.f. is placed in a lower part, instead of in the Soprano. Analyze carefully: Bach, Vol. V, No. 30 (c.f. in Soprano, slightly embellished ; running inner part ; Pedal independent). Vol. V, page 81 (Var. VI) — cantus firmus in Pedal-bass. Vol. V, page 86 (Var. IX) — cantus firmus in Pedal, as inner voice ; two motives- Par. 98. CHORALE-FIGURATION. 1 97 Five-Voice Elaboration. 98. For this an Alto, two Tenors, and Pedal-bass are added to the c. f. The motive is apt to be brief, and rests may be freely used. See par. 8i. Bach, Vol. V, page 91 (Var. XI) — Pedal independent ; strictly 5-voice, through- out. Vol. V. No. 42 (chiefly 4-voice; <.. f. slightly embellished; separate M. for Pedal.) Miscellaneous. Bach, Vol. V, No. 4, Verse I (two motives together, Double counterpoint, in inner parts; Pedal employs motive 1 exclusively). — No. 6 {c. f. in Alto, slightly embellished; M. two beats, in Soprano; same simplified for Pedal). No. 24 (running Tenor, two alternating motives ; Pedal independent ; Alto uniform rhythm with c. f. ; brief pauses between the Lines). — Brahms, Choral-Vorspiele, op. 122: No. 2 ; t. /. in Sopr., emb. ; 4-voice; indep. Pedal. — No. 5, c.f. in Sopr., 3-voice — fine example. — No. 6, ditto, 4-voice. — No. 8, elab. harmonization; 4- voice, c.f. richly emb.; each Part rep., with c.f partly in Tenor. — No. 11, ditto; 5-voice; c.f. in Sopr.; end of each line extended by two-fold "echo." — No. 9; c.f, in Sopr., richly emb. ; Ped. independent. EXERCISE 28. One or two examples each of the 3-voice and 5-voice chorale elaborations. CHAPTER XI. The Large Species of Chorale-Figuration. first variety : invention with chorale. 99. In this larger and more elaborate species, the thematic or figural voices are the chief, essential factors, while the chorale melody is (at least apparently) an incidental factor. The first Line of the c.f. is preceded by an introductory exposition of the Motive ; similar the- matic Interludes occur between the Lines of the chorale ; and a more or less lengthy Postlude follows the final Line. Hence the chorale melody has the appearance of entering incidentally, when convenient, into the thematic texture, while the lower parts pursue the initiatory development of the adopted Motive (precisely as in the Invention), as aim and burden of the entire composition. Of the Large Species there are several varieties, the first and sim- plest of which is called " Invention with Chorale." 198 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 100. Cantus- Firmus in Soprano. 100. This — as in the Small Species — is the most natural, and probably most common, location for the chorale melody (c.fi). a. The Motive is usually at least a measure long, often much longer. It may be invented "free," i.e., independent of the c.f., and in that case it is wise to select some melodic progression (of two or three tones) that occurs frequently in the course of the chorale (as, for instance, the tone-repetitions in chorale No. 24 of the above table), and invent the Motive as characteristic counterpoint to that figure ; this ensures its availability at these points, at least. b. But it is somewhat more likely that the Motive will be derived from the first Line of the c. f, — possibly, though rarely, from the last line, or even some other (striking) line of the chorale. The derivation may be simple, as shown in Ex. 126 (which see). Or it may be elabo- rate; for example, all the following motives (and many more) are derived by Bach from the first line of the same chorale : 3fe Chorale Mel. (Table, No. 18). ist Derivative (Vol. VI, Xo. 4). ■j wrr H T mm m Ex. 128. -et—ejr fflE ££ *o rf 3*± •=* m$ 2nd Derivative (Vol. VI, No. 5). 4 (EfeE ■a 3-*- i§± 23E 3S53 atzrfr »2) r*n m rd Derivative (Vol. VI, No 6). hr~ff - ^ ^^^£ bb^=Hetc. ~ Z *-« ! Mill I ilLi-a^ — H 4th Derivative (Vol. VI, No. 7). ^^m -*|v *3) Par. iooc. INVENTION WITH CHORALE. 199 nfttt 5th Derivative (Vol. -f>-i „ 1— ' -1 VI, No. 8). -7r¥# F±f l -\-f~ p -f~r — 7f-#-H^i— — - 1 1 i I H -*»-* — £p*^ —lit ' 1 J-*— $>— %-^-» — 1 »— m 4— — • ..,--# — i_^p :^*wr- — 1 1 ■ 1 — ^ — W— *■ _ •H-j-i — 1- s :& -,!-•- 6th Derivative (Vol. VI, No. 9). 7th Derivative (Vol. VI, No. 10). u 4- 3=p* 'Ir^H -K— ^ ~J- ^ =•=?= =t=t •-*- __ m — r =P£ etc. 8th Derivative (Vol. VI, No. 3). fl^piPlPlSipH *i) The rhythmic arrangement of the original tones is preserved, in this Deri- vative; i. e., the ac cents of the successive groups, regularly, represent the successive chorale notes (marked - -). This is desirable, but not obligatory. *2) Here the original tones are shifted a trifle ; and at *3) they are transferred to the higher octave. *4) The remainder of the chorale line is vague, — probably intentionally aban- doned. It will be seen that, despite the freedom in choice and extent of added tones, the Derivatives all bear a distinctly recognizable relation to the original c . f. line; the latter " sounds ouc " plainly through the new array of tones. Observe the variety of measure (J/-, f, f, f, f). c. Not infrequently, two or even three Motives are used (par. 52). d. The introductory measures, or " Prelude," are a regular Expo- sition of the Motive, as in the Invention, and subject to the same rules (par. 40) ; but a cadence is not made, as a rule, until the c. f. (the first line of the chorale) has entered and has been conducted to its end. The first tone of each line of the c.f. must be some chord-interval, but may be either consonance or dissonance (7th, 9th, etc.). The final tone of each line may be Root, 3rd or 5th of the chosen triad, but the latter must be fundamental (Root in Bass). 200 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. iood. The c. f. should not be modified, excepting by an occasional, strictly unessential, passing-note ; or by some other equally harmless change. Care must be taken not to proceed into a new chord or key so soon after the final tone of each c.f. line, as to leave the latter (after its ces- sation) an implied dissonance ; that is, the final tone should, for at least a full beat after its conclusion, appear (in the hearer's recollection) to harmonize with the thematic voices, and fade away in their subsequent conduct. e. The end of each " Line " is, practically, the termination of a Section of the Invention, — though a definite cadence is not obligatory. Each succeeding Section begins with an " Interlude," devoted to con- tinued thematic development in the figural voices while the c.f. voice pauses ; very similar in character and conduct to the " Prelude," but more free. The length of these Interludes is optional ; usually a measure or two, often more, — the c. f reentering, each time, when convenient. Review par. 99. f. The very last tone of the c.f. (the final tone of the last line) should be a Root, if possible. The voice which has the c. f — the Soprano, in this instance — may, after prolonging the final tone a few beats, join in the thematic elaboration, usually beginning its participation with an announcement of the Motive. This extension, the " Postlude," may be of any reasonable length. 101. In executing the task, the thematic (or figural) parts and the c. f (when the latter is present) may be carried along abreast of each other, with constant regard to the announcements of the Motive ; or the M. alone may be inserted, beforehand, in one part and then another, where it promises to agree well with the c. f. - — somewhat after the manner of leading parts (par. 64, which review). At all events, the Motive should appear very frequently, if not incessantly, in some part or other ; and therefore great freedom may (must) be exercised in rendering the M. adjustable, by altering the quantity of its interval-progressions (rarely, however, by changing its rhythm, excepting for possible Augmentations, complete or partial). Contrary motion, shifted rhythm, and stretto Imitations are to be freely employed. The Pedal-bass should be conducted, in general, more quietly than the manual parts. It may, occasionally, be independent (par. 93). Progressions in alternate opposite direction, with or without skips, are peculiarly adapted to pedal-technique : Par. ioi. INVENTION WITH CHORALE. 1. Pedal-bass. 2. Ex. 129 ^ 201 Bach. IsSip^lpB^ilpiilB For general illustration of the process (No. 16 of the above Table of Chorales ; Motive in large notes) : Ex. 130. Prelude. H?To W= £ 55P& *£ tt± *-•- p-»- HE ^^fe^^i^^t M. /4 llegrelto tranquillo. (or 8va alta m 12; flz ^3§ * • ==? fe*: „ . Cantus firmus. -4 ± ££ wm m cir -*-?- > i £J +-*:■*.• ■»-f-F-fc=F ■»-# E§ -•-* iz^EEB^ ±E -•-* ££ -) ^ ^ -*—* Seb s -si— I P3 «tS— *3) £-" -*- -•- • - -fc— I 1 — F-»- Iff f -5,»~ =t=t ^E 3=t 3£* It si-t : ^H - 'iRi=^-,-» s=? tt 202 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Interlude. Par. 101. r*^ ~ *5) . <=■ f- £^ 5H £-= j- \*-*$j&rr— '*• v^'f -t^^- 1 — ^~mv~- — ? — ; — tT~ i. -* b LJ — *"" ■ LJ t, ^P=l , : : ^=^ ^ H^F^"^-^ ,J. J J m GOETSCHIUS. W~f -^-s^- ♦ ^Jtpi- t*+. -m- -f-«h — i— +--\--f--f- » ^ -s S=± 1 etc. M. extended. gyf^p^^1^g¥%a g *i ) The contrary motion of the M. is very freely used. *2) The c. f. enters as chord-seventh. See beginning of second Line, also. This is effective. *3) Fragments of the Motive. *4) The Line ends as chord-root, *5) Observe that the abandoned c. f. tone (f) is understood as harmonic tone through the following half-measure ; par. ioo b). Similar substitutions of the diminished or augmented 5th (and 4th) for the perfect 5th (and 4th) are quite common, and are due to the very same principle that gives rise to the general exception under discussion (par. 116). See Note to Ex. 136. Here the bb confirms the principal key, F major. — See also Ex. 146, No. 3. *3) Same as Note *2). c. Repetitions or embellishments of the Dominant, at or near the beginning : 1. Subj. {e minor). 2. Subj. I Resp. Bach. =^t£: ■0 — *-p-#-r m EE «= m =F? :fczfc -# — r » . p- -I 1 ! ! \ I 3=t 3. Subj. Resp. Sfe Faisst. ^^n p p t=£ rtfF =J=u Or, adding to this last Theme (Ex. 139—3) various embellish- ments of the initial Tonic (as in Ex. 138), the results would be: 1. 2. Subjects. ,_^etc. 3. 4. Ex. 140. 0mm .etc. Responses to the above, ^etc. ^etc. .etc. wmm *2)' wm^m .etc. .etc. ^etc. 7fr»7 SP^ Ii Par. ii7d. THE "RESPONSE." 1\J *i) In every case (excepting No. 4) this g is imitated in the augmented 5th , (d i N.B. 2. Subj. Resp. Bach. ;^i ^^JjllfeEii ^f ^l'*- ■+**+* (0) (j) ir * r V a *2) 3. Subj. N.B Resp. (a) m^mm 3^S fcHE ■*>— m etc S=f 5 w 5 I I I Very doubtful. Par. 120b. (0 gi^Hi rafi "RESPONSE: if) 223 Si *=d=4 ^g •^^ttei Possible, and not improbable. 4. Subj. Probably the best Response. Resp- 11 Mozart. fc gjg^^^^£ | gggjj|j| 1 P #* I 5. Subj v ^^. m^jfc^J tot Resp. ■•4) Bach. *±JL Pa: J| • fc ' • 1 i 6. Subj. P &es ^S K§ etc. etc. Itflit *6) i Resp. Bach. 3=P-/-*- =*=» -3— u — SS|g N.B. 7. Subj. It ^1 §±e -si- s -f — •- Resp. *7) Weinlig. £1 t=f II ^s N.B. 8. Subj. E9%# St SI etc. etc. *8) Resp. Mozart. m $=m=^$ N.B. *i) This initial Dominant is answered in the 5th (contrary to par. n6«), because of the characteristic formation of the Theme. Comp. par. 118. *2) The initial Dominant is here simply one of a series of unimportant passing- notes leading into the Tonic, and is therefore answered in the 5th. Further, Bach 224 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. hi. chooses/It for the 3rd tone of the Response (instead of the expected /J), in order to preserve for an instant the impression of the original key. *3) In case Response (c) were to be chosen, this would be it) in preference to 6 b. Otherwise, the latter is more probable. *4) The final tone is imitated in the augmented 4th, to preserve closer relation to the original key, — probably because the Subject is brief. Compare Ex. 138, Note *2). *5) Same as Note *4). *6) The striking modulation into the Dominant key, so near the beginning, must be answered in the 4th, — similar to par. 1 \"]d. *7) The prominent Leading-tone, when absolutely indicative of the Dominant chord (as here), and not merely an embellishing note of the Tonic (as in Ex. 138, No. 1, 2nd tone), is subject to tonal imitation, with all that is inseparable from it. Comp. par. wjd. *8) Like Note "7). EXERCISE 35. A. Analyze all the Responses in the Well-temp. Clavichord of Bach. B. Write the Responses to all the original Subjects invented in Exercise 34. And invent a numb«r of new Themes (and Answers), with reference to the above traits. CHAPTER XII. The Four-Voice Fugue. — The Exposition. 121. The Exposition or first Section of a Fugue contains as many announcements of the Theme (Subject and Response alternately — par. 114) as there are parts employed. In the 4-voice Fugue the order is, therefore (when regular), Subject, Response, Subject, Response. a. The first Response may begin simultaneously with the final tone of the Subject (Bach, Well-temp. Clav., Vol. I, Fugue 8). Or immedi- ately after the Subject ends (Vol. I, Fugue 6). Or still a little later, so that one or more tones must be added to the Subject, as intervening figure (Vol. I, Fugue 1, one intervening tone ; Vol. I, Fugue 2, ditto ; Vol. I, Fugue 12, two intermediate tones ; Fugue 1 1, three tones ; Fugue 3, four tones ; Fugue 7, seven tones, — more than this number could scarcely be justified). Or, more rarely, the Response may enter before the cadence tone of the Subject, as brief stretto (Vol. I, Fugue 9 ; the Par. i22. THE EXPOSITION. 225 Response overlaps the Subject one beat, possibly three, — the length of Subject is somewhat uncertain). b. In the third of these possible cases, where intermediate tones are used, the latter must be carefully chosen, in keeping with the conduct of the Subject, and with a view to their subsequent employment as thematic basis of the episodic passages (as in Vol. I, Fugue 7). 122. The first counterpoint — that which follows the Subject in the same part, as contrapuntal associate of the Response — is sometimes called the " Counter-subject " ; as this term is misleading (in the Single Fugue), it will be spoken of here simply as the " Counterpoint." Comp. par. 34. It is a very important factor in the Fugue (or may become so), and especial pains must, therefore, be taken with its formation. It may be derived from the figures of the Subject itself : Response.. Bach. Ex. ) 150.\ m ssa IS3E w a VAt>?? ? El? IV I Par. 133 THE SECTIONAL FUGUE. Bach. 4. 4 ft t^r=f=r^f ?f#V I 4 ? d#_ N.B. Brahms. M ^g=lPl s fe^SBry^rrw is^i^E^i^E^gii * s- -=r*- EI EV_ J *i) " Passing-chord "; this effect is very common in Wagner. *2) Sequence in the Alto-part. The harmonies are simple and regular, but the passing- and neighboring-notes create totally unexpected chord-effects. When this result is achieved, the product belongs to the highest grade of polyphonic thought. But it is scarcely conceivable that this lofty phase of polyphonic effort can be often reached or long sustained ; even in the works of Bach and Brahms, unmistakable evidences of eman- cipation from natural harmonic law are rare ; in those of Beethoven and other great homophonic masters, naturally still more so. And in the more modern writings of Wagner, Rich. Strauss, and others, where such evidences are again more frequent, one cannot always quite escape an uncomfortable sensation of harmonic bewilderment. The growing vigor and independence of melodic conduct may incite to occasional success- ful rebellion (so to speak), but the student will never wholly outgrow the necessary and wholesome habits of harmonic action contracted during early studies. The habits formed during the discipline of deriving all melodic movements from the sub-current of natural harmonic sequence, will, in polyphonic texture of greatest power and stability, never cease to assert themselves. 236 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 134. Hence, the present student will apply this most eminent resource of polyphonic development chiefly as a means of defining the choice between many possible chord-structures which await each coming beat ; and far more rarely, with much caution, as a legitimate device for obtaining unexpected harmonic clusters, and evolving greater freedom and opulence of harmonic movement. Review, further, pars. 59 and 60; and, particularly, pars. 61 c, d, and e. Also par. 75. 134. a. The voice-movements should be conjunct, in largely prepon- derant measure. Skips, of course, can not and should not be avoided altogether ; but they must be made with caution, and may require care- ful testing. They are always good when occurring within any un- changed chord, or when the first of the two tones is common to the following chord. It is best to avoid leaping to any sharply dissonant, or inharmonic, tone. Transient harsh effects, even extreme, cannot be precluded ; they are as essential in effective polyphony as are the pure consonances ; but the manner of their approach and departure must be very guarded, — abrupt dissonances are usually objectionable. b. Review, thoroughly, par. 64. It is absolutely necessary that one of the four parts should assume the lead, for a more or less extended period, — until another of their number becomes in turn the " leader." This function devolves, naturally, upon the part which has the Theme, though not to the exclusion of some concurrent part, especially Soprano or Bass, — one of which is very likely indeed to contribute most noticeably, in this way, to the tracing of the Form. A good illustration of this vital condition is seen in Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. I, Fugue 22, meas. 6-12 in Soprano. See also Vol. II, Fugue 18, meas. 85-93 in Bass. Vol. II, Fugue 9, last 6 measures in Soprano. Mendelssohn, Organ Fugue, op. 37, No. 1, — the "leading" character of the Soprano, especially, is obvious in many places; see meas. 18-19, 20-22, 41-45. Without such definite, and, if need be, lengthy melodic lines, a Fugue can hardly escape monotony, diffuseness, and vague, ineffective form. c. For this very reason, sequences are of the utmost importance. Review par. 41^. d. Review par. 63^ and c; par. 75^. It is well to avoid long rests during the Exposition, until the four parts have all appeared with the Theme. Short rests are always good (Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. I, Fugue 23, meas. 5-6) ; especially in the Theme itself (Vol. II, Fugue Par. 134c THE SECTIONAL FUGUE. 237 22), or in the first Counterpoint (Vol. I, Fugue 12). And longer rests are not only permissible, but desirable, in the later course of the Fugue. It is positively unwise to keep all four parts constantly present and moving. e. In the Exposition avoid any circumstance that tends to obscure the successive announcements of the beginning of the Theme. Observe how effective the entrances of the parts are in Vol. II, Fugue 9 and Fugue 8. In Vol. II, Fugue 7, the last note in meas. 6 interferes somewhat with the Response in the next. Observe, further, the entrances in Mendelssohn, op. 35, Fugue 1, especially in meas. 6. f. The character of the Subject influences its Exposition to a cer- tain extent. A heavy Theme is somewhat likely to appear first in Bass or Tenor (i.e., low). A Theme that ends higher than it begins must appear first in a high voice, to avoid interference with its next imitation, and vice versa. The tempo of the Subject must be taken into account also ; it in- fluences the number of parts, the number of rests, the degree of liveli- ness (or of stateliness) in the rhythm of the first Counterpoint, and, in fact, of the entire Fugue ; and, somewhat, the number, extent, and quality of dissonances. Attention is again directed, particularly, to Par. 33- Continue the work of thorough analysis with the following sectional 4-voice Fugues : Bach, Organ Comp. (Peters compl. ed.), Vol. Ill, Fugue 10 ; 3 sections; brief and simple, but effective ; many episodes. Vol. IV, Fugue 5 ; 3 sections ; 5 announcements in Exposition, ending with vague cadence (meas. 20) ; Pedal in last section only. Vol. IV, Fugue 9 ; for manual organ ; 4 sections and free Coda ; Counterpoint retained approximately throughout ; many episodes. Vol. VIII, Fugue 10 ; manual organ ; very regular, " Subject " and " Response " throughout ; cadences vague. Vol. II, Fugue 10 ; three different thematic counterpoints, besides several inci- dental characteristic ones ; thus : Cpt. a. -P5s*- 1 • J- m m&^& mm^ 238 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. i34f. Char. Cpt. *. Theme. *= i=^^f^| * m and : Bach. Ccp ff r c | — h ' — L - ° Theme. — a— ^— •— ^ a -. *U m — N- - Char. Cpt. c. ^™^™d Bach, Clavichord Works: Peters ed. 212, No. 6 (a minor). Peters ed. 216, No. 8 (p. 48) ; many stretti. Peters ed. 216, No. 9 (p. 52) ; contrary motion in middle sections, and later in alternation with the original motion. Mendelssohn, Organ Comp., op. 37, Fugue 1 ; fine example of both detailed and continuous structural design ; intimation of 3-Part Song-form (par. 136). Op. 37, Fugue 2 ; cadences vague. Sonata, op. 65, No. 4, last movement ; Fugue with homophonic Introduction and Coda ; 3 sections, cadences vague. Sonata, op. 65, No. 5, 5th movement ; Fugue ; 3 Sections, cadences vague. Mendelssohn, Pianoforte Comp., op. 35, No. 4, Fugue. Bach, " Art of Fugue " Fugue 1 ; probably sectional, though the cadences are very vague, — more like one long, unbroken Section ; fairly frequent episodes, based upon a brief episodic (auxiliary) motive, and corroborative of each other. Analyze this and the following very thoroughly and minutely. Fugue 2 ; an Exposition, and one other long Section (cadences, if any, very vague) ; an auxiliary motive (meas. 8-9, Bass) and several episodic motives are utilized. Fugue 4 ; five Sections, fairly definite cadences ; many long episodes, based on an auxiliary figure (of two notes, meas. 14-15 in Soprano, 23-26 in Bass), and an episodic motive (of 4 tones, descending scale, meas. 18-19 * n Bass) ; a characteristic trait of the Counterpoint (repeated measure) is also occasionally used. Handel, Clav. Suites, No. Ill, second movement. Handel, Clav. Suites, No. VIII, second movement (partly 3-voice). Schumann, Pianoforte Fugues, op. 72 ; Fugue 1, five Sections and Coda; aug- mentation of Theme (abbreviated) in Sec. V. — Fugue 3, Romantic style, four Sections and Coda; in Sec. II an auxiliary M. appears twice (with small auxiliary figure), and reappears similarly in Sec. Ill; in Sec. IV there is a new and characteristic Counterpoint. Par. 135. TWO-PART SONG-FORM. 239 EXERCISE 39. Write a large number of 4-voice Fugues, in sectional form ; major and minor alternately; different species of measure, different style and tempo for each example. The Song— Forms. 135. The Two-Part Song-form. The chief difference between this and the sectional design is the distinctly marked cadence (usually perfect) in or near the middle of the Fugue. The First Part is likely to consist of the Exposition, and one addi- tional section ; the latter may be brief and largely episodic, or it may be longer and more independent ; but in either case it leads into a well- prepared and fairly emphatic cadence in the Dominant key (possibly the Relative major, in a minor Fugue, or some other next-related key). Part II is often individualized to some extent ; most commonly by adopting the contrary motion of the Theme (for a time), or by means of a new and characteristic Counterpoint. At the same time, Part II may (perhaps should) exhibit more or less distinct parallelism with its First Part, — especially in its episodes ; and, as usual, the last few measures may corroborate the ending of Part I. A Codetta or Coda may be added. Review par. 45. See Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. I, Fugue 14; Part I (the Exposition, and 3 epi- sodic measures) closes in meas. 20, with a strong Dominant cadence. Part II begins with Theme in Alto in contrary motion; then Theme in original motion in Soprano with disguised beginning (meas. 25), leading to cadence in meas. 28, — thus dividing the Second Part into two sections. In meas. 35-36 the episode of meas. 19 reap- pears, followed by Theme in Soprano. The contrary motion occurs again in Bass, meas. 32-34. Vol. I, Fugue 17 ; Part I ends in meas. 16; a very faint intimation of a Third Part occurs in meas. 27. Vol. II, Fugue 2; Part I is 3-voice texture throughout; it closes in meas. 14 with a positive perfect cadence in the Dominant key. Part II is characterized by two announcements of the Theme in Augmentation, and, further, by the addition of a 4th voice. The last 5J measures are a Coda. Vol. II, Fugue 7 ; Part I closes in meas. 30; Part II largely episodic. Mendelssohn, Organ Fugue, op. 37, No. 3; quasi sectional, — suggestion of a separation into two Parts in meas. 32 ; the last 25 measures are Coda. Organ Sonata, op. 65, No. 2, last movement; Part II characterized by a more animated counterpoint (partly thematic) ; few episodes until near the end. 136. The Three-Part Song-form. Part I the same as in the 2-Part Song-form. Part II is here again generally characterized in some manner ; and is led into a more or less distinct semicadence upon the 240 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 136. Dominant of the original key, usually confirmed by an emphatic (some- times quite extended) organ-point. Part III must be, as usual, a well-marked " Return to the begin- ning " ; but it does not need to contain any more than the first few measures (two or three) of Part I, — enough to establish key and for- mal design ; its subsequent contents are 'likely to be entirely independ- ent, and should be more elaborate and interesting than any preceding Section ; hence, stretto-imitations are peculiarly appropriate, and more brilliant (even partly homophonic) episodes are legitimate and desirable. A Coda or Codetta is frequently added. Review pars. 49, 50 ; also 33. See Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. I, Fugue 16; already cited among the sectional forms ; there is a strong indication of a " Return to the beginning " in meas. 28. Vol. I, Fugue 23 ; ditto ; intimation of Third Part in meas. 6 from the end. Schumann, op. 72, Fugue 4 ; in Part II (piit vivo) two different modified forms of the Theme appear : Moderate. Modified form a. Schumann. h4^+u=±^ ^m =t=t i *=$. ¥ Modified form b. " jf"* - Tr EXERCISE 40. A number of 4-voice Fugues in the 2-Part and 3-Part Song-forms. Thk Fugue with Special Design. 137. No good Fugue is barren of some structural design, as the foregoing paragraphs show. But it is possible to pursue some special plan in the manipulation of this polyphonic form, evolved more particu- larly out of the resources of its Theme, and therefore peculiarly iden- tified with the processes of Thematic Development. The formal plan is usually that of the sectional Fugue ; and the " special design " consists in assigning to each Section in succession some specific method of thematic treatment, resulting in a systematic Par. 137. FUGUE WITH SPECIAL DESIGN. 241 presentation of such possibilities of manipulation and combination as are latent within the Theme (e.g., effective stretti, contrary motion, etc.). These possibilities, or resources, are usually determined beforehand by most thorough examination and experiment with the Theme ; and it is more than likely that these resources may be systematically multiplied by judicious revision and alteration of the Subject, — possibly created outright in draughting the Theme. Review Chap. IV; especially pars. 29, 33, 36. Analyze, most thoroughly, the following : Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vo). I, Fugue 20; the "design" is strikingly manifest; Sec. I is a regular Exposition, to meas. 14 ; Sec. II is an equally complete Exposition of the Theme in contrary motion, to meas. 27 ; Sec. Ill is the exposition of a strctto in the 8ve after two beats (Soprano and Tenor) carried through all the parts, up to meas. 48 ; Sec. IV is a similar exposition of the same stretto in contrary motion (Alto and Tenor) through all the parts, somewhat abbreviated in the last measures, 62-64 ! Sec. V is the condensed exposition of a new stretto, after two beats in the 5th, first in original motion (meas. 64-65, Bass and Tenor), then in contrary motion (Soprano and Alto) ; Sec. VI, meas. 73, contains miscellaneous stretti, to the cadence in meas. 83 ; the rest is Coda. Vol. II, Fugue 22, is similar ; Sec. I is a regular Exposition up to meas. 25 ; Sec. II is the Exposition of a remarkable stretto, after one beat in the 7th (meas. 27, Tenor and Alto) ; Sec. Ill, meas. 42, is an Exposition of the Theme in contrary motion ; Sec. IV, meas. 67, the same stretto as before, but in contrary motion (Alto and Soprano). Thus far, to meas. 77, the Fugue consists of two similar double- sections, one in regular and the other in contrary motion. Sec. V, meas. 80, is the Exposition of a new stretto, after one beat, in regular and contrary motion (Soprano and Tenor). Near the end, as climax (meas. 96), there is an extraordinary double- stretto, regular and contrary motion, each Theme doubled in the 3rd (the first one part of the way in the 6th). Vol. II, Fugue g ; " Gregorian " Theme ; Sec. I, Exposition ; Sec. II, meas. 9, stretto in 4th after two beats (Alto, Tenor, Bass, Soprano) ; Sec. Ill, meas. 16, new stretto, in 5th after one measure (Alto, Soprano, Bass, Tenor) ; Sec. IV, meas. 23, new stretto, in 5th after one beat, with modified form of the Theme (Soprano, Alto, Bass, Tenor) ; Sec. V, end of meas. 26, Exposition of the Diminution (Soprano, Alto, Tenor, Bass); Sec. VI, meas. 30, contains original Theme, and its Diminution, in regular and contrary motion, — faintly suggestive of Sec. I; Sec. VII, meas. 35, is substantially the recurrence of Sec. II ; from meas. 38 to end is in the nature of a Coda. Vol. I, Fugue I ; the special design is not as obvious as in the above examples, but the persistent stretto-treatment of the Theme after the Exposition (meas. 7-24), especially the 4-voice stretto in meas. 16-18 (Soprano, Alto, Tenor, Bass), seems to be more than merely accidental. Bach, " Art of Fugue," Fugue 3 ; appears to begin with " Response," instead of " Subject," — (a peculiarity of irregular Exposition — par. 124 — seen also in Bach, Orf*. Comp., Vol. Ill, Fugue 4, and Vol. IV, Fugues 1 and 4). 242 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 137. The " Subject " (meas. 5) runs thus : i Ex. 158.[=ggH3p: a 3 1=F=M= T=£ I -Z5l- ± ~^- There are four Sections, separated by very vague cadences, but distinguished by their thematic contents ; Sec. I is the usual Exposition ; Sec. II (meas. 23) presents the Theme in the following form : i 5^ V-l*- -•- m-f 2 - -m- -x=x sfe iiB •-4W =SE fc£ P= 5 Sec. Ill (meas. 39) returns to the original form ; Sec. IV (meas. 55) uses the following form twice, i ^ IE 3=F *=st - g*-— :•— ^- and also the original form. The first counterpoint (partly chromatic) is retained nearly throughout. Bach, " Art of Fugue," Fugue 1 2 ; 4-voice ; Special Design in 2-Part Song-form ; Part I is a regular Exposition, with a thematic Counterpoint (par. 163) retained; Part II is an exposition of the Subject in still more richly embellished form than those illustrated in Ex. 158. The following Fugue (No. \2b) is the exact Contrary motion and Inversion of the preceding ; compare them minutely. Mendelssohn, op. 7, No. 5 ; very elaborate sectional form ; about nine Sections (including the Exposition) and a brief Coda ; Sec. Ill, contrary motion ; Sec. IV, Augmentation ; Sec. V, Diminution ; Sec. VI, episodic, animated tempo and rhythm ; Sec. IX, stretti. EXERCISE 41. Two or more Fugues with Special Design. CHAPTER XIII. The Fugue with Less or More Than Four Parts. — The Three- Voice Fugue. 138. The Exposition. The three parts are called lower, inner, and upper, without reference to voice-compass, though they are likely to represent adjacent registers. The regular Exposition contains Subject, Par. 139. THE THREE-VOICE FUGUE.. 243 Response, and Subject (comp. par. 123), the last Subject always either an octave higher or lower than the first Subject. The enlargement of the Exposition to four announcements is, how- ever, quite common in the 3-voice Fugue ; the last announcement is again " Response," usually an 8ve lower or higher than the first Response. See Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. I, Fugue 19; the 4th announcement is made noticeable by the peculiar leap in Bass (meas. 5-6). Vol. I, Fugue 8 (meas. 12). Vol. II, Fugue 11 (meas. 21). Vol. II, Fugue 19 (meas. 7). 139. The Theme of a 3-voice Fugue is likely to be of a more spir- ited rhythmic character, and possibly wider compass, than that of the 4-voice Fugue ; otherwise there is no essential difference. The struc- tural designs and all details of treatment are the same. 140. Sectional form. Review pars. 128 to 132, and analyze the following, most thoroughly : Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. I, Fugue 9 ; Exposition to meas. 5 ; Sec. II to meas. 17; episode in meas. 13-15, recurring in meas. 23-24; in meas. 19 there is an inti- mation of a return to the beginning (quasi 3-Part Song-form). Vol. I, Fugue 11, four Sections. Vol. II, Fugue I. — Fugue 6 (contrary motion and stretti employed in later course). — Fugue 10 (episode in meas. 18-20, corroborated in meas. 47-49; charac- teristic Counterpoint recurs occasionally). — Fugue 1 1 (quasi 2-Part Song-form j Exposition to meas. 29 ; many episodes). — Fugue 12. Fugue 15. Fugue 19. Bach, Clavichord Comp., Peters ed. 212, No. 2 (p. 59). Peters ed. 213, No. 1, 2nd movement; elaborate episodes. Peters ed. 213, No. 2, 2nd movement (p. 21) ; broad sectional form; elaborate episodes, largely similar. Peters ed. 214, No. 2 (p. 12); many fairly strong cadences, Sections small; compare minutely with the " Variante," p. 48. Peters ed. 215, p. 23. 216, p. 50 (No. 8, fifth movement). 216, No. 10 (p. 57) ; many cadences, Sections brief. Bach, Musikalisches Opfer, No. 1 (Riccrcata, — same as Fuga). Rubinstein, Fugue op. 53, No. 2 (contrary motion and stretti ingeniously used). Schumann, op. 126, No. 1 (2 Sections, cadences vague); No. 6, 4 Sections. Jadassohn, Pfte. Fugues and Preludes, op. 56 ; Fugue No. 6 ; also Nos. 2 and 3 ■ the latter contain effective stretti and the Contrary motion, — cited again, among the Concert -fugues (par. 148). 141. Two-Part Song-form. Review par. 135, and analyze the following : Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. I, Fugue 6 ; Part I closes in meas. 21 (almost ex- actly in the middle of the Fugue) with a strong perfect cadence in the Dominant 244 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 142. key; Part II uses the contrary motion freely, and later, from meas. 31 on, corrobo- rates Part I closely ; the last 5 measures of each Part correspond exactly (except in key). The Fugue as Gigue form (par. 51), with contrary motion as basis of Part IT, is illustrated in Bach, Org. Comp., Vol. I, " Pastorale," last movement. 142. Among the many devices adopted for the characterization of the Second Part (the most common being the contrary motion of the Theme, pars. 48^, 51), there is one that is peculiarly effective in the Fugue, namely, the introduction of a new and striking Counterpoint, retained more or less constantly throughout the Part, as new thematic member. This process was touched upon in Ex. 156, which see. For illustration see — Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. I, Fugue 13; Part I (Exposition and episodic exten- sion) closes in meas. 11 ; the new "thematic counterpoint" appears in meas. 12-13 in Bass, and twice later; it grows out of the foregoing episodic figure (meas. 7). Vol. II, Fugue 21 ; Part I to meas. 32 ; the thematic counterpoint is in Soprano, meas. 33-36, and reappears often ; the two Parts close alike. Vol. II, Fugue 24 ; the form is sectional (no decisive cadence to mark 9 First Part) ; the thematic counterpoint first occurs in meas. 29-32, in Bass Handel, Clav. Suite, No. 4, 1st movement ; 4-voice. This design is the type of the Double-fugue, Third Species (par. 178, class i\ 143. The Three-Part Song-form. Review par. 136, and see — Schumann, op. 72, Fugue 2 ; light cadence at end of Part I (Exposition) ; the first figure of the Counterpoint is used constantly ; the contrary motion of the Themf appears in later course of Part II ; Part III contains only fragments of Theme, — a end in Augmentation. The Second Part is strongly characterized by an animated rhythmic counter- point in Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. I, Fugue 19; Part I ends in meas. 20; an interlude of 3 measures follows, leading into Part II (meas. 23) ; the animated counterpoint is not exactly " thematic " (that is, it has no definite and permanent thematic form), but is based upon a. set of similar figures ; Part III, meas. 42, falls back into the original quiet rhythm, which again yields to the animated form during the Coda (meas. 49). This form corresponds to par. 70. Comp. also par. 142. The 5-Part Song-form (two digressions, Parts II and IV, and two returns to the beginning, Parts III and V) is illustrated in — Rubinstein, Pfte. Fugue, op. 53, No. 5 ; effective use of Diminution and stretti. 144. The Special Design. Review par. 137, and see — Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. I, Fugue 8; the Exposition ends in meas. 19; See II contains stretti, and a curious partial Augmentation (Alto, meas. 24-27) ; Sec. Ill meas. 30, is an Exposition of the contrary motion ; Sec. IV, meas. 44, closely resem hies Sec. II (in contrary motion) ; Sec. V, meas. 52-61, contains triple stretti in regu- Par. 145. THE TWO-VOICE FUGUE. 245 lar and contrary motion, and one regular (single) announcement of the Theme ; Sec. VI, meas. 61-83, * s an Exposition of the Augmentation (Bass, Alto, Soprano) ; the rest is an extremely beautiful Codetta. Vol. I, Fugue 15; Sec. I, Exposition, to meas. 20 ; followed by an Exposition of the contrary motion ; and later, various stretti; analyze thoroughly. The episodic sections in this Fugue are very distinct, and corroborative of each other. The 2 -Voice Fugue. 145. The Fugue with two parts only is naturally rare, because such slender means are inadequate to the dignity and richness that distin- guish this polyphonic form. The Theme must be of a lively rhythmic character, and ample com- pass. Episodes are frequent and somewhat free (brilliant) ; and the occasional addition of an auxiliary part, or parts, is permissible, — almost necessary. See — Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. I, Fugue 10; very clearly defined 2-Part Song-form j Part I closes (with a unique passage in intentional octaves) in meas. 20, in the Sub- dominant key ; Part II, which follows immediately, is an exact reproduction of the First Part, but with inverted voices, and, on the first beat of meas. 29, a shift to the next higher step, in order to cadence upon the original keynote, e, instead of d (as would be the case if the preceding Subdominant modulation were pursued). Com- pare meas. 29 with meas. 10. Part II ends, with the same octave-passage, in meas. 39 ; the rest is Codetta (Theme in Soprano, pried asunder by an interposed measure, with imitation of first half in Bass). Rheinberger, op. 5, No. 3. Bach, Duetto II (Peters ed. 208, No. 4), 3-Part form. Also Duetto III (with exceptional auxiliary part at beginning — par. 112, 2) j 3-Part form. The 5-V01CE Fugue. 146. The extra, 5th, part is either a second Soprano, second Tenor, or second Bass (rarely an additional Alto) ; and the compass as a whole is somewhat expanded, either by adding to the height of the usual Soprano, or the depth of the Bass, or both. Review par. 123. The Exposition consists of Subject, Response, Subject, Response, Subject. The " Subjects " must be an octave apart; the " Responses " likewise. Parallel parts (those which are to announce the " Subject "), be it recalled, are separated by one (or three) parts. Five-voice Fugues are seldom effective for the pianoforte, but en- tirely so for organ. In any case, however, it is desirable to use rests frequently ; especially protracted rests which reduce the texture occa- 246 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 146. sionally to 4-voice, or even 3-voice. Review, carefully, par. 134// and par. 75*. The Subject is usually brief, stately, and narrow in range. The very positive difficulties attending the addition of a 5th part may be minimized : (1) by preserving a perfectly distinct consciousness of the chord-basis, and the harmonic progressions in general ; (2) by sustaining at least one of the parts upon some lengthy tone, important in the chord (as root), or in the key (Tonic, Dominant), — that is, by refraining from leading all the parts abreast, in active rhythm; (3) by using many parallel 3rds and 6ths and reciprocal figures, illustrated in Exs. 113 and 114 (which see) ; and (4) by judicious use of brief rests. For general illustration : 1. Bach. Ex. 159. s IE X S: g g- ^^ *i) §HE -*-» A r r™ r r fe£s r T r n *^i r N.B. ¥ a r^n?r 1 1 N.B. V 7 (IV) I Bt?V 7 unj_AA^i Bach. i EE -r—f- idt=fe nJ 1—1 r-i 1 mi r— 1 *-4J 4 -e- J J J +4 nCF^ I I (III) I V V Kb V 7 Par. 146. THE FIVE-VOICE FUGUE. 247 *6) 3. I ib^fe^ffiffi ts^^Wa al- -F I V- -dV* X *6) Bach. ^S \J1±. ^ ^ ^^f *8) jss. tatt 1 aV -I Bt>V 7 I=FIV- -I- *i) Observe the profusion of parallel 3rds. *2) Parallel 3rds and 6ths. *3) The two basses run in 6ths constantly. Observe the thematic character of the first (highest) bass part; the very definite melodic conduct of both outer parts; and the chord-analysis. *4) From here on, 4-voice texture. *5) A neighboring-chord. *6) The Motive (in 8th-notes). *y) Cfl substituted for the expected c\ (par. 19c). *8) Probably" the Dominant of F ; see par. 133, Ex. 155. Analyze, very minutely, the harmony, thematic texture, and form of the following : Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. I, Fugue 22 ; Two-Part Song-form ; Part II, begin- ning in meas. 25, contains three well-defined Sections; in the last Section there is a double announcement of the Theme in 3rds (in the two Sopranos), and a five-fold stretto (beginning in meas. 9 from the end). Bach, Org. Comp., Vol. II, Fugue 5 ; a fine example ; 5 Sections ; many differ- ent effective " Counterpoints " ; after the Exposition the rhythm is more animated ; Sees. Ill and V are largely 3- and 4-voice texture. Vol. II, Fugue 7; Special design; the Theme is brief, and almost constantly present (i.e., few episodes) ; the texture is 4-voice up to Sec. VI, when the Pedal enters with Augmentation of Theme (to the end) ; Sec. II, meas. 8, begins with a striking sequential Counterpoint in the Soprano (see par. 134^) ; Sec. IV is an Expo- sition of the contrary motion ; Sec. V contains stretti in regular and contrary motioa 248 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 147. Vol. II, Fugue 6; Two- Part Song-form ; 6 announcements in the Exposition; in Part II there is a new thematic Counterpoint (see par. 142), utilized first in abbre- viated form, as a long 3-voice episode (meas. 59—86). Vol. Ill, Fugue 4; begins with "Response"; 7 Sections and Coda; many effective episodes, somewhat homophonic in character. Vol. IV, Fugue 1, also begins with " Response"; it is 4- voice texture, with occasional brief intimations of a 5th part. Jadassohn, Pfte. Fugues, op. 56 ; Fugue No. 9 ; sectional. Fugue with Six and More Parts. 147. It is very uncommon to employ more than five parts in the Fugue, or any other strictly polyphonic form, not only because of the technical difficulty, but chiefly that of rendering the form intelligible. As the parts are multiplied, the style becomes more and more harmonic, and all voice-individuality is lost. The most effective device consists in so using protracted rests that, for the most part, no more than 5 of the voices appear at one time together. In any case, the extent will rarely exceed that of a Fughetta. See Bach, Musikalisches Offer, No. 2, Ricercata (i.e., Fugue) for 6 parts. An example of 6-voice writing may be found in Bach, Org. Comp., Vol. VI, No. 13 (Fugue-group, par. 157). Further, Bach, " B-minor Mass," No. 20 (Second Division, Pleni sunt coeli) ; vocal fugue, par. 152 ; properly speaking, only a Fughetta. Bach, 8-voice motets (vocal, — Peters ed. 28), No. 2, Allegro non tanto ; 8-voice double quartet; first announcement of Theme in 1st Soprano, accompanied; followed by 8 Imitations in the other parts. Motet No. 4, letter C to D ; 8-voice Exposition. Also the following Vivace. EXERCISE 42. A. Four or more examples of the 3-voice Fugue, respectively in sectional form (par. 140), 2-Part Song-form (pars. 141 and 142), 3-Part Song-form (par. 143), and with Special Design (par. 144). Employ different species of measure and different tempo for each, and alternate major and minor modes. B. An example of the 2-voice Fugue. C. Two examples of the 5-voice Fugue, for organ. D. A Fughetta (one Section) with 6 parts, for organ. Par. 148. THE CONCERT-FUGUE. 249 CHAPTER XIV. Miscellaneous Varieties of the Fugue-form. — The Concert-Fugue. 148. It is entirely feasible, and permissible, so to elaborate the Fugue-form that, without violating any of its essential conditions or materially modifying the dignity of its character, it may exhibit those qualities of brilliancy, passion, and freedom which better adapt it for public concert use, or, in a word, enhance its effectiveness and external beauty. Such a version bears about the same relation to the more genuine, serious Fugue that the Prelude bears to the Invention. Review par. 83. The consequent relaxation of fugue law, and general freedom of treatment, will affect : (1) The Theme itself, which may be more char- acteristic ; (2) the tempo, which is usually more lively ; (3) the number of parts, — very frequently limited to three fundamental parts, but freely augmented by the occasional addition of auxiliary lines or whole "bunches" of auxiliary tones (incidental chords); (4) the episodes, which are both more frequent and more extensive, and often nearly or quite homophonic and " figural " .in character ; (5) the form, which is perhaps most likely to be definite 2- or 3-Part Song-form, with firm cadences, — often embracing purely homophonic (or at most " imita- tory ") transitional passages, or complete contrasting sections ; (6) the dramatic design, embracing more pronounced dynamic and rhythmic contrasts, and the steadily progressive development of one or more brilliant climaxes. The strictest fidelity to the Theme is, however, indispensable ; not necessarily to the whole Theme, nor constantly, but to its pregnant or salient figures. This (the original Theme, entire, and in fragments), the contrary motion, possibly Augmentation, stretti, and an effective variety of " Counterpoints," constitute the thematic material of the Concert- fugue ; to which are to be added striking episodes (as usual, largely corroborative of each other), and all the factors which contribute to an impressive dramatic design, as a whole, and brilliancy of detail. The most of these traits are forcibly exhibited in Mendelssohn, Pfte. Fugue in e minor (with Prelude), op. 35, No. Ij 4-voice; definite 3-Part Song-form; after Part I the tempo and rhythm are gradually and persistently accelerated; Part II 250 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 148. contains the contrary motion of the Theme (further transformed by substituting staccato for the original legato), and leads to a splendid climax in Part III, which, after a powerful bass cadenza, culminates in a distinct Coda consisting of an original chorale with running bass ; the latter gradually subsides to the original tempo and rhythm, and is followed by a second brief Coda with the Theme in major, treated more homophonically. Analyze, further : Mendelssohn, Pfte. Fugue, op. 35, No. 3 ; 3- to 4-voice; distinct 3-Part Song- form, contrary motion throughout Part II ; in Part III, regular and contrary motion in stretto. Op- 35. No. 5 ; 3- to 4-voice ; sectional, quasi 3-Part Form. Op. 35, No. 6 ; 4-voice ; sectional, quasi 3-Part Song-form. Op. 7, No. 3 ; 4-voice ; large 2-Part Song-form. Fugue in e minor (with Prelude, no opus-number) ; 4-voice ; sectional, quasi 3- Part Form. Bach, Organ Comp. (Peters compl. ed.J, Vol. II, Fugue 2; 4-voice j stretti in last Section ; many and lengthy episodes, — the Theme appears (after the Exposi- tion) in periodic single announcements, isolated between effective episodes (mostly of consistent thematic origin, but brilliant and free). Vol. II, Fugue 4 ; similar to the above ; quasi 3-Part Song-form. Vol. II, Fugue 8; 4-voice; sectional; similar to above. Vol. Ill, Fugue 8; 4-voice; sectional; characteristic Counterpoints; first Counterpoint retained, approximately, until last Section. Many episodes. Vol. IV, Fugue 3; 4-voice; 10 Sections; many episodes, similar in substance; first Counterpoint retained, approximately, throughout. Vol. IV, Fugue 4 ; 4-voice ; about 4 Sections, cadences vague ; appears to begin with " Response " ; many effective episodes, lengthy, and free, but related to the Theme and to each other. Bach, Clavichord Comp., Peters ed. 211, No. 2; 3-voice. Bach, " Chromatic" fugue for Clavichord (with Prelude) ; 3-voice; sectional. Rubinstein, Pfte. Fugues and Preludes, op. 53, Fugue 3 ; 4-voice ; definite 3- Part Song-form. Brahms, op. 24 (" Handel "- Variations for Pfte.), Finale. Raff, Pfte. Suite, op. 71, Finale ; 3-voice. Other miscellaneous examples of the Fugue of more or less free structure, or in (and influenced by) homophonic surroundings, may be found as follows : Beethoven, Pfte. Sonata, op. no, Finale. Pfte. Variation, op. 35, Finale. Saint-Saens, Pfte. Etudes, op. 52, No. 5 ; 4-voice. Paderewski, op. 11, Variations and Fugue (Finale") ; 3-voice. Nicod£, op. 18, Variations and Fugue (Finale) ; 4-voice. MacDowell, op. 10, No. 5, 4-voice Fugue; independent Coda. MacDowell, op. 13, Prelude and Fugue; 4-voice. Guilmant, Organ Comp., op. 25, No. 3 (4- to 5-voice). — Op. 40, No. 1 (4-voice). — Op. 49, No. 6 (4-voice). — Op. 44, No. 2 (4-voice). — Op. 69, No. 4. — Op. .72. Organ Sonata, Op. 50, Finale. — Op. 86, Movement III (quasi Double; counter- point retained). Par. 148. THE CONCERT-FUGUE. 25 I Arthur Foote, op. 15, N0..1, Prelude and Fugue; 3-voice. J. K. Paine, op. 41, No. 3, Fuga giocosa ; 3-voice. Aless. Longo, op. 9, Fantasia e Fuga {stile libero). Clementi, Gradus ad Parnasmm, Part III of the revised edition by Max Vogrich (Schirmer) ; No. 89 (orig. ed. No. 13); 4-voice. — No. 90 (orig. ed. 18) j 3- voice; brief Introduction. — No. 91 (orig. ed. 25); 4-voice; brief Introduction. — No. 92 (orig. ed. 45), 4-voice; with Prelude. — No. 93 (orig. ed. 43). — No. 94 (orig. ed. 40). — No. 95 (orig. ed. 69). — Nos. 99 and 100 (orig. ed. 56, 57), Prelude and Fugue. J. Rheinberger, op. 78, No. 2; 3-voice; 3-Part Song-form; in Part II a brief auxiliary chromatic Motive is thematically treated (alone, per moto contrario, par. 158), and reappears in Part III, at times in conjunction with the Theme. Many more fine examples of the Fugue may be found in the Organ Sonatas of Rhein- berger (and of other writers also). Raff, Suite, op. 72, Finale; 3-voice; 3-Part Song-form; contrary motion freely used ; also stretti and Augmentation ; in Part Ilia new Counterpoint appears, which assumes considerable importance in subsequent episodes, and in the Coda. Jadassohn, Preludes and Fugues for pianoforte, op. 56, Fugue 1 ; 4-voice ; 2- Part form ; stretto in 2nd Part. — Fugue 2 ; 3-voice ; sectional ; stretti and contrary motion. — Fugue 3 ; 3-voice ; ditto. — Fugue 4 ; 4-voice ; sectional ; various effective Counterpoints, in successively accelerated rhythms. — Fugue 5 ; 4-voice ; 2-Part form ; much parallel movement in thirds and sixths. Some of these Fugues, and particularly those which follow, are quite strict in design and treatment : Fugue 6 ; 3-voice ; sectional. — Fugue 7 ; 4-voice ; sectional ; stretti. — Fugue 8 ; 4-voice ; sec- tional ; animated Counterpoint in last Section. — Fugue 9 ; 5-voice ; sectional. Reinecke, op. 157, No. 4 ; Fugue ; 4-voice; sectional form ; Augm. in last Section. An exceedingly interesting work, well worthy of most thorough scrutiny and analysis, is: Prelude, Chorale, and Fugue for Pianoforte, in b minor, by Cesar Franck (ed. Litolff, 1578). The three numbers are coherent, and to some extent thematically inter-related ; the chorale is original, and bears no relation to the tradi- tional German church-melody ; it occurs, rather episodically, during the Fugue, and even in brief (fragmentary) connection with the Theme (not as shown in par. 154) ; the Fugue is ostensibly 4-voice, but very free ; an animated thematic Counterpoint appears in a later Section. Emile Bernard, Prelude and Fugue in g minor, op. 14 ; 3-voice ; 3-Part form. 149. The Concert-fugue seldom, if ever, appears as an isolated com- position, but either as a movement of a larger work, or at least in company with an Introduction or Prelude. The latter, as stated in par. 83a, may be connected thematically with the Fugue, or may be a totally separate piece, independent of the Fugue in every respect, excepting in key, which should be the same. Review par. %->a, thoroughly; and examine, again, the Preludes of Bach, Mendelssohn (op. 35, 37), and Rubinstein (op. 53). 252 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 150. EXERCISE 43. Several examples of the Concert-fugue of various types, major and minor alter- nately. They may be written for Pianoforte (for two, or for four hands), or Organ. N. B. Each Fugue must be preceded by an effective Prelude, polyphonic, semi- polyphonic, or homophonic, at option. The Fugue for Other Instruments. 150. For String-quartet. The four instruments used are first and second Violin, Viola, and Violoncello. Their notation and average compass are as follows : Violin I & II. Viola. 'Cello. XL^l P ==EE^fl »=^= B Ex. 160 The Viola is written in a C-clef (the so-called Alto C-clef), and the student, if not yet familiar with it, should embrace this opportunity of learning it thoroughly. In performing this task, the student should adopt the following system : The C-clef should be learned by itself, and not by comparison with, or reference to, the G- or F- clefs. That is, the name of each line or space must be independently mastered. The clef-sign ( |3) indicates the letter c 1 (the " middle " c of the pianoforte). Thus : o 1 1 a 1 -bL^L ^= Ex -H-* r— kL E 1 * H 161. 1—3 A — Q - , B" 1 r 1 p J! ■ ■ After learning this perfectly, write familiar melodies or Themes in the new clef. Then read or play the Viola part alone of the String-quartets of Haydn, Mozart, and Beethoven. Then play, at the pianoforte, the String-trios of Beetho- ven, and afterwards the above-named quartets, slowly, and with less reference to the rhythm than to melody and general harmony. This being accomplished, the student may write a few fairly simple 4-part harmonizations of the chorales given in Exercise 26, upon the four staves of the String-quartet. There is no essential difference between the Fugue for string- quartet and that for pianoforte, as regards the form and structural treatment. But the technique differs materially, because of the superior freedom and independence of the string-parts ; hence, the parts may diverge, or cross, more freely. In a word, the constraint of keyboard technique is wholly removed. For examples, see Haydn, String-quartets (Peters ed. 1026a), No. 6, D major, Finale — one-flat signature; 4- voice Fugue, Exposition only. Par. i5i. THE VOCAL FUGUE. 253 Mozart, String-quartets (Peters ed. 10370), No. 1, G major, Finale ; Exposition of one Theme at beginning, and of another 30 or 40 measures later. Beethoven, String-quartets, op. 18, No. 4, Andante ; a partial Exposition in first 19 measures. — Op. 59, No. 3, Finale ; Exposition (irreg.) in first 40 measures or so. — Op. 131, whole of first movement. — Op. 95, second movement, meas. 34- 64, and again later ; Counterpoint retained. — Brahms, String-quintet, op. 88, portions of Finale. 151. The Fugue for Pianoforte and one or more Solo instruments (Violin, 'Cello, etc.) will derive its character and treatment from the technical nature of the instruments employed ; but will be, in any case, more free and more effective than the pianoforte Fugue. For examples, see Brahms, Sonata for pianoforte and 'cello, op. 38, Finale, first 53 measures, — and again further on. Tschaikowsky, Trio op. 50 (a minor), 2nd movement, Var. VIII. Bach, Sonatas for Clavichord and Violin, No. 1, 2nd movement. — No. 3, 2nd movement. — No. 4, 2nd movement. — No. 5, 2nd movement. — No. 6, 4th move- ment (Adagio). All very free; more like elaborate Inventions than Fugues. The Vocal Fugue. 152. The constraint of technical treatment is most imperative in the Fugue for vocal parts. The compass of each voice must be re- spected, constantly and rigorously ; awkward intervals, rhythms, or any other circumstances which impair the melodiousness and " singable- ness " of the several parts, must be scrupulously avoided ; and good balance of effect (excluding wide spaces, though not an occasional crossing of the parts) must be preserved. The form should be fairly definite (strict) and intelligible. Episodes are necessary, but they must be of a more sober character than in the instrumental Fugue, and must be held well within the general thematic atmosphere of the Subject. Particular attention should be directed *~ the uppermost voice, which is mainly responsible for the clear d/id effective melodic form of the whole. The Theme should always be a striking setting of some brief, preg- nant text-sentence, — melodious, but rhythmically characteristic, — and it accompanies the same words throughout. The voices not occupied with the Theme, however, are generally written without regard to the text, — the latter being subsequently adjusted to the finished tones, with strict regard to grammatical sense and order, and to the correct prosodic disposition of accented and unaccented syllables and words. 254 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 153. Rests are indispensable ; short ones for breathing, and occasional protracted silence (especially before an announcement of the Theme) for variety and contrast. 153. If, as is almost invariably the case, the Vocal fugue is to be accompanied, the instrument chosen (pianoforte or organ) may either be limited (1) to an exact duplication of the parts, unisotw ; or (2) may double either outer part, especially the Bass, in octaves, perhaps adding an occasional full chord to support the vocal parts where their effect is somewhat meagre ; or (3) the accompaniment may add materially to the bulk, or to the rhythmic movement (or both), of the vocal parts, — even to the extent of introducing independent imitations and announcements of the Theme. Further, the accompaniment may provide a brief instru- mental Introduction, occasional Interludes, and a Postlude, if necessary or desirable. See Bach, " B-minor Mass," No. 6 ; Gratias agimus, 4-voice ; Accompaniment simple. Compare No. 34. — No. 3, Kyrie, 4-voice. — No. 1, Kyrie, 5-voice : thematic instrumental Prelude and Interlude; large 2-Part Form. — No. 13, Patrem omnipo- tentem, 4-voice; partly harmonic Accompaniment, otherwise elaborate. — No. 12, Credo in unum Deum ; 5-voice ; Running Bass in Accompaniment. Mendelssohn, "St. Paul," No. 29, Is this He? — simple Fugue, with homo- phonic Interlude, derived from the Counterpoint to Theme. — No. 43, See what love; irregular Exposition. — No. 15, Behold now total darkness; Running Accompaniment, chiefly Soprano. Haydn, "The Creation," No. 11, For He both heav'n and earth; Accompani- ment elaborated. — No. 29, We praise Thee now , Running Accompaniment (figural). Handel, " Messiah," No. 26, He trusteth in God. — No. 6, And He shall purify ; free, somewhat irregular; homophonic episodes. — No. 37, And their words ; Expo- sition irreg. (Response, Response, Subject, Subject). — No. 52, Amen; an Exposi- tion, Interlude, and long episodic passages, with fragments of Theme. Handel, "Judas Maccabaeus," No. 26, 2nd Part, W 'here warlike Judas ; Expo- sition irreg. (4 " Subject "-announcements). Mozart, " Requiem," No. 8, Quam olim ; independent Accompaniment, quasi harmonic. Cherubini, " Missa solemnis " (in D), Kyrie eleison (Allegro moderato) ; Accom- paniment partly harmonic, partly running rhythm, and partly single duplication. — Dona nobis pacem ; observe different forms of accompaniment. Mendelssohn, "Elijah," No. 1, The harvest now is over; effective Imitation (echo) of last member of Theme ; brief harmonic episode. — No. 22, Though thou- sands languish ; Accompaniment partly harmonic. — No. 29, Shouldst thou, walking in grief. — Final chorus, Lord, our Creator. Handel, " Israel in Egypt," No. 4, They loathed to drink. — No. 10, He brought (hem out with silver and gold. — No. 16, And believed the Lord; homophonic epi- Par. 153. THE VOCAL FUGUE. 255 sodes. — No. 1 8, T will sing, and For He hath triumphed ; two Themes in fairly regular alternation, — not together (camp. par. 52). — No. 26, Thou sentest forth Thy wrath. — No. 13, He led them through the deep ( Double-chorus, 4- to 8-voice texture) ; characteristic Counterpoint, thematic (quasi " Double "). — Etc. Brahms, "German Requiem," No. Ill, final tempo (Der Gerechten Seelen — The souls of the righteous) ; the entire Fugue rests upon a persistent Tonic organ-point. — No. VI, final tempo {Herr, Du bist wiirdig — Thou art worthy) ; powerful thematic episodes ; variety of Counterpoints. Brahms, Motet, op. 29, No. II ; 2nd movement and Finale. Horatio W. Parker, " Hora Novissima," No. 4, Pars mea, Hex meus. — No. 10, Urbs Syon unica (unaccompanied). — No. n, quartet, Urbs Syon inclyta ; Subject of unusual length, n measures (cited again in par. 189). — H. W. Parker, " St. Chris- topher,'' Act III, Scene 2, Quoniam Tu solus sanctus (Contrary motion; Augmen- tation). Beethoven, "Mass in C," op. 85, Cum sancto spiritu ; simple Exposition; Inter- lude, chiefly harmonic; new Exposition with chromatic Counterpoint. — Et vitam venturi ; instrumental Interludes, and vocal Soli. — Osanna in excelsis. Beethoven, "Mass in D," op. 123, In gloria Dei patris, Amen; elaborate; Counterpoint retained through the Exposition ; partly double-quartet. — Osanna in excelsis (both versions). Verdi, " Falstaff," Finale, Tulto nel mondo e burla ; large chorus, but practically 4-voice ; Counterpoint retained during first section, and used later episodically ; fre- quent contrary motion. EXERCISE 44. A. Two Fugues (each with brief Introduction, or Prelude) for String-quartet, — major and minor ; different measure and tempo for each. B. A Fugue, with Prelude, for Pianoforte and Violin. C. Two or more Fugues for mixed quartet (or chorus), with organ or pianoforte accompaniment. The text may be taken from any of the above examples, or from any part of the Bible. Fugue in Connection with Chorale. 154. Fugue with Chorale. This form corresponds in design exactly to the Invention with Chorale, but differs from the latter in that greater degree of seriousness and strictness which distinguishes the Fugue in general from the Invention. All the specific directions are given in paragraphs 99 to 105, which must be thoroughly reviewed. The introductory measures (par. lood) are usually a regular Expo- sition (par. 121, etc.), during the later course of which the chorale melody appears, in the part left vacant for the purpose. Thereafter the form is that of the ordinary sectional Fugue, into the texture of which the chorale Lines are successively interwoven, apparently as incidental 256 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 155. addition, — though naturally they influence (or even dictate) the pro- gressive development. The Subject is almost invariably evolved out of the first Line of the chorale, with more or less freedom. Analyze minutely: Bach, Organ Comp. (Peters compl. ed.), Vol. VI, No. 30; 3-voice ; Cantus firmus in Bass ; long Theme, independent of the chorale, with two very quaint modifications. — Vol. VII, No. 39a; 4 -voice ; c. f. in Soprano; Theme derived from first two Lines of chorale ; a. stretto-Imitation, with which the Fugue begins (after two beats, in the 5th), recurs frequently; other stretti, and contrary motion, also appear. This is an extremely interesting and instructive example. Compare it carefully with the next, Vol. VII, No. 39*, which it closely resembles in all essential respects ; 4- voice ; c. f in Tenor. Guilmant, Organ Sonata, Op. 80, Finale. Mendelssohn, " St. Paul," No. 36, But our God ; 5-voice ; chorale in 2nd Soprano ; two Themes, in fairly regular alternate Sections, both independent of the chorale. 155. Chorale as Fugue-group. This is the parallel form of the cho- rale as Invention-group, explained in par. 106, which review thoroughly. Out of each successive Line of the chorale a Subject is evolved ; each Subject in turn is carried strictly through the parts, as Exposition, in which the chorale finally participates, as usual. Thus the whole constitutes a group or chain of Fugues (or Fugue-Expositions, — Fughettas) , corresponding to the number of Lines in the chorale. See Bach, Organ Comp., Vol. VI, No. 21 ; 4-voice ; i.f. in Soprano, each time as last announcement of the Theme. — Vol. VI, No. 28; 4-voice; c.f. in Soprano, as Augmentation of Theme. — Vol. VII, No. 37 ; 4-voice; c.f. in Soprano, some- what embellished, and each time as last announcement of the Theme ; a new (10th) Motive for the Coda, in animated rhythm. — Vol. VII, No. 50; 4-voice; the last announcement of Theme each time in Bass, as Cantus firmus. — Vol. VII, No. 55 ; 4-voice; the Pedal is added as duplication of the Bass at end of each Exposition, to emphasize the c.f. — Vol. VI, No. 13 ; 6-voice; c.f in 1st Bass, as Augmentation of the Theme; several thematic Counterpoints. — Brahms, Chorale- Vorspiele, op. 122, No. 1. — Brahms, Motet, op. 29, No. 1 ; 5-voice; c. f in 1st Bass. 156. The Chorale-Fugue. Somewhat allied to the Chorale-Invention, par. no, which review. The Subject, or Subjects, are derived from the first, or later, Lines of the chorale, and manipulated in the usual manner. But the chorale-melody, as such, is absent. See Bach, Org. Comp., Vol. VI, No. 33 ; 4-voice ; many stretti ; two auxiliary, or episodic, Motives. — Vol. VI, No. 1 1 ; 3-voice ; thematic Counterpoint in later Sections. — Vol. VI, No. 20 ; 4-voice ; special design. — Vol. VII, No. 41 ; 4- to 5- voice ; secondary Motive, derived from Counterpoint. — Vol. VII, No. 60; 4-voice- basse ostinato in Pedal (transposed recurrences) ; thematic Counterpoints. Par. 157. THE FUGUE-GROUP. 2$? A smaller variety, the Chorale-Fughetta, is illustrated in the follow- ing: Bach, Org. Comp., Vol. V, No. 20; 3-voice. — Vol. V, No. 43, 3-voice. — VoL VII, No. 61 ; 3-voice. — Vol. VII, No. 40c; 4-voice ; Exposition in stretto. — Vol. VII, No. 54 ; 3-voice ; the Subj ect, and two secondary Motives, are derived from three Lines of the chorale ; Line 4 is intimated by the descending scale, constantly present in the Counterpoints. The Group- (or Motet-) Fugue. 157. The Fugue-group is similar to the form described in par. i55 ) but is usually broader in design, and by no means necessarily identified with the chorale. Different Subjects — usually, though not neces- sarily, of similar character (and perhaps related in contents) — are successively, sometimes alternately, manipulated as separate complete Fugues (or Fughettas), more or less extensively and independently. See Bach, Org. Comp., Vol. Ill, Fugue 6 ; 4-voice ; large 3-Part form ; the first Subject is the basis of Part I ; a totally different Subject (chromatic) is manipulated in Part II, as separate Fugue, so to speak ; in Part III the first Subject is resumed ; this Part is a nearly exact recurrence of the first Section of Part I, abbreviated at the beginning, and extended at the end. — Vol. Ill, Fugue 7 ; 4-voice ; the first Division is a Double-fugue (to be analyzed later) ; the second Division is a brief Interlude (free, similar to the Prelude to the whole number) ; the third Division is based upon a rhythmically modified Augmentation of the first measure of the preceding Fugue- subject; animated rhythmic Counterpoints in later course. — Vol. Ill, Fugue 9; 4- voice ; interjoined with the Praeludium (meas. 1-39) ; Division I is a Double-fugue (see later), to meas. 62 ; Division II has a different Theme, though somewhat related to the preceding; an independent Coda, similar to the Introduction, is added. — Vol. VI, No. 10 ; Chorale-fugue (chorale itself absent), in group-form ; 3-voice ; three sections; two different Subjects alternating (returning to first). — Vol. VI, No. 34; ditto; 4-voice; 5 Themes (or Motives, — quasi Invention-group). Bach, "B-minor Mass," No. 19, last Division (Vivace e allegro'), El exfecto and Amen ; 4 Themes. Mendelssohn, " St Paul," No. 23, For all the Gentiles, and Now are made mani- fest ; 5-voice; large 3-Part form, quasi Song with Trio. — No. 20, The Lord He is good, and For His word ; successive Expositions, and then close alternate treatment (not " Double-fugue "). — Final chorus, Bless thou the Lord, and All ye His angels ; 4-voice ; two Subjects. EXERCISE 45. A. One or two examples of the Fugue with Chorale (par. 154). B. One or two examples of the Chorale as Fugue-group (par. 155). C. An example of the Chorale-Fugue (par. 156). 258 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 158. D. One or two examples of the Fugue-group (par. 157). a Prelude, or free Introduction, is to be prefixed. To each of the latter Irregular Fugue-Species 158. The Fugue in Contrary motion (per moto contrario). In this species the first and third Imitations of the Theme are made in Con- trary motion, so that the 4-voice Exposition consists of the alternate " regular " and " contrary " motion (the latter standing each time for the usual " Response "). This arrangement may extend through the entire Fugue ; or it may be confined wholly (or nearly) to the Exposi- tion ; and, further, the alternation may be more or less irregular (for instance, in the Exposition, or later, the regular motion twice, followed by the contrary motion twice ; etc.). The relation of the contrary motion to the original form of the Theme is generally that defined in par. 29a, particularly Ex. 72, which review. See also Exs. 73 and 74. The Theme in contrary motion may be announced in the original key, or, as usual, in the Dominant key (by simple transposition to the upper 5th or lower 4th). Analyze, thoroughly, Bach, " The Art of Fugue," Fugue No. 5. The Exposi- tion runs as follows : Andante con moto. Ex. 162. tfkr — - mm- .. Theme. rf- -m-P- -r^ -r -£t=E; 3^ ^Q2P — rf± = ^~-t. J \>y — * 1 - £: 4- — Theme, Cont. Motion.. Theme, Cont. Motion l d gf^ gzrcn Par. 158. IRREGULAR FUGUE-SPECIES. 259 r ' Theme. _ J --¥ =t=4 1. JL lu- etic. ^ ^^E ^ TT Six measures later (in meas. 1 7) the Exposition closes, with a vague cadence. The Fugue has a Special Design, extending through 5 Sections; Sec. II (meas. 17- 33) is very similar to the preceding one; Sec. Ill (meas. 33-46) is based upon a stretto in contrary motion ; Sec. IV (meas. 47-65) upon a stretto in parallel motion, after one and one-half measures ; Sec. V (to meas. 86) upon a parallel stretto, after one measure. The Coda (last 5 measures) is based upon a simultaneous (or double) announcement, in regular and contrary motion. — "Art of Fugue," Fugue - No. 13; 3-voice ; per moto contrario, absolutely regular alternation ; frequent episodes, all similar; cadences vague. The following number (13^) is the exact contrary motion, and partial Inversion, of the preceding. — " Art of Fugue," two Fugues for 2 piano- fortes ; both 4-voice, xndper moto contrario ; the Fugues are different manipulations of the same Subject. Compare them minutely. Brahms, Fugue in cfo minor for Organ, first 27 measures ; 4-voice ; Counter- point retained, in regular and contrary motion. Handel, "Israel in Egypt," No. n, Egypt was glad, first 30 measures; 4-voice; the Dominant (b in e minor) is answered by the Tonic (e), in the first " Response " ; the two following announcements are both in the original motion ; later the alterna- tion is more regular. Mendelssohn, motion. 'Elijah,'' No. 16, The flames consume; Exposition in contrary Beethoven, String-quartet, op. 127, Scherzando vivace ; Exposition in contrary motion ("fugato," — i.e, in fugal style, imitatory, but not exactly a Fugue). Bach, Org. Comp., Vol. VII, No. 39^ ; Fugue per moto contrario, with Chorale ; 5-voice ; Cantus firmus in Bass ; stretto-imitations throughout. 159. The Fugue in Augmentation, or in Diminution. In this species, which is very similar to the above, the Augmentation, or Diminution, of the Subject is substituted for the contrary motion ; or, in rare in- stances, is combined with the latter. See Bach, " Art of Fugue," Fugue No. 6 ; this is a 4-voice Fugue in " Diminu- tion and Contrary motion"; probably 3 Sections and Coda; the Exposition begins thus: 260 APPLIED COUXTERPOINT. Par. 160. Ex. 163. I Th. Dim. and Cont. Motion , S ostenuto. J. f-5 l ^g-i- -i-£ j ufl^ JTs ^= w ziz^t i+-W -¥^=i m f=* r«rtr~iror H Th. Diminution.. _etc. §ffi Theme._ g E %=f ?V=P¥ "Art of Fugue," Fugue No. 7; 4-voice Fugue in "Augmentation and Contrary motion " ; contains also a series of Double-augmentations, and fragments of the Diminution (end of 7th measure, in Soprano) ; cadences very vague ; the form is either simply one broad section, constituting the Exposition of the Double-augmentation, through the four parts (Bass, Tenor, Alto, Soprano, alternately in contrary and regu- lar motion) ; or it contains four Sections, with one announcement of the Double- augmentation in each. Handel, "Messiah," No. 33, Let all the angels ; Fugue in Augmentation. 160. The Fantasia-fugue. This somewhat contradictory term may- be justified in the case of those Fugues which begin seriously, and con- tain a more or less legitimate Exposition, but thereafter degenerate into a free, fantastic series of sections or sentences (passages), based upon fragments only of the Theme, possibly in distorted forms. A beautiful and entirely defensible illustration occurs in Bach, Well-temp. CI, Vol. II, Fugue 3 ; it is 3-voice, sectional form ; the Exposition is in stretto, and Contrary motion (Subject in Bass, i\ measure), ending in meas. 7; in Sec II (meas. 7-1 1) the 2nd half of the Theme is reconstructed; Sec. Ill (meas. 11-14) is episodic; Sec. IV (meas. 14-17) reverts to the original form of the Theme; the last Section (meas. 1 7 to the end) does not contain the original Theme entire, but is one long episode, or Fantasia (18 measures), in which intimations of the Diminution, Augmentation, and a unique mixture of other thematic fragments occur. — See also Bach, Clav. Comp., Peters ed. 216, No. 6, "Capriccio"; the purpose is evidently that of a Fugue, but the extensive episodic passages (quasi homophonic figuration), and the general treatment, make the title " capriccio " more appropriate. Kindred forms are (1) the Recitative-fugue : See Mendelssohn, Pfte. Sonata, op. 6, Adagio movement ; no definite measure ; 4- to 5-voice ; large 2-Part form, with a homophonic (lyric) section as Interlude, and Postlude, in J time. and (2) the Harmonic fugue, i.e., a fugal thematic design, but of marked harmonic character, or with distinctly harmonic auxiliary parts. See Schumann, op. 32, No. 4, " Fughetta." — Bach, Clav. Comp., Peters ed. 211, No. 3. Par. 161. THE DOUBLE-FUGUE. 26 1 EXERCISE 46. One example each of the Fugue in Contrary motion (par. 158), and the Fugue in Augmentation, — or in Diminution, at option, — (par. 159). CHAPTER XV. The Double-Fugue. 161. The Double-fugue is one in which two Subjects appear, and are manipulated, simultaneously. It is not to be confounded with the forms cited in par. 52, par. 106, par. 155, and par. 157, in which two (or more) Themes are treated successively, each by itself for the time being; but takes its name from the fact that its thematic basis is a Double-theme —thematic duet. It is not necessary that the two Subjects should always be together, for, as will be seen, either (or each) may be announced alone, or even have a separate Exposition ; but, in order to achieve the idea and purpose of the Double-fugue, the Themes must appear in conjunction, distinctly, and during a reasonably extended section of the whole. 162. The Double-fugue has its inception in that variety of the single Fugue in which, as shown in par. 132, the first Counterpoint is retained, more or less persistently, throughout a part, or the whole, of the Fugue ; for such companionship between the Subject and its Counterpoint ap- proaches the effect of an intentional double thematic basis. Review par. 132, and context, thoroughly. But there still remains a character- istic difference between such examples of retained Counterpoints and the genuine Double-fugue. 163. An important intermediate grade, sufficiently independent to merit separate treatment, is The Fugue with Thematic Counterpoint. An ordinary contrapuntal associate of the Theme, such as is found in the majority of simple Fugues, could not be called " thematic," even if " retained " and introduced occasionally in subsequent announce- ments, for the reason that it provides no especial thematic feature, does 262 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 163. not enrich the thematic resources, and takes no active part in the devel- opment of the design. In order to be thematic, the Counterpoint must be to a certain extent characteristic, must contain rhythmic and melodic features which distinguish it somewhat from the Theme ; must recur often enough and emphatically enough to become a recognizable (though not obtrusive) line in the physiognomy of the Fugue ; must influence the development, and enter actively (though not vitally, or perhaps even essentially) into the thematic texture as a whole. All this the " Counterpoint " may be, without becoming a genuine Secondary Theme, or subject to any special conditions with regard to time, place, frequency, or accuracy of recur- rence. To this class belongs, properly speaking, the example already cited in par. 132 : Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. II, Fugue 9; see Ex. 153. Also Vol. I, Fugue 14; possibly also Vol. II, Fugue 22. More genuine examples of the Fugue with Thematic Counterpoint are the following, — to be carefully analyzed : Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. II, Fugue 17 j 4-voice; sectional form ; Subject and Counterpoint as follows : Lento. j^ ^ Eg^ i^Sjg Ex. 164. Subject.. Response.. 1 Thematic Counterpoint.. The Thematic Counterpoint is absent during 3 or 4 announcements of the Theme, and is often freely modified. Further, Bach, Org. Comp., Vol. IV, Fugue 7 ; 4-voice ; 4 sections ; Counterpoint retained throughout, but modified freely. — Vol. IV, No. 10, " Canzona" (equivalent to Fugue), Division I ; 4-voice; 2 sections; few episodes; Thematic Counterpoint retained, but modified. Bach, Clavichord Comp., Peters ed. 212, No. 3; 3- to 4-voice. — In the same volume (212), No. 5, the same principle is somewhat extended, inasmuch as two different Thematic Counterpoints appear, in different rhythms; this approaches the idea of par. 179. Further, Bach, Well-temp. Clav., Vol. I, Fugue 2 ; 3 voice ; sectional form ; Subject and Counterpoint as follows : Par. 164. THE DOUBLE-FUGUE. 263 Moderate 165. Subject.. Response. 'M J_ ai wi ^"i & *• -B- =#r= it* 1 Thematic Counterpoint.. In order to perceive the melodic beauty and thematic validity of this Thematic Counterpoint, it should be played or sung alone. It accompanies the Theme every- where, with but one exception (in the Codetta, last 2\ measures), and participates in all the episodes. For these reasons the Fugue barely escapes being " Double " ; it would be unquestionably so were the Counterpoint more nearly coordinate, in char- acter and importance, with the Theme proper. To the same class, closely approximating the Double-fugue, belong Fugue 3 and Fugue 7 of Vol. I (Well-temp. Clav.) ; and Fugue 13 of Vol. II. — Also Partita No. 6 (Clav.), " Gigue "; large 2-Part form; Contrary motion in Part II ; Thematic Coun- terpoint retained, but considerably changed in Second Part. 164. During the Exposition the Thematic Counterpoint appears, at each succeeding announcement of the Theme, in the part which last contained the latter; i.e., the Counterpoint follows the Theme, each time, in the same part (whether interrupted by episodes or not). After the Exposition, however, the location of the Counterpoint, like that of the Theme, is optional ; and it may be occasionally omitted, or more or less modified. EXERCISE 47. One or two examples of the Fugue (3- or 4-voice) with Thematic Counterpoint. The Genuine Double-Fugue. 165. In the authentic Double-fugue, the two Subjects are strictly coordinate. The secondary Theme (sometimes so called merely by way of distinction), or Counter-theme, is not a " thematic counterpoint," but an essential part of the thematic material, subject to precisely the same specific limitations as the principal Theme. Rule 1. Each Subject must be a perfectly good melody, in and by itself. Hence, each must be tested alone, in order to verify its indi- vidual validity as thematic sentence. 264 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 165. Rule 2. Each Subject must be well individualized ; must differ from its fellow (chiefly as regards its rhythmic formation) sufficiently to con- trast perceptibly in character, though not obtrusively. They should not begin exactly together, nor need they end upon the same beat. Rule 3. The two Subjects must constitute peculiarly faultless coun- terpoint, — not by any means to the exclusion of characteristic disso- nances, but without any awkward irregularities. They should not cross each other; and, as a rule, should not run much beyond an octave or tenth apart, in their original associated form, when designed for a Fugue with 4 or more parts. Compare these rules with the primary definition of polyphony on page 1, of which they are simply a singularly severe and just exposition. Rule 4. After the Double-subject has been completed, it must be tested in inverted form, i.e., the parts so exchanged that the upper becomes the lower. Also, though less urgently, in their joint Contrary motion. This is necessary, not only because it is impossible to avoid Inversion, in the development of the Double-subject, but because the art of the Double-fugue consists in a great measure in these, and many similar, changes in the relations of the two Themes to each other. Review pars. 55 to 58, especially par. 57 ; and refer, briefly, to Artificial Double-counterpoint, par. 169, etc. Examples of Double-subjects : 1. Moderato. Theme A. *i) ^ ^ i fc^ GOETSCHIUS. 1 Ex. 166. 33 Theme B Ssrf^ef^=fftgf 2. Allegro. Theme B GOETSCHIUS. r trr i 3. Allegro. I % ~M 4U rrr-r *^f St Th. B Par. 165. THE DOUBLE-FUGUE. 265 g j-^rn Bach. IE ■Q f^j IrT W 4. Vivace. Th. |A. Bach. Th. B.i i i I I " ! ! ! "M -H ^^ i 5. Allegro moderate). HC 1 *z P^ 1 _ -p-f" Theme B. 1 I I I I i^fee^^ -* — * — *- — *- Theme A. I Bach. p=t=pzg, — #__7&— =— i ^_,— =j=B 1 — ^^ — I F-i-Pf-MH^FP-FF-*-!! SE E EH _ 1 1 - 2& — «-j-« - ^te^EEg Efe ttt 6. Molto allegro, Th. B. I ^. l¥. fc ^- j-^ J^i Mozart. I Th. A. 7. Andante con moto. Th. A. ^fe^£B*JffiK&J Rubinstein, rfTT-sN Th. B. 8. Animato. Saint-Saens. i Th. B. Ett ^3 I H=SEELi Tfrf ajETPfil r ft Th. A. 266 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 166. *i) The Themes are marked thus, A and B ; generally in the order in which they appear, — A being the first. — *2) A fine example. Play each Th. alone. See further, Bach, Well-temp. Clav., Vol. I, Fugue 12, meas. 4-6; Theme B begins with iU in the 3rd beat of the 4th measure. — Vol. II, Fugue 16, meas. 5-9; Theme Z? begins one i6th-note after A. — Fugue 18, meas. 97-101 ; Theme B begins on the 3rd 8th-note. — Fugue 20, meas. 3-5 ; Theme B commences with the 32nd- notes. — Fugue 23, meas. 27-30. 166. Double-fugues are divided into three classes or Species, ac- cording to the degree of importance assumed by Theme B. The First Species of Double-Fugue. 167. In this Species, the two Subjects are announced together at the beginning of the Fugue. a. They may appear in any two of the parts to be employed, but are almost certain to be in neighboring parts (either the upper, inner, or lower pair). During the Exposition, for instance in 4 parts, the rules of par. 123 (which review) apply to each Theme independently of the other ; i.e., each one takes its way through the four voices in the usual order. For instance (assuming them to start in the inner pair of voices) : Soprano, A..B.. B..A.. B..A.. Alto, A..B A B.. A..B Tenor, B A . . ° r : B . . A ° r: B..A Bass, A..B.. B..A.. A..B.. If announced in parallel parts, a collision is possible, but always easily to be avoided. Thus : Soprano, A . . B. Alto, A . . B. . Tenor, B . . A. Bass, B . .A.. A but of course not thus : AB. . B These principles can also be readily applied to the Fugue for 3 or 5 voices. b. After the Exposition these regulations are relaxed, as usual ; the two Themes may appear in any pair of parts, in optional frequency ; and, possibly, one or the other of the Themes may occasionally appear alone, though this should occur very rarely, as it militates against the specific conditions of this species of the Double-fugue. Review par. 128. Either Subject may, as usual, be slightly modified or abbreviated, as occasion or necessity arises, but not to the extent permitted with a mere " Thematic Counterpoint." Par. 167b. THE DOUBLE-FUGUE. 267 The formal designs, and all other structural details, correspond exactly to those given in Chapters XII, XIII, and XIV. Analyze, very minutely, the following examples of the First Species : Bach, Org. Comp., Vol. II, No. 6, Praeludium ; the whole is a brilliant example of the Concert-species (par. 148), in 3-Part Song-form; Section I is a largely homo- phonic introduction, exactly reproduced at the end as Sec. V, or Third Part ; the Double-fugue begins with Sec. II (meas. 25) and extends through Sees. II, III (Part II) and IV ; it is 4-voice, and slightly irregular, as regards the order of voices, in the Exposition. Vol. Ill, No. 9, Fuga, first Division; 4-voice; 2 Sections (meas. 39-63 of whole piece). Vol. IV, No. 8, Fuga ; 4-voice ; 4 Sections and Coda ; lengthy episodes ; Theme B enters two measures later than Theme A ; Exposition somewhat imperfect. Vol. IV, No. 10, "Canzona," Division II (§ time); the First Division has al- ready been cited as Fugue with Thematic Counterpoint; this Second Division is a Double-fugue, based upon the same Themes, rhythmically and melodically modified ; form sectional, cadences vague ; 4-voice. Bach, Clav. Duetto, No. I (Peters ed. 208, No. 4). Bach, Clav. Toccata in d minor (Peters ed. 210, No. 4); Third Division, Presto ; 3-voice, sectional, very free ; the first 2 measures in lower part are introduc- tory auxiliary tones, derived from Theme A, and frequently recurring; Theme B begins in meas. 3 ; another auxiliary Motive appears later. — Same Toccata, Finale; 3-voice ; also very free ; the first 1 1 measures are introductory. Bach, Org. Comp., Vol. VI, No. 18; 3-voice \ per moto contrario ; Chorale- fugue. — Vol. V, No. 23 ; 3-voice ; Double-fughetta. Handel, Clav. Suite No. 6, 3rd movement. Beethoven, op. 120, Var. 32 ; 4-voice ; in final sections a new thematic Counter- point, in animated rhythm, is introduced. Rubinstein, op. 53, No. 6 ; 4-voice ; 3-Part form ; Concert-species. Clementi, Gradus ad Parnassum, Schirmer ed., No. 97 (orig. ed. No. 54), Fugue, with Prelude; 4-voice; contains Retrograde Imitations (par. 29^). Also No. 98 (orig. ed. No. 74) ; 4-voice. Haydn, "Creation,'' No. 27b, Glory to His name, and He sole on high exalted reigns. Also No. 33, Jehovah 's praise for ever, and Amen; Theme B fragmentary, and not constant. N. B. In some of these examples Theme B might, probably, be more justly regarded as a Thematic Counterpoint only. Handel, " Israel in Egypt," No. 9, He smote all the first-born. Cherubini, " Missa solemnis," Cum sancto spiritu. Also Amen of the Credo. Mozart, " Requiem," No. 1, Kyrie ; reproduced as Finale, with different text. EXERCISE 48. A. Invent a large number of Double-subjects, in various styles, tempi, keys, and modes. 268 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 168. B. Write two 2-voice Inventions, with Double-subject, ist Species. Models for this work will be found in Bach, 2-voice Inventions, Nos. 5, 6, 9, 11, 12, and 15 ; and Well-temp. Clav., Vol. I, Prelude 3 ; Vol. II, Prelude 20 ; analyze thoroughly. C. Two Double-fughettas (one or two Sections), major and minor respectively ; 4-voice and 3-voice. D. Two complete Double-fugues, ist Species, 3-, 4-, or 5-voice; for Pianoforte, Organ, String-quartet, or Vocal parts. The Second Species of Double— Fugue. 168. In the Second Species, Theme B enters as first contrapuntal associate, in connection with the second announcement of Theme A (i.e., with the first " Response "). It therefore corresponds, in this respect, to the Fugue with Thematic Counterpoint ; but all the conditions detailed in par. 165 must be strictly observed. The order of voices during the Exposition is simpler than in the First Species, because Theme B naturally (and almost invariably) fol- lows Theme A in the same voice, — precisely as shown in Exs. 164, 165, excepting that the contrapuntal associate is a genuine Counter-theme, and not merely a thematic counterpoint. But, as Theme A thus ap- pears once alone, the Exposition is generally extended by one extra announcement, in order that Theme B may appear in every part ; i.e., in the 4-voice Fugue the Exposition usually embraces five announcements of Theme A, the 5 th time in the voice which began the Fugue. See Bach, Well-temp. Clav., Vol. I, Fugue 12 ; Theme A is announced in Tenor, then in Alto (meas. 4), Bass (meas. 7 — this is irregular — par. 124), Soprano (meas. 13), and again in Tenor (meas. 19); Theme B follows, each time, in the same voice; the Exposition closes in meas. 22. Exactly the same in Vol. II, Fugue 16, in every particular, excepting that the order of parts is regular ; the Exposition closes in meas. 24. — In Vol. II of the Org. Comp., Fugue 9, the Exposition is not thus extended. The distinction between the ist and 2nd Species is limited, thus, to the Exposition alone. The subsequent development is identical. Ana- lyze, very carefully, the following ; observe, here again, the degree and quality of freedom of detail exercised, and endeavor to recognize the factors that must be regarded as vital and inviolable : Bach, Well-temp. Clav., Vol. I, Fugue 12 ; 4-voice, sectional ; the 6 tones imme- diately following the cadence of Theme A (meas. 4, beats 1 and 2) are intermediate — see par. 121b ; they constitute the staple of all the episodic passages, which are of frequent and very regular occurrence throughout this Fugue ; Theme A appears alone in meas. 40—43. — Vol. II, Fugue 20 ; 3-voice, sectional. Bach, Org. Comp., Vol. II, Fugue 9 ; 4-voice ; definite 3-Part Song-form, Part III an exact reproduction of Part I, modified only at beginning; Concert-species; Par. 169. ARTIFICIAL DOUBLE-COUNTERPOINT. 269 many brilliant episodes, in animated rhythm. — Vol. Ill, Fugue 7, first Division ; 4- voice, sectional. Bach, Clav. Comp. (Peters ed. 211, No. 1), Fugue, with Toccata; 4-voice, sec- tional, regular and simple ; Contrary motion frequent. Duetto No. IV (Peters ed. 208, No. 4) ; 2-voice, sectional. — Toccata in / minor (Peters ed. 210, No. 2), Division IV, £ time; 4-voice, sectional. — Partita No. VI, " Toccata " ; 3 Divisions, embracing the Double-fugue (3-voice, sectional) be- tween a thematically related Prelude and Postlude. — (Same Partita, "Gigue"; already analyzed, as Fugue with Thematic Counterpoint). Handel, Clav. Suite No. II, Finale. Bach, Org. Comp., Vol. VII, No. 47 ; Fugue with Chorale ; 4-voice ; cantus firmus in Bass. — Vol. V, No. 39 ; chorale-fughetta, 3-voice. Handel, " Messiah," No. 23, And with His strifes. — " Samson," No. 9, Part II, Was ever the most High. Bach, " B-minor Mass," No. 4, Et in terra pax. EXERCISE 49. A number of Double-fugues, 2nd Species ; 3-, 4-, or 5-voice ; different character and tempo; instrumental or vocal. Some of the Double-subjects of Exercise 48^ may be utilized. Artificial Double-Counterpoint. 169. The term " artificial " is adopted (in its most serious sense) in distinction to " natural," with reference to those varieties of Double- counterpoint in which the harmonious result is not a matter of course, but must be assured by calculation. Review par. 55. As stated in pars. 55^ and 56, when the Double-counterpoint is obtained by inversion in the 8ve, no change of interval-relations takes place, and an equally harmonious agreement results, naturally. But no such natural guarantee exists when any other interval of inversion is used. Therefore, Double-counterpoint in the 8ve, without any other modification, is the only Natural kind, while Double-counterpoint in any other interval, or with any other modification of either part, belongs to the Artificial kind, and is to be determined only by calculation or experi- ment. 170. Double-counterpoint in the Twelfth. Double-counterpoint is obtained by transferring one part towards and past the other ; and the species is defined by the interval of inversion involved. For example, if the lower part remains, and the upper part is shifted downward a 12th (an 8ve and a 5th, or perhaps two 8ves and a 5th) the result is Pouble-cQunterpoint in the 12th. For illustration : 2 J O APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 170. (a) The Original Counterpoint. Th. B. J 67 Th. A r sio A. LA wmm (b) Inversion in the 12th (affecting Th. A). Th. A.*i) . ^ Th. B *i) Theme A is shifted up, past its fellow, a 12th; Theme B remains where it was. *z) Such modifications as this (/ changed to ft by the accidental) are often absolutely necessary, and are to be freely employed, with discretion, in favor of better modulatory agreement. Their use is entirely legitimate, inasmuch as the two forms (the Original and the Invention) never appear together. The change, however, may only affect the accidental, — never the letter. An apparently new result is obtained by moving the other Theme down, past its fellow, a 12th. But this, or any other movement of both parts together, equivalent to the 12th. represents simply a transposition of the Inverted form. Thus : (a) Inversion in 12th (affecting Th. B) . Ex. 168. Th. A..JJ — JL' -J. Th. pl ' I *! -ni *-!"- =P=i: 1 AY- 'S, s =r=#-» (fe)= (6) Inversion in the 12th (affecting both Themes). (#) F^rfTf L ,^,- sill ^£ I k>= fe^^ l f^^SE 5 — 1 ' — 1 p«i pqf wo i Inv. in the 12th. <£& B (5th higher). A (as before). *i) 5^ : N- N =3 q 1 1 n r j=i *T- 1 Brahms. *2) § ws •-*-• ^ 333 ■!-#■ Si -*--*- PB §±i*!F* -& — ff S HE §" i=t=^ *i ) That is to say, the same Awz« ( letters ) as before. The change of register makes no difference, as long as the parts pass each other, in the stipulated interval. *2) From the orchestral Variations upon a Theme by Haydn, op. 56, Var. IV. See also the next 20 measures, whick are followed by a similar exact Inversion in tke lath. See also Bach, " The Art of Fugue," Fugue 9 Original counterpoint in meas. 35-43 (Sopranp and Tenor) ; Inversion in the, 12th in meas. 45-53 (Tenor and Alto). Par. 172. ARTIFICIAL DOUBLE-COUNTERPOINT. 273 Same work, Canon IV j Original counterpoint in meas. 9—35 ; Imitation in 12th in meas. 42-68 (the upper part is shifted down a 12th, while the lower part retains the same tones, shifted up two octaves) ; a long and instructive example, to be carefully analyzed. 172. Double-counterpoint in the nth. Frequent use of the interval of a 6th will, as a rule, yield a good Inversion in the nth (the 6th becoming again a 6th). For example : Ex. I Orig. Cpt. B. 3 -S— *— ER4 ■$=£■ 3fc±a£ *#=* J — ^ — I -44- 171.EW *=btjz* tf- ~6 "' 6 6 6 6 6 Inv. in the nth. A (as before). * _JL B (nth lower). J- (b) * r- CErf- -Cf ^^ # # This species, Double-counterpoint in the nth, is the companion (the counter- part) of that in the 12th; and, because of the harmonic similarity between the 6th and the 3rd, is scarcely distinguishable from it. One is, technically speaking, simply the 8ve-inversion of the other. For illustration : invert the parts in Ex. 1670 (in the octave), and also invert Ex. 167* in the same manner; upon comparing the two results with each other they will be found to constitute Double-counterpoint in the nth. 173. a. Double-counterpoint in the 10th. The best device for Double- counterpoint in the 10th consists in doubling one of the Themes in the 3rd, and counterpointing the other Theme against this double line. In order to yield counterpoint in the 10th, the duplication must fall between the principal lines as a so-called inner 3rd ; i.e., it must be the lower third of the upper voice, or the upper third of the lower. Thus : 274 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 173c. Th. A. Bach. *i ) The large notes constitute the Original counterpoint ; the inner part (small notes) is a. duplication of the upper Theme in the lower or inner 3rd, in order to provide for Double-counterpoint in the 10th by inverting the parts, thus : Ex. 173. Th. B. (as before). J J L J. * -x- -s- 1 V T Th. A. ( 10th lower) f= t F lh b. Although Double-counterpoint always implies Inversion of the parts (as stated in par. 55), it must be understood that the principle is the same whether the Inver- sion actually takes place or not; and therefore Ex. 172 is as certainly Double-coun- terpoint, with its duplication of one part in the 3rd, as Ex. 173, or any other of the inverted forms. c. Such a duplication in the 3rd is less difficult and hazardous than might be suspected, and will quite frequently be found practicable with little or no change, in any ordinary counterpoint. The only necessary condition or limitation is, that the parts shall move in contrary direc- tions (at those points where both are moving). This may be verified in Ex. 172. It is applied, with precisely equal certainty, to the other part (Theme B) of the a"bove example, by Bach himself. Thus : Th. A. Ex. 174. 1 i * ■a- g^fll Double-cpt. in 10th. 1 ! . u ' w i i r I rrfl 9 j ryt»V $== t=t Th. B. T 53! t=F Srvgfey m 1 W. B. Each lower part alone must be valid with the upper. Par. 173d. ARTIFICIAL DOUBLE-COUNTERPOINT. 275 d. Further, exactly the same result is obtained by duplicating either part in the outer 6th (instead of inner 3rd, as in Exs. 172 and 174). Thus : Ex. 175 <£ mm 3=s m *-• Th. A. miv ¥=F f-\ E=F Th. B. b£tt. N. B. Play each duplicated part «/»«* with the other. And write out the Inverted forms of each example, complete, as in Ex. 173. 174. Double-cpt. in the 13th (or 6th). This is the companion-species of that in the 10th, and is obtained by duplicating either Theme in the outer jrd (pomp, par. 173a), or inner 6th (par. 173^). For example: Ex. 176. 4- i I Th. A. Th. B. If 3e ■ V (' ^^T^ 5 m^mm* ^^ m ^ tt=t 1 '■# -^-^ Th. B (as before). Inverted 1 ln the 13th : [3ZS— S 3 jn.*T ) w 1 etc. Th. A (13th lower). N. B. Play each upper part alone with the other. Write out the example also with duplication of the lower part in the outer (i.e., lower) 3rd. Write out each example in its Inverted form, complete. 175. It is sometimes possible to apply the device of duplication in the 3rd (or 6th) to both parts at once. Thus : 276 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 175. *i) Slightly changed from the Original (Bach, Well-temp. Clav., Vol. II, Fugue 16, meas. 59-63). Comp. with meas. 9-13; and see, also, meas. 45-49; 51-55; 69-73- The complication of Double-cpt. " Species " involved in such two- fold duplications can be defined only by reference to the Original form (here shown in large notes) : it is exceedingly confusing, — and no doubt wholly unnecessary. 'A long and instructive example of Double-counterpoint in the 10th may be found in Bach, "Art of Fugue," Canon III ; meas. 5—39 are inverted in the 10th in meas. 44-78 ; the lower part one 8 ve higher, and the upper a 1 oth lower, than before. Bach, 3-voice Inv. No. 8, meas. 17-18; upper, part duplicated in the inner 6th. — Well-temp. CI., Vol. II, Fugue 22, meas. 6-3 from the end (double duplications, partly in 6ths, and partly in 3rds). — Bach, Org. Comp., Vol. VI, No. 18, meas. 22-23 j Theme A in Bass, Theme B doubled in 3rds, slightly embellished, in upper parts< 176. Double-cpt. in the 9th, and its companion, in the 7th. For these extremely difficult and rare species there is no other guide than the rigid application of the two general principles, of (1) stepwise pro- gression and (2) contrary direction. For example : ( a ) Orig. Cpt ra^^^^^S Th. B. Th. A. ^ -•- -^-•- , rgs- ±3t. 1 Par. 176. ARTIFICIAL DOUBLE-COUNTERPOINT. 277 (&) Inversion. I p Th. A (as before). Th. B (7th lower). *i) *2) 5—? w=ss ^i: :£=E=E -=1— *- Th. B (9th lower). i :j^t g *^ f f r tr f -Tff id^dEdET^H I * ^ *=t -h es; *i) Theme B is written out in both species of Double-cpt. at once, in this instance, because they produce, together, a somewhat fuller and more plausible har- monic result than either would alone. This, however, is not (or should not be) necessary. *2) The addition of another part, as here, is often of the utmost consequence in denning more fully the harmonic intention. A double-subject, devised thus strictly in contrary directions, and •with exclusive stepwise progressions, will generally prove available for every species of Double-cpt. That is the case with Ex. 178, as the student may (and should) verify. Other Varieties of Artificial Double-Counterpoint. 177. These are purely experimental, and cannot be obtained by any method of calculation. They consist in multiplying the relations of the two Themes to each other by applying the ordinary modifications (Con- trary motion, Shifted rhythm, Augmentation, or Diminution) to either Theme alone, while the other retains its original form. For illustration, Ex. 167 chances to admit of transformation as follows : Th. B, as before. 1 1 1 . Ex. 179, 'rrm , I' l-^HT\ Th. A, in Contrary Motion. r-tTf * T m 278 APPLIED COUXTERPOINT. Par. 177 Th. B, in Shifted rhythm. SP ^ -*!) I I I I J- J1_i r_ g- j. Th. A, as in Orig. cpt. And Ex. 170, No. 2, reappears later thus: Th. A, as before. Bach. g3^E g£gJ^aSligf£l^fl Th. B, Shifted rhythm. *i) See Ex. 178, Note *2). See further, Bach, 2-voice Invention No. n ; Original cpt. in meas. 1—2, Theme A in upper, Theme B in lower part ; inverted in meas. 3-5, Theme A as before, but in lower part, Theme B in upper part in Contrary motion and Shifted rhythm. • — • B.ch, Well-temp. CI., Vol. II, Fugue 23 ; comp. meas. 60-63 with meas. 27—30 (Theme B in Shifted rhythm). EXERCISE 50. A. A number of Double-subjects in Double-cpt. in the 12th (par. 171). Each example is also to be written out in the 8ve-Inversion, and in complete Contrary motion (i.e., both Themes together in Contrary motion). See par.' 165, Rule 4. B. Double-subjects in Double-cpt. in the nth (par. 172). Each to be subjected to the same Inversions as at A. C. The same in Double-cpt. in the 10th (par. iy^a-e). D. The same in Double-cpt. in the 13th (par. 174). E. The same in Double-cpt. in the 9th, — and in the 7th. F. The Double-subjects invented in Exercise 4SA are to be subjected to very thorough experimental tests, with reference to the duplication of either, or both, of the Themes in the inner, or outer, 3rd. G. All of the above Double-subjects (including Exercise 48.^) are to be ex- haustively examined with reference to the experimental species of Artificial Double- cpt., illustrated in par. 177. The Third Species of Double-Fugue. 178. In this species, which may be regarded as the most genuine and distinctive of the Double-fugue, the entire Exposition (first section) is devoted to Theme A alone. And, in the broader Song-forms, this Par. 178. DOUBLE-FUGUE, THIRD SPECIES. 279 Exposition may be extended a section or more, so as to complete the measure of a full First Part. The following sections or Parts may then be designed in either of two ways : (1) Theme B may simply join Theme A, so that they appear in conjunction the rest of the way ; or (2) Theme B may also be first manipulated alone, for one section or Part, and the conjunction of the two Subjects follow in the final Sections, or Third Part. In the latter case, where each Subject is manipulated alone before they appear together, care must be taken to avoid contrapuntal associates that resemble the other Theme too closely, especially with regard to their rhythmic formation ; otherwise the subsequent conjunction of the Themes will not be striking enough, and the product may be monotonous. An incipient type of the first class is shown in par. 142, which review. The first class is illustrated in the following (to be thoroughly analyzed) : Bach, "The Art of Fugue," Fugue 9; 4-voice; 3 Sections, cadences vague; Theme A alone to meas. 34 ; A and B together from meas. 35 to the end. Con- tains Double-cpt. in the 12th. — Same work, Fugue 14; 4-voice; Theme A alone to meas. 21 ; A and B together from meas. 22 to the end; in Section III (meas. 34) there is a regular Exposition of an auxiliary Motive, derived from the first Counter- point (meas. 6-7) ; in Sec. V (meas. 67) another brief auxiliary Figure appears. Contains Double-cpt. in the 1 oth and 12th. The second class is illustrated in the following : Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. II, Fugue 18; 3-voice; 3-Part Song-form; Theme A alone to meas. 60 ; Theme B alone from meas. 61 to 96 ; A and B together from meas. 97 to end. The first counterpoint differs but little from Theme B, but the latter is nevertheless characteristic enough. Vol. II, Fugue 4; 3-voice; Theme A alone 10 meas. 19; in meas. 20-21 Theme B is introduced tentatively, once (in upper part), and in modified form ; meas. 24-29 Theme A again alone, Exposition of Contrary motion ; in meas. 30 Theme B is again "attempted" (lower part) in still another modified form; meas. 35-39 Theme B, in correct form, has a regular Exposition alone ; A and B together from meas. 48 to end. Artificial Double-cpt. freely applied. Bach, " The Art of Fugue," Fugue 10 ; this is practically the same as Fugue 14 (analyzed above), with which it must be very carefully compared ; it differs from No. 14 in containing an additional first Section (meas. 1-22), devoted to the Exposition of Theme B ; i.e., it begins with the "secondary Subject"; thereafter it corresponds very closely to No. 14. Hence it contains : Theme B alone in Sec. I, Theme A alone in Sec. II, both together the rest of the way. The Subjects are well contrasted. Bach Org. Comp., Vol. IV, No. 6 ; 4-voice ; 3-Part Song-form ; Theme A in Part I Theme B in Part II, both together in Part III ; the last 14 measures are an 280 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 178. independent Postlude, quasi free Fantasia. The Pedal announces both Themes almost invariably in simplified rhythmic form ; frequent perfect cadences in course of the Sections ; few episodes until near the end. Themes well contrasted. Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. I, Prelude 7; 3 rhythmically contrasted Divisions; texture more free than in the genuine Double-fugue. Mendelssohn, Pfte. Comp., op. 35, Fugue 4 ; 4-voice ; 3-Part Song-form ; Theme A in Part I, to meas. 46 ; Theme B alone to meas. 96, often in modified form ; A and B together, with some freedom of treatment, from meas. 97 to end. Themes rhythmically contrasted. Analyze, further, the following miscellaneous examples (irrespective of class) : Bach, Partita (Clav.) No. 5, " Gigue " ; large 2-Part form, Gigue-species. Bach, Clav. Comp., Toccata in c minor (Peters ed. 210, No. 3) ; Divs. I and II are introductory; Div. Ill, lengthy Exposition of Theme A (3-voice, Concert-species) ; a brief interlude follows, and then Div. IV, with Themes A and B together. — Fan- tasia e Fuga in a minor (Peters ed. 208, No. 2) ; excellent example ; 4-voice ; 3-Part Song-form. Mozart, String-quartet (Peters ed. 1037a), No. 1, G major, Finale; Double- fugue in homophonic surroundings (as Sonata-movement). Regular Exposition of two different Subjects, one at the beginning, and the other 30 or 40 measures later; both together in final Division (the " Recapitulation "). Raff, Pfte. Suite, op. 69, Finale. Saint-Saens, Pfte. Etudes, op. 52, No. 3, Fugue with Prelude ; only a very concise Exposition of Theme B, and no more than brief fragmentary conjunction with Theme A, in last Section. Rubinstein, Pfte. Fugues and Preludes, op. 53. Fugue 1, 3-voice. — Fugue 4, 4-voice ; 5-Part Song-form ; * contains Contrary motion, and Augmentations. Handel, Clav. Suite IV, first movement ; 4-voice. Vocal: Handel, "Israel in Egypt," No. n, Egypt was glad (Fugue in Contrary motion). — -The same, No. 21, And I will exalt Him, and I will exalt Him. Mendelssohn, " St. Paul," No. 22 ; Sing His glory, and Amen. Bach, " B-minor Mass," No. 19, Confiteor, and In remissionem ; near the end a Cantus firmus is interwoven, first in canonic imitation, and then single, in Augmen- tation. Irregular (4.TH) Species of Double-Fugue. 179. An irregular variety of the Double-fugue, which might be desig- nated as the 4th Species, consists of one principal Theme, with two or more contrasting thematic Counterpoints, one or the other (or all) of which may assume the importance of a genuine secondary Theme. * Homophonic Forms, Chap. XVI. Par. 179. DOUBLE-FUGUE, FOURTH SPECIES. 28 1 The thematic Counterpoints (or Counter-themes) are likely to appear in successive sections, or Parts, of the usual forms. Analyze, thoroughly, Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. II, Fugue 23; 4-voice; the first 27 measures are an Exposition of the principal Subject, with a characteristic the- matic counterpoint, appearing first in meas. 5-8 (Bass) ; after meas. 27 it is perma- nently abandoned. In Part II (meas. 27-74) a second thematic counterpoint, or, rather, a genuine Counter-theme, appears, first in Soprano ; in meas. 60-62 it is shifted backward a half -measure (par. 177); and Double-cpt. in the 12th abounds throughout. At the beginning of Part III (meas. 75) Theme A occurs once alone. This example resembles those of par. 142 (which see), but is more nearly a genuine Double-fugue. See further, Bach, Org. Comp., Vol. Ill, Fugue 1 ; 5-voice ; 3 distinct Divisions, — somewhat like the Fugue-Group (par. 157) ; Div. I, £ time, Exposition of principal Theme ; Div. II, f time, contains an Exposition of the First Counter-theme alone, in slightly modified form, and the conjunction of this with the principal Theme (rhyth- mically modified on account of the change in measure) ; Div. III,^ time, consists in a similar Exposition of the Second Counter-theme alone, and its conjunction with the principal Theme, again with modified notation. Analyze minutely, and compare with the next-following Fugue. Vol. Ill, Fugue 2 ; 4-voice ; 3-Part Song-form ; the First Counter-theme is asso- ciated with the principal Theme in Sections I and II (to meas. 70) as a Double-fugue of the 2nd Species ; the Second Counter-theme has an independent Exposition in meas. 70-128, as Part II ; Part III begins with one conjunction of the First Coun- ter-theme with the principal Theme, but consists thereafter of the association of the latter with the Second Counter-theme. Neither of these examples must be confounded with the Triple-fugue (par. 180), for nowhere are all three Subjects combined. Bach, Clav. Comp. (Peters ed. 212, No. 5); 4-voice; two different thematic Counterpoints, in different rhythms, and slightly modified, — i.e., not genuine Counter-themes. Raff, Pfte. Suite, op. 91, first movement ; elaborate Introduction, as Fantasia; first announcement of Fugue-subject interwoven with last vanishing chords of the Introduction ; two different thematic Counterpoints, in accelerated rhythms. Beethoven, " Mass in D," op. 123, Et vitam venturi ; two different Counter- themes. EXERCISE 51. A. A number of Double-fugues, 3rd Species, 3, 4, or 5 parts, for pianoforte, organ, string-quartet, or vocal parts. Any Double-subject of former Exercises may be used, preferably those of Exercise 50, with a view to manipulation in both Natural and Artificial Double-cpt. B. One or two Double-fugues of the 4th Species, according to par. 179. 282 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 180. CHAPTER XVI. The Triple-Fugue. 180. The Triple-fugue is based upon three different coordinate Themes, which appear together, as a threefold Subject, during some portion of the composition. All the rules of par. 165 apply strictly, and must be reviewed. The chief difficulty in devising a Triple-subject is, so to individualize each one of the three Themes that it constitutes by itself a wholly independ- ent and characteristic melody, especially in its rhythmic formation ; and that, furthermore, each one may serve equally well as Soprano, Bass, or inner part. Compare par. 57. Probably the best plan is to follow the principle of par. 61b (which review), i.e., to invent the Themes successively ; first, Theme A, in stately rhythm (preponderantly a and J - notes) ; then to add Theme B to this in more animated rhythm (J - notes), and then Theme C to these, in still another form of more active rhythm. This is, however, by no means imperative. Illustrations of the Triple-subject : Ex. ISO. f n Th. A . I 1 _J. J 1 1 I tr ^ ! Th. B. '" ' (^ *Bfc ^ Th. C. 2. Th. A. Bach. n J3 •& Beethoven. *2) j E*i> — f ^MmMs&M^ P^l r- p-m-0-m-\ m Th. C. jtZtr- £= tP p?=q=f^ W~x~ 7— o-t-F ^-*±£ -3-3- m Th. B, ■fe±£ rfcP m Par. 181. THE TRIPLE-FUGUE. 283 Brahms. Th. B. =n=p: ■e-t-m- I m &m fl* Th. C. 4. Th. C. --^-U r=^ Brahms. ee ^gg^Ss^P^ i?= =fe gl _p=jr CH= =* Th. B." §3E i— p fc-I IPh* Th. A. *i) Themes A and B end here, while Theme C runs on a few beats. In the other illustrations it will be seen that the 3 Themes usually' close exactly, or nearly, together. But observe that they do not begin together. *2) From the String-quartet, op. 18, No. 4, second movement, meas. 64-68 from the Double-bar. See also Bach, 3-voice Invention No. 9, meas. 3-4. Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. I, Prelude 19, first 2 \ measures. — Vol. I, Fugue 4, meas. 51-54 (Tenor, Bass, Soprano). — Vol. I, Fugue 21, meas. 9-12. 181. The Inversion of a Triple-counterpoint yields a fivefold result (or 6 forms in all), thus : c Theme A, ( A, B, B, C, C Original cpt, ) Theme B, Inversions, 1 C, A, C, A, B B, C, A, B, a. As in Double-cpt., it is generally a foregone conclusion that the 8ve-in versions will all be possible (par. 56), though some embarrass- ment, with regard to register, may be encountered ; and it may be neces- sary at times both to cross the parts and to allow them to diverge widely. b. On account of the multiplied complications, only the Natural species (8ve-inversion) need claim attention. The Artificial species are exceedingly difficult to obtain, though sometimes one or another of 284 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 182. the devices shown in par. 173 and par. 177 may be ferreted out by patient and exhaustive experiment. i n Bach. N.B. A. * 2 ) HS^iS l-Jx*-t- — j -• * I I W QJ_ 4=r B. *i) Each Theme starts with the letter a 4th above the original first tone, Theme A being transferred to a lower, B and C to a higher register. — *2) Each Theme in the 7th of the original counterpoint, excepting the first tone of Theme B. The counter- point is therefore in each case Natural Species. See Beethoven, Pfte. Sonata, op. 2, No. 3, Finale, meas. 55-62 ; very simple. 182. The Triple-fugue, like the Double, may also be divided into three Species. In the First Species, all 3 Subjects are announced together at the outset* and the order of voices during the Exposition is to be defined strictly according to par. 167a; that is, each Theme passes from part to part in the established order (par. 123), independently of the others — common sense being employed to avoid collisions. For example (4- voice) : • , C*i). . A. . C , B . . A. B. Sop., Th.A. .C .B A Alto,Th..B . .A. .C B Ten., Th.C. .B. .A. Bass, C. .B. .A C B A C, B c or B . A. . C. . A. . B . C A C . . B. • • ■ ■ . A etc. *i) Theme C in Soprano following C in Bass. This is not passing to the " next higher or lower voice," it is true ; but it is equivalent, because these are not parallel voices. Irregular Expositions are not uncommon. See also par. 167^, Par. 183. THE TRIPLE-FUGUE. 285 Analyze, thoroughly, Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. I, Prelude 19; 3-voice; the first tone in Bass is auxiliary; the Triple-subject is 2 \ measures long; the design is 3-Part Song-form; Part I is a regular Exposition, to meas. 12 ; Part II (meas. 12-17) begins with the original counterpoint; Part III (end of meas. 17) contains two announce- ments. Beethoven, String-quartet, op. 18, No. 4, second movement, measures 64 to 81 from the Double-bar ; original counterpoint given in Ex. 1 80, No. 2 ; a complete Exposition, 4 announcements. 183. In the Second Species, Themes A and B begin together, and Theme C follows immediately (usually in one of the same voices). See Bach, 3-voice Invention No. 9 ; Theme A in inner, B in lower part ; the first Bass note is auxiliary ; in meas. 3, Theme A appears in the upper, B in the inner, and C is added to these in the lower voice ; the form is sectional ; analyze thor- oughly. — Bach, Org. Comp., Vol. I, " Passacaglia," Finale; 4-voice, sectional (quasi 3-Part form) ; Exposition to meas. 29, with brief cadence in meas. 21, contains 5 announcements, in order that each part may exhibit all three Themes ; Theme C occasionally modified at its end. — In Vol. II, Fugue 4, there are many passages in Triple-cpt., and even some evidences of Triple-fugue design. — Vol. VIII, No. 12; 4-voice; sectional; somewhat irregular. — Beethoven, 3rd Symphony, Adagio, meas- ures 10-29 from second change of signature (i.e., back to 3 flats); Theme A in half- notes, and B in quarters and eighths, together in Viola and 2nd Violin ; followed immediately by Theme C, i6th-notes, in 2nd Violin; a complete Exposition, 5 announcements. A sub-variety of the Second Species is illustrated in Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. I, Fugue 21 ; the 3 Subjects enter successively (in closer analogy to the 2nd Species of the Double- fugue) ; 3-voice; sectional; Theme C, meas. 9-12, in upper part, is very fragmentary, but thoroughly characteristic and persistently retained (with slight modifications). Also Brahms, Fugue with Chorale (O Traurigkeit) for organ, in a minor ; cho- rale in pedal-bass ; Theme A derived from first Line of chorale ; per moto contrario throughout (par. 158) ; orig. cpt. given in Ex. 180, No. 4. 184. In the Third Species, Theme A is manipulated alone during the whole Exposition, or Part I ; thereafter, several different designs are possible and equally legitimate. For example, — among many possible arrangements, in successive Sections (or Parts) : Theme A alone. B alone, or A and B together. C alone, or A and C together, or B and C together. A, B, and C together. Analyze diligently Bach, Well-temp. CI., Vol. I, Fugue 4; 5-voice, Two-Part form; Theme A alone in Part I (to meas. 35); Theme B begins with Part II, in 286 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 184. Soprano, as counterpoint to Theme A in Tenor ; after one other announcement of A and B (meas. 44), Theme C joins them, in meas. 49, Tenor; the 3 Themes are then developed pretty steadily together to meas. 81-84, whereupon Theme B gradually withdraws entirely, leaving the rest of the Fugue to A and C ; these, in meas. 94, begin a series of extremely powerful stretto-announcements together, extending nearly to the end. — Vol. II, Fugue 14; 3-voice, Two-Part form; Theme A alone in Part I (to meas. 20) ; Theme B then follows, in Bass, slightly modified at its end, and is manipulated alone, in somewhat abbreviated stretti, to meas. 28 ; at the end of meas. 28 Theme A appears (inner voice), Theme B following in Bass two measures later ; in meas. 36 Theme C enters (inner voice, i6th-notes), and is developed alone to meas. 51 ; after one announcement of A alone (meas. 52-54, inner voice), the 3 Themes are combined (A at end of meas. 54 with disguised beginning, upper voice, — C in next measure, Bass, — B in meas. 56, inner voice), and remain together to the end. Bach, "The Art of Fugue," Fugue 8; 3-voice, sectional; design as follows (Themes named A, B, and C, in the order of their appearance — C being the princi- pal Subject) : Sections I and II, Theme A alone ; Sec. Ill (meas. 39) and IV, Themes A and B ; Sec. V (meas. 94), Theme C ; Sec. VI, (meas. 125), Themes A and B ; Sec. VII (meas. 147), Themes A, B, and C. Compare carefully with same work, Fugue n. The latter uses the same Themes as No. 8, but begins with the principal Theme ; further, the Themes are all in the Contrary motion of the former. It is much longer and more elaborate, introducing a characteristic chromatic counterpoint (to one of the secondary Themes) which is retained and much used, — almost as 4th Theme (meas. 28-29), though all four do not appear anywhere together, thus escaping the design of a Quadruple-Fugue (par. 185). The design is as follows (Themes named as in No. 8) : Sec. I, Theme C ; Sec. II (meas. 27), Theme A, with thematic counterpoint " D " ; Sec. Ill (meas. 71), Theme C in Contrary motion; Sees. IV (meas. 89) and V, Themes A and B (also two isolated announcements of C) ; Sec. VI (meas. 146), Themes A, B, and C to the end. — Same work, Fugue 15; the 3 Themes are strikingly contrasted in rhythm and character (the third one based upon the notes " b-a-c-h ") . This Fugue was interrupted by the master's death, after the Exposition of the 3rd Theme, and before all three Subjects were united. — Bach, Org. Comp., Vol. VI, No. 31 ; chorale as Fugue-group (par. 155) ; 4-voice; cantus firmus in Bass ; new Theme for each Line ; Double-cpt. during first Line ; Triple-cpt. in all following Lines. — Thiele, Fugue (with chromatic Fantasia) for organ; 4- voice ; Theme A alone, then A and B together, and then all three. — Brahms, Fugue in a b minor for the organ ; 4-voice ; sectional ; Thematic Counterpoint in first Sections ; stretti, augmentation, diminution, and shifted rhythm in final section ; all per moto contrario. A superb masterpiece, worthy of most diligent analysis. Quadruple and Quintuple Counterpoint. 185. The invention and employment of a complex of more than three Subjects, for the Fugue-form, is so difficult and of so little prac- tical effectiveness as to be naturally very rare ; and even for technical discipline it is of but limited value. Par. 185. QUADRUPLE-CO UNTERPOINT. 287 Brief examples of good 4- or 5 -voice counterpoint with well-con- trasted, independent parts, may be introduced episodically in the course of a Fugue, and reproduced in inverted forms (in 8ve-cpt. only) with good results. A brilliant specimen of Quintuple-cpt. may be found in Mozart, Symphony in C major (sometimes called the " Jupiter" symphony), Finale. The complex of 5 Subjects, which first appears in meas. 40 from the end, is as follows (in the orchestral String-quintet) : Ex. 182. i Allegro molto. Th. A. V^El Wl w§= m Th. B. t=£ £ :*=* -#— • Th. C. -1=- Th. D. _,_. _,_ _» -tr- £' ftfit.* ffi g *t±* -#Tg- y=H=0 Th. E. -S>- 33 ^f#-=^ (<5Va bass a) This is followed by a complete Exposition, 5 announcements in all, up to meas. 22 from the end. But this is not all ; the entire Finale is, in fact, a Quintuple-Fugue of the 3rd Species, molded in the form of the " Sonata-Allegro," and so designed that nearly all of the Subjects appear successively, and are manipulated, alone or together, in stretti, contrary motion, diminution, and even retrograde imitation, before their ultimate conjunction in the final Coda. Analyze thoroughly, from the orches- tral score. In conclusion, the student is recommended to analyze the 48 Fugues of A. A. Klengel (" Canons and Fugues in all the keys " ; 2 vols., Breitkopf & Hartel ed.). This distinguished and interesting work, to which frequent reference will be made in the next Division, has been intentionally omitted in the preceding pages, in order to provide opportunity for an extended course of independent analysis. The Fugues are almost exclusively " Single " ; Contrary motion, Stretti, Augmentation, and Dimi- 288 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 186. nution abound, and even Retrograde Imitation occurs in one instance (in the unique 2-voice Fugue, Vol. I, No. 16). EXERCISE 52. A. Invent a number of Triple-subjects, in various styles, and write out all five 8ve-inversions of each. B. Two brief Triple-fugues, or Fughettas, one in the First, vhe other in the Second Species, major and minor. C. Two or three complete Triple-fugues, Third Species. D. A few experiments in Quadruple- and Quintuple-counterpoint, with Inver- sions (as explained in pars. 180-181). DIVISION V. THE CANON. 186. The Canon-forms differ from the foregoing classes of poly- phonic composition in two respects : (1) The Imitation is entirely, or nearly, strict (par. 26) ; and (2) it is continuous ; that is, not limited, as in the Fugue, to the Subject alone, but extended to include all that follows in the same voice, to the end of the Section, or Part, or entire composition. 187. a. The part which begins, or leads the canonic progression, is called the Leader (propositi) ; the following or imitating part is called the Follower, or responding part (risposta). b. The principal distinction between canonic species (among many) is defined, precisely like the stretto, according to the distance of the Fol- lower from the Leader in time, and in melodic interval ; for instance, " Canon in the 8ve (or 2nd, 3rd, etc.) after one measure (or two, or more)." c. Another important distinction is made between the Unaccom- panied (or Independent) and Accompanied Canon ; and further, be- tween the Round and the Progressive Canon. Other traditional distinctions will either be defined in the following pages, or will be intentionally omitted because of their doubtful utility ; for the latter the curious student may consult Dr. Baker's " Dictionary of Musical Terms," or Grove's " Dictionary." Par. 188. THE ROUND-CANON. 289 CHAPTER XVII. The Round, or Round-Canon. 188. The simplest and most venerable application of the principle of Continuous Imitation is made in the so-called Round-canon. This is usually written for at least three, sometimes four, but seldom more, weal parts, and is nearly always a Canon in unison (or 8ve) Imitation. The Leader begins with a distinctly lyric (melodious) Phrase, commonly 4 measures long, with a fairly definite semi-cadence ; more rarely it is a 2-measure member, or a Period (8-measure, or irregular) with the usual two cadences. Thereupon the first Follower reproduces (or imitates) this leading phrase, while the Leader continues with a counterpoint, similar in character but melodically well contrasted (see par. 35a, and par. 165, Rules 1, 2, 3), if possible with a modulation, to avoid monotony. After the leading phrase is thus again finished, the second Follower enters and announces it, while the first Follower con- tinues with the preceding " counterpoint," and the Leader adds a new contrapuntal phrase to these, again well-contrasted. At this juncture the original counterpoint (in a 3-voice Round) is complete, and repre- sents a Triple-subject, exactly as in par. 180, but with less rhythmic diversity, and so contrived that the 3 parts (A, B, and C) constitute a continuous melody in phrase-group form, and returning to the beginning (whence the designation " Round "). What follows, as the voices continue their rotatory Imitation, or fol- lowing, of the Leader, is simply Inversion of the voices, and presents nothing new, — in the unison-canon not even the effect of Inversion ; therefore the Imitation is generally extended only until the last Follower has finished the entire phrase-group, whereupon a free cadence, of any length, is added, to terminate the Canon. If a low voice (Alto or Tenor) is used in company with two high ones, or if, in any way, the Triple-subject is so devised as to embrace different registers, the 8ve- Imitation may also be employed ; and in that case the effect of Inversion will be secured, subject to the usual tests (par. 1810). For a 4-voice Round the process is the same, but the desirability of 8ve-Imitation, in company with the unison, is greater ; hence, parallel voices are likely to be chosen (2 Sopranos and 2 Tenors, or Altos and 290 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 188. Basses). The text must be so chosen as to cover either the leading phrase only, or exactly the entire group of 3 (or 4) phrases. For illustration (3-voice Round-canon) : I? Leader. ££ Ex. 183, SBEBE5Z : ? oz f : dfatEt Dif fi - ci - le lee - tu mi - hi mars et jo - ni - cu jo - ni- i pg&£ m i S333 -*.*| g *- cu dif-fi - ci I le, lectulec-tu (etc.) 1st Follower. w ^E3E ^=t s> <*- ^=*t Dif-fi - ci-le ^m=m =f^^=s; * r**-*-+ EfeSE fH^ -• — g-»l- =5R^f :t± 2nd Follower. -=)- -r-5- Dif - fi ci-le I Mozart. II =P=P=T w^^n ^- d- m -d- ^ N-si— s< ■U-P- Dif &£ ]=F£^ I&jfc* 1 :*±=bfc* -»3t3t -* *~ *3> *4) &=t P^=PC *-w — r -*— ^ -g>- -•^-•-tsf- etc. *5> *i) From here to Note *2) appears the union of the three voices, or the "Triple-subject" which constitutes the body of the entire Canon. — *2) Here the Par. 188. THE ROUND-CANON: 29I Leader ends the canonic melody, and returns to the beginning. — *3) The 1st Fol- lower continues with the third Period (that of the Leader at Note *i) . — *4) The 2nd Follower continues with the 2nd Period (meas. 8). — *5) In the Original, the 3 voices continue thus together for 14 measures, or until the 2nd Follower has finished the canonic melody. The student is to write out these measures, and, if possible, have the whole Round sung. _ It is evident that the single canonic melody — the upper staff alone up to Note *2) — is all that need be written in order to indicate the contents of the whole. The 3 singers may all read from this single staff, but beginning successively, at each new Period, and continuing as long as desired. Or, it is also possible to write out the Round in score, precisely as shown from Note *i) to *■£). In that case each singer begins with the lowermost staff, passes successively to the next 'higher, and finally around to the lowermost again, and so on. This method is illustrated in the fol- lowing : 3rd Follower. Mozart. Ex. 184. Begin- ning. fegJ3l 3Ej^ ^ft TOz Efr5g -.J&,.- ve, a - ve Ma-ri - a, a 2nd Follower. I £$E ^FE -*-r ^? ii A ve Maria, 1st Follower. Ma-ri a, a - P<- n =8* m m* ve Ma - ri - a. J 6 3.(1 61' to " 3rd Foil." to "2nd Foil." to ' 1st Foil.' ve Ma - ri - a, a ve Ma - ri - a. Write out this Round in its complete form, beginning as in Ex. 183, and continu- ing until the 3rd Follower has completed the canonic melody. Mozart made no provision for a perfect cadence (Tonic); the Round is therefore "endless." Such provision could, however, easily be made by adding a free codetta of one (or more) measures, when, as here, the Canon is written in score. Or a stopping-place may be indicated, either for each part successively, or for all together, by the n\ sign. These examples are both taken from the Breitkopf & Hartel ed. of Mozart's complete works (Serie 7, Nos. 41 to 61). See further, from the same, No. 46 ; Round for 3 voices, unison ; Follower be- gins after 10 measures (irreg. Period-form); ends with perfect cadence. — No. 47 ; 3-voice, unison, after 14 measures (Group of 3 phrases, extended) ; perfect cadence. — No. 52 ; Round for 4 voices, unison, after 6 measures ; the Canon is " endless," but provision is made for a cadence. — No. 45; 4-voice, unison, after 8 measures; no 2g2 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 189. cadence. — No. 55 ; 4-voice, unison, after 4 measures ; " endless," but a stopping-place is marked. — No. 56 ; 4-voice, unison, after 3 long measures ; no cadence. — No. 57 ; 4-voice, unison, after 6 measures ; no cadence. — No. 59 ; 4-voice, unison, after 8 measures; no cadence. — No. 60; 4-voice, unison, after 4 measures; "endless," but cadence provided for. — No. 44, Round for 6 voices; all unison, after 4 measures ; no cadence. — No. 48 ; 6-voice, first Follower in unison, the other four in lower 8ve ; after 2 measures; no cadence.. — Brahms, Round-canons, op. 113, No. 1; 4-voice, unison, after 4 measures ; cadence provided for. — No. 2 ; 3-voice, unison, after 7 measures. — No. 3. — No. 4. — No. 5. — No. 7 ; 3-voice, unison, after 10 measures. — No. 10. — No. 11. — No. 12. — No. 13; 6-voice, in the following unique disposition: 4-voice Canon in upper parts, unison, after 9 measures ; and, as accompaniment, 2-voice Canon in lower parts (8ve, after one measure). Many other examples of the Round, both classic and popular, may be found in various collections of vocal music for instructive or social purposes. 189. Closely allied to the Round, but inclining toward the structure of the Progressive Canon, is a form of very pronounced Lyric character, in which (as a rule) there is no return to the beginning, and conse- quently no such rotation of parts as in the Round. The leading sen- tence is often of considerable length — 8, 12, or even 16 measures, in very definite Period, or Double-period, form ; the number of voices is usually 3 (sometimes 4) ; and the form generally extends no farther than through the announcement of the leading sentence by the last Fol- lower. A simple harmonic accompaniment is added (par. 2011/). Probably the most masterly example of this form is the famous mixed quartet in Beethoven's " Fidelio " (No. 3, in the First Act). The leading sentence is a regu- lar Period of 8 measures ; this, and the succeeding canonic counterpoints, are imi- tated in the usual manner by the Followers (in the unison by the other female part, and lower 8ve by the two male voices), until the last Follower has finished the original leading Period, whereupon a free homophonic coda of 12 measures is appended. The rhythm of the accompaniment is gradually accelerated from quar- ters and 8th-notes to i6th-triplets. Rossini, " Semiramide," Act I, No. 3, Quartet, second division, Di tanti Regi ; 3-voice, auxiliary 4th voice during last announcement ; independent Coda. A beauti- ful example. Rossini, " Moses in Egypt," Act III, Finale, Quartet, Je tremble et soupire ; 4- voice ; slightly irregular near end. Also Act II, No. 8, Quintet, O toi dont la climence; 5-voice ; transposed announcements of leading Period ; irregular ; independent Coda. Of similar design is the Quartet, Urbs Syon inclyta, from " Hora novissima " (H. W. Parker), No. 11, already cited among the vocal Fugues. Mozart, No. 61 of the above volume, is an example of this kind, as far as lyric style is concerned ; but the imitation is extended to the characteristic rotation of the Round (cadence indicated by /rv ), and there is no accompaniment. It is 3-voice, unison, after 11 measures (extended Period). Par. 190. THE PROGRESSIVE CANON. 293 EXERCISE 53. A. Write two or more examples of the Round for 3 voices, in unison, unaccom- panied ; " endless," but with provision for a cadence. B. One or two Rounds for 4 voices, in unison and 8ve, with Coda. C. One or more Lyric canons for 3 voices (unison and 8ve), accompanied, with Coda, according to par. 189. CHAPTER XVIII. The Progressive Canon. 190. In the Progressive Canon the same principle of strict continu- ous imitation prevails ; but any other interval (or species) of imitation may be used quite as well as the octave ; and the time-interval is gen- erally much shorter, — i.e., the risposta follows the proposta, or Leader, earlier than in the Round; and, finally, there is less distinctness or regularity of form, and no such characteristic recurrence of the leading sentence, — excepting the distinctive return to the beginning necessary when the 3-Part Song-form is chosen, or when Part I is to be repeated. The Two- Voice Canon, Unaccompanied. 191. In the 8ve. Either part may be chosen as Leader. A simple melodic motive is devised, very similar in contents and character to the Motive of an Invention or a short Fugue-subject, but without cadence. Its length depends upon the time-interval between Leader and Follower. This is most commonly one measure, sometimes two measures, or one- half measure in any compound rhythm ; more rarely one beat, or any other uneven fraction of a measure, for it is desirable that the prosodic effect of Leader and Follower (disposition of accents) should agree. This leading motive is then imitated in the other voice, either an 8ve higher or lower, while the Leader proceeds with a contrapuntal associate devised in strict conformity to the rules in par. j^a, which review. The Follower imitates this Counterpoint, while the Leader again pro- ceeds with a new one, — and so on, to the end of the Canon. If, for instance, the time-interval is one measure, the contents of every (or any) measure in the Leader will be literally reproduced in each following measure in the Follower ; — though a duet, the contents of one voice alone will represent the entire melodic material of the composition. For illustration : 294 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 192. Ex. 185.< i j± Allegro. q fttf— — - Follower (in upper 8ve, after one 3^3 3S m-^-u — ■ — a Leader. Leading M. - Mii ^ ■*—+- t=x iM #- -m-' ^=f S^ Leading motive : — 1st Counterpoint : — - measure) . Clementi. gJtjfrEggS 2nd Counterpoint : — 192. There are two characteristic difficulties persistently present in the constructive process of an unaccompanied Canon in the 8ve, namely : a. The difficulty of avoiding monotony. The 1 st counterpoint is, presumably, a peculiarly fitting associate of the leading Motive. When it reappears in the Follower (3rd measure of the above example) it is necessary to devise an equally good, but new, associate, as 2nd counterpoint, whereby the natural temptation to fall back upon the leading M. must be resisted. In other words, constant care must be taken to use new contrapuntal intervals in successive measures ; also intervals occasionally foreign to the key, in order to effect necessary modulations. But no liberties are to be taken with the Follower ; in the 8ve-canon the imitation is absolutely strict. It is also necessary to avoid monotony of rhythm and monotony of register. All of these considerations are skilfully observed in the following : Leader. Follower (in lower double-8ve, after one measure.) Par. 192b. UNACCOMPANIED CANON. 295 _n» (ti. OSS "^" l l-TTI ,— ILEMENTI. etc. *i) The last beat of this measure was harmonized, in the Leader (preceding measure), with b, d, and dt ; here a totally new result is obtained by using fQ, This, and the persistent evasion of the distinctive Mediant c (in this whole measure of the Leader), prepares for the unique modulation (or change of mode) into a minor, at Note *2). — *3) The diversity of register during these 5 measures is noteworthy; from the high e of the Leader to this low e a range of 4 octaves is covered. — *4) Diversity of rhythm is here effected and sustained by the heavy syncopated forma- tion of the Leader. b. The difficulty of obtaining intelligible form. The student will soon discover how galling the constraint of persistent strict imitation is; every desirable melodic aim is hampered, apparently to *. fatalistic degree ; and this is especially palpable at the cadences, or at any other point in the structural design where it is necessary to conduct the Leader in a certain definite direction. The dogged pursuit of the Follower is in itself a circumstance that mili- tates against clear cadential effects, because the Leader can perform no act alone. At the same time, it is absolutely necessary (particularly at the beginning, and from time to time in later sections) to preserve, at least approximately, the effect of regular Phrase- and Period-formation ; to provide for a firm cadential separation at the end of the First Part ; and, in case a repetition of Part I is required, or when the 3-Part form is used, to lead the voices back to the beginning. The best device for such recognizable (if not strictly regular) syntactic forma- tions is a judicious use of Rests in the Leader. The rests should not be so brief as to appear breathless, or so long as to sever the continuity of the sentence (excepting at strong cadences, where a whole-measure rest may be used) ; nor should the rests be so frequent as to defeat their own purpose. In a word, it is mainly necessary to impart to the Leader a good and intelligible melodic and syntactic form — as far, and as continuously, as is possible under the canonic constraint. The Follower may then be left to take care of itself, as far as the "form" is concerned. For this reason, also, it is wise to introduce from time to time some striking melodic or rhythmic figure in the Leader ; not only because these contribute to the intelligibility of the form, but because they emphasize the relation of the Follower to the Leader, i.e., render the canonic imitation, as such, more recognizable. But see par. 202. The "formation" is very distinct in the following: Allegro. .^- Ex. 187, t^d^^^^ fe^ &&&W ig6 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 192a "M&f r t \ ^ later: * 4 ) ^ £ ^ ^ f 4) In the 2nd, below. ri i w * 2 ) GOETSCHIUS. fftre mm& mm'W 1 *i) This rest defines the syntactic arrangement of the phrase in two 2-measure members. *2) Here a definite semi-cadence is made on the Dominant of the leading key. •3) It is often necessary, and always permissible, to cross the parts, as here. *4) The first 2nd is minor, the next major. See Bach, Air with 30 Variations for clavichord, Var. 27, Part I. Other examples will be given among the Accompanied Canons. 194. In the 7th. This is the counterpart of the Canon in the 2nd, and exhibits precisely the same peculiarities, merely reversed. For example : Par. 195. UNACCOMPANIED CANON. 299 Ex. 190. tpE^^fe -3 =1 =1 =1- " rrrmTrrf j: I ±t^ V-i ■•- * I I tt Bach. :J=«!=t== =& 1 w -=l — q- -=l — =1- BrrFfTfg TT bt: •t etc. 195. In the 3rd. This interval is somewhat easier to manage than the 2nd, though the same difficulties exist, and similar remedies are necessary (par. 193 a and U). The same applies to its counterpart, the Canon in the 6th. For illustration : a. In the 3rd ( or 10th) . Ex. 191. *i) tr Pb3= mm i Andante. mm ttSEEtE^ tr *± &=$ SE ^s^ggg f fc£ eS KLENGEL.*2) =P=i=i«: P-F- ^ a*-*- a Cad. etc. aa^ p^i ^-» i:tP: 5fe£±*: b. In the ,6th. w IE =^sf t^^fe £^- *->—*- h A llegro. I=t^ 252E =f=*= 30o APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 196. GOETSCHIUS. ifcj M g5g fe&^=^ ffi=^|* I *i) At the end of Part I (meas. 27) the Leader is conducted back to the begin- ning, and the Part is then repeated, with 1st and 2nd ending. — *2) From "48 Canons and Fugues," Vol. II, Canon 18. Analyze carefully. — See also Bach, "Art of Fugue," Canon III ; in 10th, — with Artificial Double-cpt. in 10th. 196. In the 5th, and its counterpart, in the 4th. For illustration : Ex. 192. ti In the 5th. m P'^a^y 1 ^gfr^rr^ -0-^-0- »f •? * Klencel. *i) \k±k J"3 . J^jgg j; *i) " 48 Canons and Fugues," Vol. I, Canon 19. Analyze to the end. See also Vol. II, Canon 3 (in 5th, after 2 measures). Bach, " Art of Fugue," Canon IV ; in the 5th, with Double-cpt. in the 12th. For an example of the Canon in the 4th, see Klengel, Vol. II, Canon 6; after 4 measures. EXERCISE 54. A. Two examples (major and minor, different time and tempo) of the Unac- companied 2-voice Canon in the 8ve. Review par. 192 a, i, c, d. B. Examples of' the Unaccompanied 2-voice Canon in the 5th, 4th, 3d, 6th, 2nd, and 7th. Either write one brief example of each ; or a continuous example in sec- tional form, with a different interval in each section. Some experiments must, however, be made in 2- or 3-Part Song-form, with repetition of Part I.' Other Species. 197. The Canon in Contrary motion. Here the choice of " corre- sponding tones " is of great importance. Review par. 29a thoroughly. Par. 197. UNACCOMPANIED CANON. 301 As there demonstrated, the best results are obtained either by answer- ing Tonic by Mediant, or Tonic by Dominant. All other conditions correspond to those of the above species. See, particularly, pars. 192^ and 193a. For illustration : Ex. 193. Allegretto. E4: m =t »i) * tf S3 J3_ ) etc. *i) *i) The Tonic e in the Leader is answered by £•(, the Mediant, in the Fol- lower, throughout ; and vice versa — the Mediant by the Tonic (g% everywhere by e). *2) "Gradus ad Parnassum," Schirmer ed. No. 66 (orig. No. 73). Analyze to the end. It is " endless," but with an added cadence. See also, same work, No. 63 (orig. No. 10) ; exactly the same ; Tonic=Mediant, after 1 measure, " endless," but with cadence. Klengel, Vol. II, Canon 20; Tonic = Dominant, after 2 measures. Brahms, Handel-Variations, op. 24, Var. 6; Fart I, parallel 8ve-Canon, after • 1 beat; Part II, Contrary motion; Part III, again parallel. 198. Canon in Augmentation. The two parts generally begin to- gether or nearly so, usually in the 8ve ; and the Augmentation con- stantly widens the distance between Leader and Follower, so that it is of course impossible to imitate the entire Leader. Usually, therefore, the second half of the leading voice is a free counterpoint to the por- tion of the Follower still due ; but many devices, such as exchanging the parts, or substituting Diminution after a while, may be resorted to. For example : Allegro vivace. — — ■ ,~ Goetschius. Ex. 194. g^i^sHii^fe etc. She 1 ^ 8ve, in Augmentation. 302 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 199. Bach, Art of Fugue," Canon I ; Augmentation and Contrary motion. 199. In Diminution. Here the distance between the parts is con- stantly decreased, so that the Follower overtakes the Leader after the first time-interval has been exactly doubled. Thereafter the calculation is reversed, and the imitation becomes " Augmentation." For example : Allegretto. *,) GOETSCHIUS. i -«— *- ±=*= t ±&z =f* :etc. ■**■ =i=?t T f T In Augmentation. *i ) The parallel octaves at the confluence of the parts are of course inevitable. From here on, the upper part is, practically, the Leader. EXERCISE 55. A. Two examples (major and minor) of the 2-voice Canon in Contrary motion. B. One example, each, of the Canon in Augmentation and Canon in Dimi- nution, (the latter beginning with time-interval of 4, 6, or 8 measures) . CHAPTER XIX. The Two-voice Canon, Accompanied. Instrumental. 200. This is by far the most practicable and valuable form of the Canon, because the added part (parte libera), or parts, disguise the con- straint of the canonic imitation, and may contribute very significantly to the beauty and effectiveness of the whole. Any of the above canonic Par. 2oi. ACCOMPANIED CANON. 303 species may be thus treated, but the most common is that in the 8ve, parallel, — more rarely contrary. 201. The auxiliary (accompanying) part may be placed above, be- low, or between the canonic voices, at option ; but much depends upon the degree of importance it assumes. a. It may be distinctly subordinate (unessential), serving no other purpose than that of emphasizing the rhythm ; or of supplementing the harmony where needed. For example : Allegro assai. Klengel. *i) Auxiliary. *i) Vol. II, Canon 16; 8ve, after one beat. Analyze to end. Schumann, Studies for Pedal-piano, op. 56, No. 1 ; 8ve, after \ measure ; auxiliary Bass. b. Or the auxiliary part may be coordinate with the canonic parts. In this case it may be a carefully conducted running voice (comp. par. 73#) ; or it may borrow its melodic and rhythmic figures from the Canon itself. For example : 1. Andante caritabile. Klengel. *i) Ex. 197. i Pzz« "^^=^ $33$ xtat Follower ( in unison.) etc. Auxiliary, running part. 2. Allegretto. Leader. fees: Klengel. *3) s :ifi *-#* ziL-2 tfc V? *-±- Auxiliary. '4 1 1 \-m 1 — 1 l-m G— - m* W-mM-M — I m etc. r*Tib t*=# -•^+4- m Bizfc|i2= =lzOfir w p ■ v Follower. *2) 3°4 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 201b. *i) Vol. I, Canon 18. Analyze. *2) In Contrary motion, Tonic = Tonic (comp. par. 197). *3) Vol. II, Canon 12. Analyze to end, and see also — Klengel, Vol. I, Canon 8 ; Contrary motion (Dominant = Tonic), after one measure ; auxiliary upper part, beginning in 3rd measure. — Vol. I, Canon 1 1 ; unison, after 2 beats ; auxiliary Bass. — Vol. I, Canon 16 ; Contrary motion (Tonic = Tonic), after one measure ; auxiliary Soprano, beginning in 2nd measure. — Vol. I, Canon 17; in the 2nd, after one measure; auxiliary Soprano, beginning in 8th measure. — Vol. II, Canon I; 8ve, after one measure; inner part a running auxiliary. — Vol. II, Fugue 6, middle Division ; unison, after one measure, during Part I ; running aux- iliary Bass ; in Part II the canonic voices appear in fairly exact contrary direction ; Part III as before. — Vol. II, Canon 10; Double-8ve, after 2 measures; inner part auxiliary. — Vol. II, Canon 13 ; 8ve, after 2 measures; auxiliary Bass, beginning 2 measures before canonic parts. — Vol. II, Canon 15; 5th, after ^ measure; auxiliary Bass. — Vol. II, Canon 21 ; 5th, after one measure; auxiliary Bass. Bach, Air with 30 Variations, Var. 3 (unison, after one measure, auxiliary Bass). Var. 6 (in 2nd, after one measure, auxiliary Bass ; beautiful example). Var. 9 (in 6th, after one. measure, auxiliary Bass). Var. 12 (Contrary motion, Tonic =Domi- nant, after one measure, Bass partly coordinate). Var. 15 (ditto; Bass coordinate). Var. 18 (in 6th, after J measure, auxiliary Bass ; fine example). Var. 21 (in 7th, after \ measure, auxiliary Bass). Var. 24 (in 8ve, after 2 measures, auxiliary Bass). Klengel, Vol. I, Canon 22, is in Augmentation, later Diminution (in 8ve), with auxiliary Bass ; the canonic parts begin on first beat ; the Augmentation, in inner part, extends to meas. 13 J; Imitation in uniform rhythm follows (6-measure time-interval) to meas. 25^ ; then Diminution to end of meas. 28 ; then again Augmentation to meas. 35 ; then uniform Imitation (after 3 measures) ; in meas. 40 the time-interval is short- ened to 2 measures ; the Coda, last 3 measures, is in Diminution. Sometimes two such coordinate parts accompany the 2-voice Canon. This is rare, however, excepting in the free harmonic manner shown in d below. See Klengel, Vol. II, Canon 8; in 8ve, after one measure, two inner auxiliary parts. — Chadwick, Canonic Studies for Organ, op. 12, Canon 2; in 8ve, after 2 measures ; two upper parts auxiliary. c. Or the auxiliary part may be so conducted as to appear, as far as external effect is concerned, to constitute the essential element, which the canonic parts merely serve to sustain. Here the danger of incoherent or unintelligible form is greatly reduced. For example : Allegro moderato. Ex. 198. 1 h&-Ei mm Auxiliary. §§si ± -&-*- Follower. i n Reader. r Par- 2oid. ACCOMPANIED CANON. 3°5 Klengel. *i) i|£i f^= g Sip^^^l » -j- -i j etc. i e: ^ f- f= *i) Vol. I, Canon 7 ; analyze to end, and see also — Vol. I, Canon 10 ; in 5th, after \ measure ; auxiliary upper part. — Vol. II, Canon 7 j in 2nd, after two beats in 3-4 time ; auxiliary Bass, beginning two measures before canonic parts. d. Finally, the accompaniment may assume a distinctly harmonic character, imparting a more or less preponderantly homophonic effect to the whole. It may be limited, as before, wholly (or largely) to one single auxiliary part, which exhibits the underlying harmony in broken-chord form (i.e., as harmonic figuration, in flowing rhythm). One of the canonic parts is almost certain to be given to the Soprano, the other to the inner voice, more rarely Bass. Thus : Andante. *i) Pfte. Variations, op. 9, Var. 14; Canon in the 2nd, after 2 measures. See also Var. 15; in 3rd, after one measure; auxiliary inner part. In both of these examples occasional, very slight, licences occur. — See further, Klengel, Vol. \\, 3o6 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 2oid. Canon 19; unison, after \ measure; auxiliary Bass. ■ — Vol. I, Canon 3; in the 4th, after 2 long measures ; auxiliary Bass. — Vol. I, Canon 5 ; in the 7th, after one brief measure ; auxiliary Bass, partly coordinate. Or, the auxiliary homophonic accompaniment may consist in con- crete harmonic bulk, with little (or no) regard to the number or conti- nuity of parts (i.e., variable volume). Here, again, one of the canonic parts is assigned to the Soprano, almost without exception ; the other may be placed in any lower part, but (unless in Bass) is frequently so confounded with the harmonic accompaniment as to be unrecognizable as a "canon." See par. 202. For example: Follower. Ex. 200. 1. Molto espresswo. 52z IE& Leader. „ ± ESfe -«— 4- 4U--S5 & Baa-;— ;-i-s-i- ~7 u. J- 1 rft m •^ Schumann. *i) \ $ m 1 g^g g? t5 i^ ^^^ A,— g ; £ T 2. Andante. »^#P| Brahms. *3> m M agi^E^i a— I r a — ^ ' Fi *i) Pedal-piano Studies, op. 56, No. 2 ; Canon in unison, after one measure. Analyze ; and see same work, No. 3 ; in 4th, after J measure ; Prelude and Posthide added. — No. 5, in 8ve, after one measure; auxiliary accompaniment in inner parts and Bass; exquisite example. *2) The Leader is in the Soprano ; the Follower (8ve) in lower voice, in this broken form, throughout ; an auxiliary Bass is added later. *3) Pfte. Variations, op. 9, Var. 8 ; analyze carefully. See also Ex. 201. Par. 202. ACCOMPANIED CANON. 307 202. In order to appreciate the significance of the Canon-form, it should be contemplated in the abstract, aside from its uninviting mathematical aspect. As has been observed, each successive time-interval (one measure, or whatever section it may be) of the Leader is a counterpoint to the preceding section; that is, each such member is a product of the preceding one, through the strictest and most obvious process of logical derivation, or cumulation. The fact that the leading voice may thus accompany itself, may fit into itself, member by member, indicates a degree of cohesion and consistency of evolution which vindicates the rank of the Canon among those art-forms whose merit is founded upon close logic. This being the case, it is evident that the essential properties of the form are all present in the Leader alone, whether actually accompanied by the Follower or not ; and though it might be injudicious ever to advocate the complete omission of the Follower,* it is interesting to question to what extent the presence of the Follower should be em- phasized, — in other words, to what degree the canonic imitation should be made clearly recognizable. It is generally acknowledged that the merit of a Canon in- creases as the evidences of canonic labor decrease ; that the more freely and naturally the leading voice runs, the more perfect the Canon ; the less it betrays of its contra- puntal origin, the dry mathematical fact that one part is obstinately dogging the other, the better. Hence, the doctrine may be defensible, that a Canon need not be recognizable as such ; but with one limitation, namely, not incessantly recognizable. The beauty and attractiveness of the act of Imitation, the calling of voice to' voice, is so real, and so greatly appreciated by even the untutored musical listener, that it should not be banished from an art-form which, at its best, does not exhibit an excess of external beauty and grace. The proper balance between unimpassioned logic of structure on the one hand and romantic charm on the other, is most nearly achieved in the 8ve-Canon, with harmonic accompaniment, in which provision is made for clear formal arrangement, and for fairly frequent evidences of the canonic imitation. Review par. 192^. 203. When the last of the above varieties (par. 20id) is chosen, it is possible to mould the Canon in any of the Conventional styles of musical composition, as, for instance, the March, Minuet, Romanza, feude, etc., etc. This is very desirable, as it lends definiteness of character and purpose to the Canon, and invites a certain legitimate freedom of treatment without violating any distinctive canonic condition (par. 186). For example: 1. Minuet. Goetschius. Ex. 201. A— e- li — b_ J ^.4jJ-.jggfl~ ir ~i i L=Effz-.-V^g— r= f— Fip — „ -H * 3=i=3F £ fe£ .3 . 1 * This actually takes place in Jadassohn, Vocal Canon, op. 38, No. 1, during Div. I. 3o8 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 203. GOETSCHIUS. Additional miscellaneous illustrations : Schumann, Jugend-Album, op. 68, No. 27 (in the 8ve) ; 3-Part Song-form ; canonic voices exchanged in Part II. — Jugend-Sonata, op. 1 18, No. 2, second move- ment (8ve) ; 3-Part form, with all repetitions. — Albumbldtter, op. 124, No. 20 (Sve). Symph. Etudes, op. 13, Etude 4 (8ve). Guilmant, Org. Comp., op. 40, No. 3 (8ve). Grieg, Lyric Pieces, op. 38, No. 8 (8ve). Jadassohn, Pfte. Preludes and Fugues, op. 56; Prelude 2 (8ve). — Prel. 3 (8ve). — Prel. 6 and 8 (ditto). Moszkowski, op. 15, No. 4. Leschetizky, op. 36, No. 2 (Gigue) ; almost wholly unaccompanied. Raff, Friihlingshoten, op. 55, No. 10. Cesar Franck, Violin Sonata, A major, Finale ; Sonata-allegro form, the Prin- cipal Theme each time an 8ve-Canon, in different modes of treatment. G. W. Chadwick, Canonic Studies for Organ, op. 12; Nos. 1, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8; different intervals; all accompanied. EXERCISE 56. A. An example of the 2 -voice Canon, with subordinate auxiliary part (par. 2010). Any interval may be used. B. A 2-voice Canon with coordinate auxiliary part (par. 201*). Any interval, or Contrary motion. C. A 2-voice Canon with essential auxiliary part (par. 2oi«). D. A number of Canons with harmonic accompaniment (par. 20\d). For each, some conventional Style may be chosen (par. 203). The Two-voice Canon, Accompanied: Vocal. 204. Among the conventional styles, frequently chosen for the outer vestment of the Canon, none is more effective than the vocal duet, with instrumental accompaniment. Par. 204. ACCOMPANIED CANON. 309 The interval most commonly employed is the unison (when the voices are of similar register), or the octave (when parallel voices are used). But any interval is possible, and even Contrary motion is some- times encountered. The time-interval is apt to be brief, as in the instrumental Canons. The text is generally the same in both voices. The accompaniment is almost necessarily devoted, also, to an independent Prelude, occa- sional Interludes, and a Postlude ; and, in general, it may assume con- siderable importance and independence of character. Sometimes the canonic Imitation extends to the end, but it is more common to add a free ending (par. 192^). For illustrations see — Jadassohn, 9 Vocal Canons, op. 36. — 6 Vocal Canons, op. 38. Henschel, 3 Vocal Canons, op. 4. Mrs. H. H. A. Beach, Sea-Song for 2 Sopranos; in Part II the time-interval is enlarged ; in Part III the voices are exchanged. Haydn, 3rd (" Imperial ") Mass, Credo in unum Deum ; Leader in Soprano and Tenor in 8ve-duplication, Follower (after one measure in the 4th) in Alto and Bass ; although the complex thus embraces four voices, it is evidently only a 2-voice Canon Brahms, Motet, op. 29, No. II, 3rd movement (in 2nd, accomp.). EXERCISE 57. A number of examples of the 2-voice Canon as vocal duet, with instrumental accompaniment. CHAPTER XX. The Canon for More Than Two Parts. 205. The 3-voice Canon. This consists of a Leader and two Fol- lowers (similar to the 3-voice Round). In order to decrease the very great difficulties of this contrapuntal form, it is necessary, or at least customary, that the same melodic interval and time-interval should prevail between the first and second Follower, as preceded, between Leader and first Follower; in other words, that the contrapuntal relations between successive voices shall exactly correspond, thus ensuring at least this degree of continuous agreement. For instance, if the first Follower is in the.8ve, after one measure, the second Follower will also be in the 8ve, after one additional measure (or two measures from the 3io APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 205. beginning) ; or, if the first Follower is in the 5th, the second Follower will be in the next 5 th, or in the 2nd from the Leader ; if in the 4th, the second Follower will be in the 7th, and so on. Thus : in 5th. in 2nd. in 4th. in 7th. 1. Foil. . a m 1 Ex. 202. r-EE Leader. 1. Foil. -%h. J^ 4th. 4th. In any other than the 8ve-8ve species, the same modifications of interval quality (not affecting the letters) are necessary, for the sake of smooth harmonic and modu- latory succession, as were noted in par. 193*. The difficulty of obtaining intelligible form is greatly enhanced : but much may be accomplished by wise and generous use of Rests. Review par. 192*, thoroughly. The 3-voice Canon is rarely accompanied, though the addition of one or even more auxiliary parts is possible. For general illustration 1. Allegro. 2nd Foil. *i) Klengel. *2) Leader. 2. Waltz tempo. Klengel. * 3 ) 3 Moderato _ fii ai *4ifc — ^ etc. Leader. "tr aa-^ c p-*- *=*- 3z 2: Klengel. *4) Auxil. Bass. Par. 205. THE THREE- VOICE CANON. 3 1 I *i) The 2nd Follower is not again in the " 2nd from the Leader," but in the 2nd from the preceding Follower, or 3rd from the Leader ; the Canon is therefore "in the 2nd and 3rd," after one measure, respectively. The contrapuntal relations between the inner and upper parts in measure 3 therefore correspond exactly to those between the lower and inner parts in measure 2 ; and so on continuously, from measure to measure, throughout. *2) Vol. I, Canon 14. Analyze minutely. *3) Vol. II, Canon 9 ; in 8ve and 8ve, after one beat ; an extraordinary example. *4) Vol. I, Canon 20; in 3rd and 5th; like the preceding, this has also a very brief time-interval (one beat), and is even more unique, in some respects ; analyze carefully ; the auxiliary Bass is coordinate. *5) See Ex. 189, Note *3). See further, Klengel, Vol. I, Canon 2 ; in 3rd and 5th, after one measure, unac- companied. — - Vol. I, Canon 4 ; in 7th and 6th, after one measure, unaccompanied. — Vol. I, Canon 9 ; 8ve-8ve. — Vol. I, Canon 12 ; in 6th and 4th, after six measures ; very definite form, in consequence of long time-interval. — Vol. I, Canon 13 ; in 5th and 2nd, after one measure. — Vol. I, Canon 23 ; 8ve-8ve. — Vol. I, Canon 24 ; 8ve-8ve. — Vol. II, Canon 2 ; in 4th and 7th, after one beat ; at first unaccompanied j later a running Bass is added, and still later an auxiliary upper part (5-voice texture) ; Prelude and Postlude. — Vol. II, Canon 14 ; 8ve-8ve, after z\ measures. — Vol. II, Canon 17; in 5th and 2nd, after 2 beats; at first unaccompanied; in Part II an auxiliary Bass is added ; later the canonic parts are shifted down (to 3 lower parts), and the upper part becomes a running auxiliary. — Vol. II, Canon 22 ; in 3rd and 5th, after 4 measures. — Vol. II, Canon 24 ; 8ve-8ve. — Vol. I, Canon 1 ; in 2nd and 3rd after \ measure ; auxiliary running Bass. — Vol. I, Canon 6 ; 8ve-8ve, in simulta- neous Diminution and Augmentation ; the 3 parts begin exactly together, the Leader in inner voice ; 14 measures of the Leader are imitated in Augmentation (to meas. 28), and 28 measures are imitated in Diminution ; the latter (upper part) becomes, therefore, "free " after meas. 14, and all the parts are free from meas. 28 to end. Mozart (Breitkopf & Hartel, Serie 7), No. 42 ; Unison. — No. 50 ; unison and 8ve. — No. 51 ; in 2nd and 3rd. Both vocal. G. W. Chadwick, Organ Canons, op. 12, No. 9; in 4th and 7th, after one measure ; auxiliary Bass. — No. 10 ; in 2nd and 3rd, ditto. 206. Contrary motion is employed as follows : The first Follower is the Contrary motion of the Leader, in any of the usual methods of cor- respondence (Tonic = Dominant being probably the best) ; the second Follower, being the Contrary motion of the first one, returns to the original direction, and the corresponding series of interval-relations is obtained by giving to the 2nd Follower, in every case, the exact tones of the Leader (i.e., 8ve-imitation of the latter). Thus : 312 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 206. Z^- GOETSCHIUS. _ Tonic. '' ^-m- Goetschius. ^ ;-- j _j],_ ,; agfc|» _ T - l ^ „ ps Tonic. *i) The 2nd Follower imitates the Leader in parallel direction, in the double 8ve. The successive intervals described by Leader and 1st Follower (beginning with the 8ve, as indicated) are exactly reproduced between 1st and 2nd Followers, but, naturally, in inverted forms. This will be the invariable result, no matter what the location of the 1st Follower is, if the 2nd Follower corresponds thus to the Leader. 207. The 4-voice Canon. The principles of par. 205 apply here also, simply extended to include the 4th voice. For example (8ve-8ve-8ve, after one measure) : , A Ex. 205. \ Allegro. p g ^=s gg= LJ_L *t T FPr=r I AIM Goetschius. A p-rf i *_I % § -• — *■ 3=t ^ w ±A±A N.B. . J ±± ± ■±. - - ^ tL^ etc. 1 ^i: %=*j ft • — P- Pf^t r See also Klengel, Vol. I, Canon 15 ; in the 6th, 4th, and 2nd (comp. Ex. 202), after one measure respectively ; unaccompanied. Mozart (Breitkopf & Hartel, Serie 7), No. 54; vocal ; all unison, after 4 measures. dementi, " Gradus ad Parnassum," Schirmer ed. No. 68 (orig. ed. 33), is a 4- voice Canon, in unequal melodic intervals ; the succession is 4th, 5th, and 8th; hence, the second pair of parts (2nd and 3rd Followers) correspond in their relations Par. 208. THE DOUBLE-CANON. 313 to the first pair, but the interval-relations between the first and second Followers are so shifted as to involve Artificial double-cpt. Analyze minutely. Brahms, Round-canons, op. 113, No. 6; in contrary motion ; indep. cadence. EXERCISE 58. A. An example of the 3-voice Canon in 8ve-8ve; unaccompanied; for piano- forte, organ, or string-trio. B. Two or more examples in other intervals of Imitation, according to Ex. 202 ; with or without auxiliary part, at option. C. A 3-voice Canon in Contrary motion. D. One or more 4-voice Canons, for string-quartet. CHAPTER XXI. The Double-Canon, Etc. 208. Like the Double-fugue, the Double-canon has two Leaders, or a " Double-leader," imitated by two Followers. The number of canonic parts is therefore four ; to these an auxiliary part may be added, but it is rarely done. The two Leaders may begin together, but it is more common to introduce the subordinate Leader (so-called) a beat or more, possibly a measure or more, later than its fellow. The rules of par. 165 apply, to a certain extent, and may be reviewed. The interval of Imitation is optional, the 8ve being here again pos- sibly the most convenient. The time-interval is apt to be a little longer than in the single Canon, but must be adhered to by both Followers ; i.e., the second pair of parts must agree with the first pair in time-rela- tion. Any two of the four parts may be chosen for the two Leaders. For example : 2nd Leader. Allegro. 314 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 208. 1 tk- r-U -fl -H :p=l — I -J—, f r — 4 -m- 1 J • — i»*= — -• 1 2nd Fc ■T^— 1 — -1 -* >llower (in -1 I 5th). 1 • * d=#^ v J- q -M- r— -H^ --f-f- -(2 -r 1st Follower ( in 5th) . I bt=± GOETSCHIUS. ^ UUJiiSCHlUS. IE s i* 31 -?- m 43 et fe# etc. J — s tf=r -• — *-*- j This is a Double-canon in the 5th, after 3 measures. See further, Klengel, Vol. I, Canon 21 ; in the 5th, after one measure ; unaccompanied ; 2 Leaders begin simul- taneously in Tenor and Soprano, 2 Followers in Bass and Alto. — Vol. II, Canon 4 ; in 5th, after 2 long measures ; 2 Leaders begin together in Bass and Alto ; they are contrasted through the novel device of making one lyric and the other its (apparently inferior) figural accompaniment. Mozart (Serie 7), No. 41 ; Double-canon as Round (vocal, unacc.) ; in 4th, after one measure ; no cadence ; •> Leaders in Alto and Tenor, one measure apart, — hence the 1st Follower begins simultaneously with 2nd Leader. Brahms, Sacred quartet, op. 30 ; in 7th, after one measure ; with accompani- ment, including Prelude and Interludes. — Round-canons, op. 113; No. 8, unison, after 4 measures ; No. 9, in 4th, after one-half measure. Clementi, "Gradus ad Parnassum," Schirmer ed. No. 70^ (orig. No. 84J) ; in 8ve, after one beat ; unaccompanied. 209. The Triple-canon is far less frequent than the preceding. It consists in 3 Leaders, imitated by 3 Followers, and therefore involves six canonic parts. See Brahms, op. 11S, No. 4, Div. II (meas. 51-91); Leaders (simultaneous) on upper staff, Followers on lower, after one beat ; unaccompanied. The Quadruple-canon is still more rare ; it involves eight canonic parts, and is practicable only in Double-chorus or orchestral writing. An extraordinary example of the Quadruple-canon is found in Mozart (Serie 7), No. 49 ; it is written for 1 2 parts (as triple-chorus) , and consists in a full quartet of Par. zio. CHORALE AS CANON. 315 Leaders, imitated in the unison, after \\ measures, by a quartet of Followers, and I \ measures later by still another quartet ; it is designed as a Round, with cadence indicated. EXERCISE 59. A. One or two examples of the Double-canon ; all conditions optional. B. An example as " Song-form with Trio," for pianoforte, 4 hands ; the princi- pal Song a Double-canon, with auxiliary (subordinate) Bass ; the Trio a brief Triple- canon, in the 8ve, unaccompanied. CHAPTER XXII. Canon as Chorale-Elaboration. 210. Chorale as Canon. In this species the chorale-melody itself appears in two voices as Canon, while the other parts provide a contra- puntal accompaniment. The interval of canonic imitation, and the time-interval, are optional. But the relations adopted at the beginning should be, as a rule, maintained uniformly through- out the chorale ; therefore it is usually necessary to experiment repeatedly with the whole, before valid relations can be determined ; and it is not considered unpermissi- ve, in case the advantage is manifest, to adopt new relations for a new Section (or even for some single line) of the chorale. It is greatly preferable, however, to over- come the necessity for such changes of canonic relation by judicious (slight) rhythmic modification, or strictly unessential melodic embellishment, of the chorale-melody, in the manner shown in Ex. 125. For example (Table, Exercise 26, Chorale 29) : First version ; canon in the 5th, after one measure. *i) ;^=* i3i Ex. n £ 207-ES Z ±gl -«>-*— \-*Sf -— Hs* — ,•■ — r-T-T'f « ,*2) m I etc. g^f^ Pffy - f> -tS- I ^ f 1 r r . r r i Second version ; canon in the 2nd, after one (longer) measure. fji&EEzO t±rz:*i)_ S!=P^lfe !^=: r tr r u t- j ft f 3i6 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 211. m GOETSCHIUS. — *r |e«. T :t»tt rffTw"* *- = r i ' f? si!r rr *i) Observe the slight modifications of the original chorale-melody. *2) The ft\ simply indicates, as usual, the end of a Line, and is not respected. *3) In the completed elaboration of this first version the canonic parts are Soprano and Pedal-bass, — the latter two 8ves lower than here written. The inner parts are thematic, as in the " Invention with chorale " (par. 99), preceding the Leader by two measures. *4) Canonic parts are Soprano and Tenor ; Pedal independent ; Alto pursues constantly a Figure of its own ; comp. pars. 93, 96. 211. The parts which accompany the canonic voices are in a sense their " auxiliaries," but should be strictly contrapuntal, and thematic (based upon some Motive or Motives), as described in par. 92, which review. See also pars. 99 and 93. The number and choice of these accompanying parts, and the loca- tion of the canonic voices, are wholly optional. Either the small or large species of chorale-figuration may be employed. For general illustration • 1. Moderate). Piutti. Leader (c. f.). Ex. 20S. ^=i=^ : -*— *^± *-*- '■-- -*■ ■*■ r r tt §5E -• — 9 (-^ — P- ^ ^i Follower (in8ve). etc. is :p* 4=1=1=1= -* • . -r 2. Moderate. S=S ' -> K&- — f— F- M. 9^ * ^ 1 J- J ,! 1 i j . , t)f-H h 1 r^ J \, 9i ,. = O ■ -fr -> L_ | f ,' 1 Par. an. CANON WITH CHORALE. 317 Follower (in 5th). 6=*=* i Bach *i) 1^3 j=t= ^X j j- 1 1 ^ r Leader (c. f.). etc. 3EEB 1 m rqz =t=t 4= *i) Bach, Org. Comp., Vol. V, No. 3. — See further, Bach, Vol. V, No. 8 ; in 8ve, outer parts; 2 auxiliary thematic parts. — Vol. V, No. 19; 4- voice ; Canon in 8ve, Soprano and Tenor ; Bass independent ; running Alto. • — Vol. V, No. 29 j 4- voice; Soprano and Alto, in 5th, after 2 beats; running Tenor, independ. Pedal. — Vol. V, No. 37, 5-voice ; Soprano and Alto, in 5th. — Vol. V, No. 44 ; 4-voice ; Bass and Alto, in 5th, after 2 beats. — Vol. V, No. 35 ; 4-voice ; Double-canon (in 8ve) for 24 measures ; then single Canon, with longer time-interval, for 7 measures ; then free Coda (6 measures). In this example the triplet notation differs from modern usage (i.e., J J J = J ). — Vol. VI, No. 19; 5-voice; Canon in two Tenors, after 2 long measures ; Pedal independent, Soprano and Alto thematic. — Vol. VII, No. 52 ; 5- voice ; Soprano and Tenor, 8ve ; Pedal independent, other two parts imitatory ; the canonic imitations alternate at each Line ; time-interval changed once. A superb masterpiece is found in Bach, Vol. V, page 100; Canon in Contrary motion; Sec. I (to meas. 14) in upper parts, Tonic = Mediant, Pedal auxiliary ; Sec. II (to meas. 27) the contrary motion of Sec. I, Mediant = Tonic, Pedal new ; Sec. III (to meas. 39), Canon in lower parts, Dominant = Mediant, two upper parts auxiliary; Sec. IV (to meas. 52) contrary motion of Sec. Ill ; Sec. V is a Coda, con- taining Diminutions of first Line, and a remarkable stretto of all 4 Lines together. 212. Canon with Chorale, i.e., canonic accompaniment to the single chorale-melody. All conditions are optional. Additional auxiliary parts are some- times employed. For example : Lento. Goetschius. C. F. ,rs I ife Ex. 209. H U. T 7 Leader. ^ §i|IE=^g M 1 — - - P=; W^ I etc. ^ T^gtE •— *-5-n Follower (in 7th). 318 APPLIED COUNTERPOINT. Par. 213. See Bach, Org. Comp., Vol. V, page 92 ; Canon in 8ve, after \ measure, in outer parts ; c.f. in Pedal as Tenor ; Large species (with Prelude, Interludes, and Postlude). — Vol. V, page 94 ; Canon in 4th, after \ measure; other conditions similar to pre- ceding. — Vol. V, page 96 ; Canon in 7th, Pedal-bass and Alto; c. f. in Soprano; additional lyric auxiliary part in 2nd Soprano. — Vol. V, page 98 ; Canon in Aug- mentation, Soprano and Bass, in 8ve; the Leader ends in meas. 21, the Follower in meas. 42 (end of the composition) ; c. f. in Pedal as Tenor ; an auxil. Tenor is added. EXERCISE 60. A. Two or more examples of the Chorale as Canon (pars. 210, 211), for Organ. B. Two or more examples of the Canon with Chorale (par. 212). " Canonic " Compositions. 213. When the canonic imitation falls short of the characteristic requirements of the legitimate Canon (par. 180), either in being inter- rupted (periodic instead of continuous), or in containing more or less frequent licences (instead of being strict), the product forfeits the title of " Canon," and is called simply " canonic " composition. To this class belong also the fairly numerous examples of homo- phonic (or even polyphonic) forms with canonic sections, or passages. See Beethoven, Pfte. Var., op. 120, Var. 6 (1st section of Parts I and II) ; Var. 19 (the same) ; Var. 20 (similar). — Pfte. Var., op. 35, Var. 7 (Parts I and III ; Part II harmonic). — Pfte. Sonata, op. 101, 2nd movement, portions of the "Trio." — Symphony No. IV, first movement, meas. 103-119 of Allegro. — Violin Sonata, op. 30, No. 2, "Trio " of Scherzo. — Pfte. Sonata, op. 7, 3rd movement, Part II. — Op. 31, No. I, Fin'ale, meas. 86-97. Schubert, Trio, op. 100, Scherzo. Schumann, op. 56, No. 4; Parts I and III; in 4th, at first after 3 measures, then after one; Part II free, but imitatory. — No. 6; Sec. I, 8ve-canon, harmonic accompaniment ; Sec. II, a 4-voice Fughetta ; Sec. Ill again canonic. Chopin, Mazurka 34 (op. 56, No. 2) ; Part V, meas. 32-17 from end. Brahms, Var., op. 9, Var. 10 ; contains several brief canonic passages, and duplications in simultaneous regular and contrary motion (belongs to the once po'pu- lar species called " Quodlibet," a contrapuntal medley ; see the Finale of Bach's "Air" with 30 Variations). Brahms, Motet, op. 74, No. 1, 2nd movement. — Op. 118, No. 4, Divs. I and III. Jadassohn, op. 56, Prelude No. 5 ; Song-form with Trio ; Principal Song homo- phonic, Trio an 8ve-canon. Bach, " B-minor Mass," No. 14, Et in unum Dominum. — Org. Comp., Vol. V, No. 15. — Vol. VI, No. 24. The End.